HP Color LaserJet Enterprise MFP X677, X67755, X67765
HP Color LaserJet Enterprise MFP X677, X67755, X67765
Service Manual
www.hp.com/support/colorlj6700 www.hp.com/support/colorlj6800MFP
www.hp.com/support/colorljX654 www.hp.com/support/colorljX677MFP
HP Color LaserJet 6700, 6701, X677,
X65455, X65465, MFP 6800, 6801, X654,
X67755, X67765 - Service Manual
SUMMARY
The information contained herein is subject to change without notice. The only warranties for HP
products and services are set forth in the express warranty statements accompanying such products
and services. Nothing herein should be construed as constituting an additional warranty. HP shall not be
liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained herein.
11.2 2/2025 Updated HV power supply PCA part numbers. See Removal and
replacement: High-voltage power supply (HVPS) on page 1002.
11.1 1/2025 Removed the reference to Quiet Mode in the General menu table as that
feature is not supported on these devices. See General menu on page 255.
10 9/2024 Updated part description for toner supply drive assembly, see Removal and
replacement: Toner supply drive assembly (X654/X677 models) on page 970
9 8/2024 Updated repetitive defect ruler table. Repetitive image defect ruler on page
475
iii
Table Revision history (continued)
● Added step to close front door, see Close the front door on page 875.
5 4/2024 Updated Fax accessory part number, see Removal and replacement: Fax
PCA (fax models) on page 568.
4.3 2/2024 Removed all references to code names. Removed the PN conref table.
4.2 2/2024 Updated M17 component, see Floor-standing stapler-stacker motor control
on page 126.
Remove the Drive PCA on page 882, Remove the ITB motor on page 1063,
Remove fuser motor on page 1080, Remove Duplex motor on page 1087, and
Remove fuser drive assembly on page 867.
Remove and replace: Waste toner duct (X57945) changed to Remove and
replace: Waste toner carry assembly on page 910.
Updated Remove and replace: Waste toner duct assembly on page 931 to
include X57945 part number.
Updated ALL procedures that have removing the Formatter cover to add 2
options depending on back covers.
Updated ALL procedures that have removing the upper rear cover to add 3
options depending on back covers.
iv Revision history
Table Revision history (continued)
1.1 04/2023 Service manual updates include, but not limited to:
v
Conventions used in this guide
CAUTION: Cautions indicate procedures that you should follow to avoid losing data or damaging the
product.
WARNING! Warnings alert you to specific procedures that you should follow to avoid personal injury,
catastrophic loss of data, or extensive damage to the product.
View a video of how to use the HP Partner First Portal to access WISE.
1. Sign-in to the HP Partner Portal (click https://partner.hp.com to access the sign-in page).
2. Select the Services & Support item (near the top of the screen).
1. Sign-in to the CSDP portal (click csdp.hp.com to access the sign-in page).
vii
Additional service and support for HP internal personnel
HP internal personnel, go to one of the following Web-based Interactive Search Engine (WISE) sites:
Americas (AMS)
● WISE - English
● WISE - Spanish
● WISE - Portuguese
● WISE - French
● WISE - English
● WISE - Japanese
● WISE - Korean
● WISE - Thai
● WISE - English
View a video of how to use WISE to find technical support videos (model number search).
View a video of how to use WISE to find technical support videos (Product detail page [PDP]
search).
ix
Document feeder / scanner .............................................................................................................................................................................................. 42
Clean the pickup rollers and separation pad in the document feeder (MFP) ..................................................................... 42
Check the scanner glass for dirt and smudges....................................................................................................................................... 42
Base printer ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 45
Remove and replace the toner cartridges (6700/6800 models) ................................................................................................. 45
Remove and replace the toner cartridges (X654/X677 models)..................................................................................................46
Remove and replace the imaging drums (X654/X677 models) .....................................................................................................48
Clean the Tray 1 pickup and separation rollers .......................................................................................................................................... 51
Clean the Tray 2 pickup and separation rollers ........................................................................................................................................ 55
3 Theory of operation.........................................................................................................................................................................................................................57
Document feeder / scanner ..............................................................................................................................................................................................58
Document feeder simplex operation ...............................................................................................................................................................58
Scanning and image capture system..............................................................................................................................................................58
Base printer ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................................60
Basic operation................................................................................................................................................................................................................60
Sequence of operation ...................................................................................................................................................................................60
Formatter-control system......................................................................................................................................................................................... 62
Power management .......................................................................................................................................................................................... 62
Set the sleep timer and configure the printer to use 1 watt or less of power ..............................................63
Set the sleep schedule ........................................................................................................................................................................63
Printer job language (PJL)..............................................................................................................................................................................64
Control panel ..........................................................................................................................................................................................................64
Walk-up USB ............................................................................................................................................................................................................64
Low end data model (LEDM) overview..................................................................................................................................................65
CPU ................................................................................................................................................................................................................................65
Input/output (I/O) ..................................................................................................................................................................................................65
Memory.......................................................................................................................................................................................................................65
Engine-control unit.........................................................................................................................................................................................................66
DC controller............................................................................................................................................................................................................67
Motors ................................................................................................................................................................................................................71
Fans.....................................................................................................................................................................................................................73
Low-voltage power supply..............................................................................................................................................................................73
Low-voltage power supply voltages description................................................................................................................74
Over-current/over-voltage protection ........................................................................................................................................75
Low-voltage power supply safety..................................................................................................................................................75
Low-voltage power supply functions ..........................................................................................................................................75
High-voltage power supply............................................................................................................................................................................76
Fuser control............................................................................................................................................................................................................77
Fuser heater protection....................................................................................................................................................................... 82
Fuser control functions........................................................................................................................................................................83
Engine laser/scanner system ................................................................................................................................................................................83
Laser scanner failure detection................................................................................................................................................................84
Laser scanner safety........................................................................................................................................................................................84
Image-formation process .............................................................................................................................................................................85
Step 1: Pre-exposure (X654/X677 models only)....................................................................................................................87
Step 2: Primary charging.....................................................................................................................................................................88
Step 3: Laser-beam exposure..........................................................................................................................................................88
x
Step 4: Development..............................................................................................................................................................................89
Step 5: Primary transfer ......................................................................................................................................................................89
Step 6: Secondary transfer...............................................................................................................................................................90
Step 7: Separation....................................................................................................................................................................................90
Step 8: Fusing............................................................................................................................................................................................... 91
Step 9: ITB cleaning ................................................................................................................................................................................. 91
Toner cartridges................................................................................................................................................................................................... 92
Design............................................................................................................................................................................................................... 92
Toner cartridge functions ..................................................................................................................................................................94
Intermediate transfer belt assembly ....................................................................................................................................................94
Intermediate transfer belt (ITB) functions..............................................................................................................................95
Secondary transfer roller assembly .....................................................................................................................................................96
Secondary transfer roller functions...........................................................................................................................................96
Calibration ................................................................................................................................................................................................................96
Calibration functions.............................................................................................................................................................................96
Engine pickup, feed, and delivery system ......................................................................................................................................................97
Sensors and switches .....................................................................................................................................................................................99
Motors, clutches, and solenoids..............................................................................................................................................................101
Feed speed control...............................................................................................................................................................................103
Pickup and feed delivery features .............................................................................................................................................103
Media detection.......................................................................................................................................................................................104
Jam detection/prevention...........................................................................................................................................................................105
Input devices...............................................................................................................................................................................................................................109
550-sheet paper feeder...........................................................................................................................................................................................109
550-sheet paper feeder paper path....................................................................................................................................................109
Paper feeder controller.................................................................................................................................................................................109
550-sheet paper feeder electrical components.........................................................................................................................110
550-sheet paper feeder motor control ............................................................................................................................................... 111
550-sheet paper feeder other functions ........................................................................................................................................... 111
550-sheet feeder jam detection............................................................................................................................................................... 111
High capacity input (HCI) paper feeder......................................................................................................................................................... 112
HCI paper path ..................................................................................................................................................................................................... 112
HCI controller ........................................................................................................................................................................................................ 112
HCI electrical components ......................................................................................................................................................................... 113
HCI motor control............................................................................................................................................................................................... 114
HCI other functions........................................................................................................................................................................................... 114
HCI jam detection............................................................................................................................................................................................... 115
Output devices ...........................................................................................................................................................................................................................116
3-bin stapler-stacker....................................................................................................................................................................................................116
3-bin stapler-stacker paper path.............................................................................................................................................................116
3-bin stapler-stacker controller................................................................................................................................................................116
3-bin stapler-stacker electrical components..................................................................................................................................117
3-bin stapler-stacker motor control.......................................................................................................................................................119
3-bin stapler-stacker fan control .............................................................................................................................................................119
3-bin stapler-stacker other functions ..................................................................................................................................................119
3-bin stapler-stacker jam detection .....................................................................................................................................................120
Floor-standing stapler-stacker............................................................................................................................................................................120
Floor-standing stapler-stacker paper path.....................................................................................................................................120
xi
Floor-standing stapler-stacker controller ......................................................................................................................................... 121
Floor-standing stapler-stacker electrical components ......................................................................................................... 122
Floor-standing stapler-stacker motor control............................................................................................................................... 126
Floor-standing stapler-stacker fan control.......................................................................................................................................127
Floor-standing stapler-stacker other functions............................................................................................................................127
550-sheet feeder jam detection............................................................................................................................................................. 128
xii
Manual sensor test ...........................................................................................................................................................................................197
Tray/bin manual sensor test .......................................................................................................................................................................197
Diagrams: Block diagrams.....................................................................................................................................................................................198
Diagrams: External plug and port locations...................................................................................................................................198
Sensors and switches ...................................................................................................................................................................................199
Diagrams: Major component locations............................................................................................................................................206
Printed circuit assembly (PCA) connector locations.............................................................................................................. 226
Diagrams: General timing chart............................................................................................................................................................. 236
Diagrams: General circuit diagrams................................................................................................................................................... 238
Internal test and information pages ...............................................................................................................................................................249
Reports menu................................................................................................................................................................................................................. 253
Settings menu................................................................................................................................................................................................................ 254
General menu...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 255
Scan/Digital Send Settings menu (MFP)........................................................................................................................................... 261
Fax menu (MFP)...................................................................................................................................................................................................272
Manage Supplies menu............................................................................................................................................................................... 283
Networking menu .............................................................................................................................................................................................286
Support Tools menu................................................................................................................................................................................................... 292
Maintenance menu ......................................................................................................................................................................................... 292
Backup/Restore menu....................................................................................................................................................................... 292
Calibration/Cleaning menu............................................................................................................................................................ 293
USB Firmware Upgrade menu...................................................................................................................................................... 294
Service menu ...........................................................................................................................................................................................294
Troubleshooting menu .................................................................................................................................................................................. 295
Service menu..................................................................................................................................................................................................................299
Printer resets ..................................................................................................................................................................................................................303
Format Disk and Partial Clean functions ...................................................................................................................................................305
Power on troubleshooting .................................................................................................................................................................................................310
Power-on checks ...........................................................................................................................................................................................................310
Power on troubleshooting overview ...............................................................................................................................................................310
Troubleshooting power-on or blank control panel problems.............................................................................................310
Engine diagnostics ...................................................................................................................................................................................................... 312
Engine test.............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 312
Defeating interlocks ........................................................................................................................................................................................313
Disable cartridge check...............................................................................................................................................................................315
LED diagnostics (formatter)..................................................................................................................................................................................315
Use the solve problems checklist.....................................................................................................................................................................319
Control panel troubleshooting ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 322
Control panel system diagnostics .................................................................................................................................................................. 322
Open the control panel system diagnostic tests ...................................................................................................................... 322
Screen test.............................................................................................................................................................................................................324
Touch test................................................................................................................................................................................................................327
SoftKey test .......................................................................................................................................................................................................... 329
Backlight test.......................................................................................................................................................................................................330
Sound test...............................................................................................................................................................................................................331
Version...................................................................................................................................................................................................................... 332
How to search for printer documentation.................................................................................................................................................333
How to search WISE for printer information and documentation ................................................................................333
xiii
Accessing WISE for HP channel partners (CSDP)....................................................................................................................339
Accessing WISE for HP channel partners (HP Partner Portal)........................................................................................340
Control panel messages document (CPMD) ......................................................................................................................................................343
Print the supplies status page ...........................................................................................................................................................................343
Pre-boot menu options ............................................................................................................................................................................................343
Open the Pre-boot menu from a touchscreen control panel ...........................................................................................343
Cold reset using the Pre-boot menu from a touchscreen control panel .................................................................345
Remote Admin ....................................................................................................................................................................................................345
Required software and network connection.....................................................................................................................346
Connect a remote connection......................................................................................................................................................347
Disconnect a remote connection............................................................................................................................................... 351
Print the event log........................................................................................................................................................................................................353
How to search for printer documentation.................................................................................................................................................353
How to search WISE for printer information and documentation ................................................................................353
Accessing WISE for HP channel partners (CSDP)....................................................................................................................359
Accessing WISE for HP channel partners (HP Partner Portal)........................................................................................360
Error-code and control-panel-message troubleshooting overview ....................................................................................... 362
Error codes (types and structure)........................................................................................................................................................ 362
Solve paper handling problems ...................................................................................................................................................................................365
Clear paper jams (SFP models).........................................................................................................................................................................365
Paper jam locations........................................................................................................................................................................................365
Auto-navigation for clearing paper jams........................................................................................................................................365
Experiencing frequent or recurring paper jams?......................................................................................................................365
13.B2.D1 jam error in Tray 1 (multipurpose tray)...........................................................................................................................366
13.B2.D2 jam error in Tray 2.........................................................................................................................................................................370
13.A3 jam error in Tray 3 ................................................................................................................................................................................375
13.A4 jam error in Tray 4 ................................................................................................................................................................................381
13.A4 jam error in Tray 4 (2,100 sheet feeder HCI).....................................................................................................................388
13.B2 jam error in right door......................................................................................................................................................................395
13.B4 jam errors in the right door .........................................................................................................................................................398
13.B9 jam errors in the fuser.....................................................................................................................................................................400
13.D3 jam errors in the duplexer.............................................................................................................................................................404
13.E1 jam error in the output bin .............................................................................................................................................................406
Clear paper jams (MFP models)........................................................................................................................................................................ 407
Paper jam locations........................................................................................................................................................................................ 407
Auto-navigation for clearing paper jams........................................................................................................................................409
Experiencing frequent or recurring paper jams?......................................................................................................................409
31.13.yz jam error in the document feeder ......................................................................................................................................409
13.B2.D1 jam error in Tray 1 (multipurpose tray)............................................................................................................................ 414
13.B2.D2 jam error in Tray 2..........................................................................................................................................................................417
13.A3 jam error in Tray 3 ............................................................................................................................................................................... 422
13.A4 jam error in Tray 4 ............................................................................................................................................................................... 428
13.A4 jam error in Tray 4 (2,100 sheet feeder HCI).....................................................................................................................435
13.B2 jam error in right door...................................................................................................................................................................... 442
13.B4 jam errors in the right door .........................................................................................................................................................445
13.B9 jam errors in the fuser......................................................................................................................................................................447
13.D3 jam errors in the duplexer.............................................................................................................................................................. 451
13.E1 jam error in the output bin ............................................................................................................................................................. 453
xiv
13.E2 jam error in top cover ....................................................................................................................................................................... 454
13.60 jam errors in the fuser exit area when printing to a stapler/stacker or floor-standing finisher..456
13.80, 13.83, or 13.84 jam errors in the 3 Bin Stapler/Stacker............................................................................................458
13.40 or 13.47 Punch jam error in the Floor-standing finisher............................................................................................ 462
13.6, 13.7, or 13.8 jam error in the Floor-standing finisher ......................................................................................................465
Printer feeds incorrect page size ....................................................................................................................................................................469
Printer pulls from incorrect tray........................................................................................................................................................................469
Printer will not duplex or duplexes incorrectly (duplex models)..................................................................................................470
Paper does not feed from Tray 2-X ...................................................................................................................................................................470
Output is curled or wrinkled...................................................................................................................................................................................471
The printer does not pick up paper...................................................................................................................................................................471
The printer picks up multiple sheets of paper.........................................................................................................................................472
The document feeder jams, skews, or picks up multiple sheets of paper (MFP)............................................................472
Paper does not feed automatically .................................................................................................................................................................473
Image-quality troubleshooting.......................................................................................................................................................................................474
Print-quality troubleshooting................................................................................................................................................................................475
Repetitive image defect ruler ...................................................................................................................................................................475
Use a ruler to measure between repetitive defects .....................................................................................................476
Print from a different software program ..........................................................................................................................................479
Check the paper-type setting for the print job.............................................................................................................................479
Check the paper type setting on the control panel.......................................................................................................479
Check the paper type setting (Windows).............................................................................................................................480
Check the paper type setting (macOS) ................................................................................................................................480
Check toner-cartridge status..................................................................................................................................................................480
Step one: Print the Supplies Status Page............................................................................................................................480
Step two: Check supplies status.................................................................................................................................................481
Print a cleaning page ......................................................................................................................................................................................481
Check paper and the printing environment...................................................................................................................................481
Step one: Use paper that meets HP specifications......................................................................................................481
Step two: Check the environment............................................................................................................................................. 482
Step three: Set the individual tray alignment.................................................................................................................... 482
Try a different print driver........................................................................................................................................................................... 482
Troubleshoot image defects.....................................................................................................................................................................483
Copy-quality troubleshooting .............................................................................................................................................................................490
Check the scanner glass for dirt and smudges ......................................................................................................................... 491
Vertical lines, bands, or streaks ............................................................................................................................................................. 492
Modify printer settings to improve scan or copy quality......................................................................................................497
Light or faint copies (color models).....................................................................................................................................................498
Performance and connectivity troubleshooting...............................................................................................................................................501
Solve fax or email problems .................................................................................................................................................................................501
Solve performance problems ............................................................................................................................................................................502
Factors affecting print performance.................................................................................................................................................502
Print speeds .........................................................................................................................................................................................................503
The printer does not print...........................................................................................................................................................................504
The printer prints slowly ..............................................................................................................................................................................504
Solve connectivity problems...............................................................................................................................................................................505
Solve USB connection problems ..........................................................................................................................................................505
Solve wired network problems ...............................................................................................................................................................505
xv
Introduction ...............................................................................................................................................................................................505
Poor physical connection................................................................................................................................................................505
The computer is using the incorrect IP address for the printer..........................................................................505
The computer is unable to communicate with the printer......................................................................................506
The printer is using incorrect link and duplex settings for the network.........................................................506
New software programs might be causing compatibility problems................................................................506
The computer or workstation might be set up incorrectly......................................................................................506
The printer is disabled, or other network settings are incorrect........................................................................506
xvi
Removal and replacement: Flatbed scanner assembly (MFP models) ......................................................... 622
4 Removal and replacement: Internal parts and assemblies (base printer) ...............................................................................631
Field-replaceable units (FRUs) ............................................................................................................................................................................631
Covers, panels, and doors...........................................................................................................................................................................631
Removal and replacement: Formatter cover.....................................................................................................................631
Removal and replacement: Formatter cover....................................................................................................................633
Removal and replacement: Front door ..................................................................................................................................636
Removal and replacement: Toner cartridge access door (X654/X677 models)......................................640
Removal and replacement: Rear cover.................................................................................................................................643
Removal and replacement: Rear upper cover (MFP models).................................................................................647
Removal and replacement: Left upper cover (MFP models).................................................................................. 652
Removal and replacement: Left cover ...................................................................................................................................655
Removal and replacement: Left handle ................................................................................................................................659
Removal and replacement: Front left cover.......................................................................................................................663
Removal and replacement: Front right cover....................................................................................................................665
Removal and replacement: Right door .................................................................................................................................. 667
Removal and replacement: Right lower door (X654/X677 models)....................................................................672
Removal and replacement: Rear lower cover (X654/X677 models)...................................................................675
Removal and replacement: Left lower cover (X654/X677 models).................................................................... 679
Removal and replacement: Output bin..................................................................................................................................683
Removal and replacement: Right handle ............................................................................................................................. 687
Removal and replacement: Top cover (SFP models)....................................................................................................693
Removal and replacement: Top cover (MFP models) ..................................................................................................699
Removal and replacement: Top front cover (MFP models).......................................................................................702
Removal and replacement: Hardware Integration Pocket (HIP) cover............................................................ 708
Removal and replacement: Control panel (SFP models) ........................................................................................... 710
Removal and replacement: Control panel (MFP models).......................................................................................... 714
Internal parts and assemblies................................................................................................................................................................. 716
Removal and replacement: Control panel slide assembly (MFP models)..................................................... 716
Removal and replacement: Convenience stapler .......................................................................................................... 727
Removal and replacement: Toner cartridges (manual unlock) (X654/X677 models)............................ 737
Removal and replacement: Secondary transfer assembly ....................................................................................740
Removal and replacement: Registration density sensor assembly .................................................................745
Removal and replacement: Registration assembly .......................................................................................................751
Removal and replacement: Paper pickup assembly (6700/6800 models).................................................. 756
Removal and replacement: Paper pickup assembly (X654/X677 models)...................................................762
Removal and replacement: Delivery assembly............................................................................................................... 766
Removal and replacement: Laser scanner assembly.................................................................................................770
Removal and replacement: DC controller (DCC).............................................................................................................776
Removal and replacement: Formatter.....................................................................................................................................781
Removal and replacement: Formatter cage assembly (SFP models) ............................................................ 786
Removal and replacement: Formatter cage assembly (MFP) models ............................................................ 791
Removal and replacement: Feed drive assembly (X654/X677 models) ........................................................ 798
Removal and replacement: Pickup drive assembly (6700/6800 models)....................................................805
Removal and replacement: Pickup drive assembly (X654/X677 models) ..................................................... 812
Removal and replacement: Toner supply motor assembly (X654/X677 models) ....................................818
Removal and replacement: Lifter drive assembly (6700/6800 models) ....................................................... 822
Removal and replacement: Lifter drive assembly (X654/X677 models)........................................................829
xvii
Removal and replacement: Auto close assembly (6700/6800 models)........................................................834
Removal and replacement: Auto close assembly (X654/X677 models)......................................................... 841
Removal and replacement: Tray 2 media size detect assembly (6700/6800 models) .......................846
Removal and replacement: Tray 2 media size detect assembly (X654/X677 models)........................855
Removal and replacement: Fuser drive assembly.........................................................................................................861
Removal and replacement: Main-drive assembly ......................................................................................................... 870
Removal and replacement: Interlock assembly..............................................................................................................889
Removal and replacement: Waste toner carry assembly (X654/X677 models).......................................910
Removal and replacement: Waste toner duct assembly (X654/X677/6700/6800 models).............931
Removal and replacement: Pre-exposure PCA holder assembly (6700/6800 models).....................940
Removal and replacement: Pre-exposure PCA holder assembly (X654/X677 models) .....................955
Removal and replacement: Toner supply drive assembly (X654/X677 models).......................................970
Removal and replacement: Toner supply assembly (X654/X677 models)....................................................977
Removal and replacement: Toner supply buffer assembly/intermediate pipe (X654/X677
models) .........................................................................................................................................................................................................980
Removal and replacement: Feed assembly (X654/X677 models) .....................................................................989
Removal and replacement: Low-voltage power supply (LVPS).............................................................................995
Removal and replacement: High-voltage power supply (HVPS)........................................................................1002
Removal and replacement: Drive PCA...................................................................................................................................1011
Removal and replacement: Feed/toner supply controller PCA (X654/X677 models).........................1018
Removal and replacement: Right PCA ................................................................................................................................. 1022
Removal and replacement: Rear PCA ..................................................................................................................................1025
Removal and replacement: Environmental sensor PCA.........................................................................................1032
Removal and replacement: Drum home position PCA............................................................................................. 1037
Removal and replacement: Drum motor ............................................................................................................................1044
Removal and replacement: Developer motor.................................................................................................................. 1051
Removal and replacement: Image transfer belt (ITB) motor................................................................................1058
Removal and replacement: Developer alienation motor........................................................................................1065
Removal and replacement: Fuser motor.............................................................................................................................1075
Removal and replacement: Duplex motor.........................................................................................................................1082
Removal and replacement: Power-supply fan ................................................................................................................1089
Removal and replacement: Cartridge fan.........................................................................................................................1096
Removal and replacement: Fuser fan ...................................................................................................................................1103
Removal and replacement: Exhaust fan................................................................................................................................ 1111
5 Input device - 550-sheet paper feeder .............................................................................................................................................................. 1115
Field-replaceable units (FRUs) ........................................................................................................................................................................... 1115
Covers, panels, and doors.......................................................................................................................................................................... 1115
Removal and replacement: Front left cover (550-sheet paper feeder) ......................................................... 1115
Removal and replacement: Front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder) .......................................................1117
Removal and replacement: Right door (550-sheet paper feeder).....................................................................1119
Removal and replacement: Rear cover (550-sheet paper feeder)................................................................... 1122
Removal and replacement: Left cover (550-sheet paper feeder)..................................................................... 1126
Internal parts and assemblies...............................................................................................................................................................1130
Removal and replacement: Pickup assembly (550-sheet paper feeder) ....................................................1130
Removal and replacement: Lifter drive assembly (550-sheet paper feeder) ..........................................1135
Removal and replacement: Pickup drive assembly (550-sheet paper feeder).......................................1140
Removal and replacement: Auto close assembly (550-sheet paper feeder)...........................................1146
Removal and replacement: Media size detection assembly (550-sheet paper feeder).................... 1151
Removal and replacement: Controller PCA (550-sheet paper feeder)..........................................................1157
xviii
Removal and replacement: Separation roller assembly (550-sheet paper feeder).............................1161
Removal and replacement: Pickup roller assembly (550-sheet paper feeder).......................................1163
6 Removal and replacement: 2,100-sheet paper deck...............................................................................................................................1166
Field-replaceable units (FRUs) ..........................................................................................................................................................................1166
Covers, panels, and doors.........................................................................................................................................................................1166
Removal and replacement: Right door (HCI) ....................................................................................................................1166
Removal and replacement: Front left cover/left cover (HCI).................................................................................1168
Removal and replacement: Rear cover (HCI).................................................................................................................... 1171
Removal and replacement: Rear lower cover (HCI)......................................................................................................1173
Internal parts and assemblies................................................................................................................................................................1176
Removal and replacement: Cassette assembly (HCI) ...............................................................................................1176
Removal and replacement: Pickup assembly (HCI)..................................................................................................... 1179
Removal and replacement: Auto close assembly (HCI) ........................................................................................... 1182
Removal and replacement: Lifter drive assembly (HCI)...........................................................................................1186
Removal and replacement: Pickup alienation assembly (HCI)............................................................................1190
Removal and replacement: Pickup drive assembly (HCI)........................................................................................1194
Removal and replacement: Controller PCA (HCI)..........................................................................................................1199
Removal and replacement: Separation roller assembly (HCI) ...........................................................................1204
Removal and replacement: Pickup roller assembly (HCI) ......................................................................................1206
7 Output device - 3-bin staple stacker multi-bin mailbox.........................................................................................................................1209
Field-replaceable units (FRUs) .........................................................................................................................................................................1209
Covers, panels, and doors........................................................................................................................................................................1209
Removal and replacement: Rear cover (3-bin stapler-stacker)..........................................................................1209
Removal and replacement: Staple cover and staple door (3-bin stapler-stacker)................................. 1211
Removal and replacement: Right upper cover (3-bin stapler-stacker) .......................................................... 1214
Removal and replacement: Right corner cover (3-bin stapler-stacker) ........................................................1216
Removal and replacement: Right lower cover (3-bin stapler-stacker) ...........................................................1219
Removal and replacement: Rear inner cover (3-bin stapler-stacker) .............................................................1224
Removal and replacement: Stapler-stacker door assembly (3-bin stapler-stacker)...........................1227
Removal and replacement: Stacking wall assembly (3-bin stapler-stacker)............................................ 1234
Internal parts and assemblies............................................................................................................................................................... 1247
Removal and replacement: Stapler assembly (3-bin stapler-stacker)........................................................... 1247
Removal and replacement: Jogger assembly (3-bin stapler-stacker) ..........................................................1250
Removal and replacement: Output bin 1 (3-bin stapler-stacker)........................................................................ 1255
Removal and replacement: Upper feed assembly (3-bin stapler-stacker)..................................................1257
Removal and replacement: Lower feed assembly (3-bin stapler-stacker).................................................1266
Removal and replacement: Solenoid assembly (3-bin stapler-stacker) ....................................................... 1281
Removal and replacement: MBM fan (3-bin stapler-stacker)...............................................................................1289
Removal and replacement: Stapler-stacker feed motor (3-bin stapler-stacker) ................................... 1292
Removal and replacement: Controller PCA (3-bin stapler-stacker) ................................................................1296
8 Output device - floor-standing staple stacker............................................................................................................................................1299
Field-replaceable units (FRUs) .........................................................................................................................................................................1299
Covers, panels, and doors........................................................................................................................................................................1299
Removal and replacement: Front door (floor-standing stapler-stacker).....................................................1299
Removal and replacement: Upper and lower output bins (floor-standing stapler-stacker) ...........1301
Removal and replacement: Left upper rear cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker) ...........................1303
Removal and replacement: Left lower rear cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker).............................1306
Removal and replacement: Rear cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker)....................................................1308
xix
Removal and replacement: Rear upper cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker) ..................................... 1312
Removal and replacement: MBM front cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker).......................................1318
Removal and replacement: MBM rear cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker)........................................1320
Removal and replacement: MBM top cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker).......................................... 1324
Removal and replacement: MBM output bin (floor-standing stapler-stacker)........................................1330
Removal and replacement: Front inner upper cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker)......................1336
Removal and replacement: Front inner lower cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker).......................1340
Removal and replacement: Front inner cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker) .....................................1343
Removal and replacement: Foot front cover (tall model only) (floor-standing stapler-stacker) ..1348
Removal and replacement: Foot front cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker)........................................ 1352
Removal and replacement: Foot rear cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker) .........................................1355
Removal and replacement: Foot center cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker)....................................1360
Removal and replacement: Foot cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker).....................................................1368
Internal parts and assemblies...............................................................................................................................................................1377
Removal and replacement: Stapler (floor-standing stapler-stacker) .............................................................1377
Removal and replacement: Controller PCA (floor-standing stapler-stacker) ...........................................1381
Removal and replacement: Power supply assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)...................... 1387
Removal and replacement: Height wall upper assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)............1394
Removal and replacement: Height wall lower assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)..............1401
Removal and replacement: Lifter base upper assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) ............1409
Removal and replacement: Lifter base lower assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) ..............1416
Removal and replacement: Delivery assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker).................................. 1423
Removal and replacement: Punch assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker).......................................1435
Removal and replacement: SWB assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)...........................................1447
Removal and replacement: Drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing
stapler-stacker).....................................................................................................................................................................................1462
Removal and replacement: Drum drive assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)............................1470
Removal and replacement: IMF assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker).............................................1484
Removal and replacement: Alignment assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)............................... 1511
xx
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (1 of 9)X654/X677 models........................................................................1568
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (2 of 9)X654/X677 models....................................................................... 1570
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (3 of 9)X654/X677 models........................................................................1572
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (4 of 9)X654/X677 models........................................................................1574
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (5 of 9)X654/X677 models........................................................................1576
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (6 of 9) X654/X677 models.......................................................................1577
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (7 of 9) X654/X677 models...................................................................... 1579
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (8 of 9)X654/X677 models.......................................................................1580
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (9 of 9)X654/X677 models.......................................................................1582
Input devices............................................................................................................................................................................................................................1584
Input device - 550-sheet paper feeder ......................................................................................................................................................1584
Covers, panels, and doors........................................................................................................................................................................1584
Covers, panels, and doors (550-sheet paper feeder)...............................................................................................1584
Internal parts and assemblies..............................................................................................................................................................1585
Internal parts and assemblies (550-sheet paper feeder) .....................................................................................1585
Input device - 2,100-sheet high capacity input (HCI) paper feeder........................................................................................ 1587
Parts and diagrams: HCI covers.......................................................................................................................................................... 1587
Parts and diagrams: HCI main body .................................................................................................................................................1588
Output devices .......................................................................................................................................................................................................................1589
Output device - Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) ...........................................................................................................................1589
Covers, panels, and doors........................................................................................................................................................................1589
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) covers 6800/X677 models .........................1589
Internal parts and assemblies...............................................................................................................................................................1591
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) main body 6800/X677 models (1 of 2).. 1591
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) main body 6800/X677 models (2 of 2).. 1593
Output device - Intermediate paper transfer unit (IPTU)...............................................................................................................1594
Parts and diagrams: Intermediate paper transfer unit 6800/X677 models ........................................................1594
Output device - 3-bin staple stacker............................................................................................................................................................1594
Covers, panels, and doors........................................................................................................................................................................1595
Parts and diagrams: 3 bin staple stacker covers 6800/X677 models ..........................................................1595
Internal parts and assemblies..............................................................................................................................................................1596
Parts and diagrams: 3 bin staple stacker main body 6800/X677 models..................................................1596
Alphabetical parts list........................................................................................................................................................................................................1598
Document feeder / scanner ............................................................................................................................................................................... 1541
Integrated scanner assembly................................................................................................................................................................ 1541
Base printer ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................1543
Control panels ..................................................................................................................................................................................................1543
Control panels .......................................................................................................................................................................................1543
Covers, panels, and doors........................................................................................................................................................................1544
Parts and diagrams: Covers 6700 models........................................................................................................................1544
Parts and diagrams: Covers X654 models.......................................................................................................................1546
Parts and diagrams: Covers 6800 models.......................................................................................................................1548
Parts and diagrams: Covers X677 models........................................................................................................................1550
Internal parts and assemblies.............................................................................................................................................................. 1552
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (1 of 7)6700/6800 models ............................................................ 1552
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (2 of 7)6700/6800 models ...........................................................1555
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (3 of 7)6700/6800 models ...........................................................1558
xxi
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (4 of 7)6700/6800 models ............................................................1561
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (5 of 7)6700/6800 models ...........................................................1563
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (6 of 7)6700/6800 models ...........................................................1564
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (7 of 7)6700/6800 models............................................................1566
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (1 of 9)X654/X677 models.............................................................1568
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (2 of 9)X654/X677 models............................................................ 1570
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (3 of 9)X654/X677 models ............................................................1572
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (4 of 9)X654/X677 models.............................................................1574
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (5 of 9)X654/X677 models ............................................................1576
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (6 of 9) X654/X677 models ...........................................................1577
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (7 of 9) X654/X677 models........................................................... 1579
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (8 of 9)X654/X677 models ...........................................................1580
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (9 of 9)X654/X677 models ...........................................................1582
Input devices.................................................................................................................................................................................................................1584
Input device - 550-sheet paper feeder ...........................................................................................................................................1584
Covers, panels, and doors ............................................................................................................................................................1584
Covers, panels, and doors (550-sheet paper feeder)....................................................................................1584
Internal parts and assemblies...................................................................................................................................................1585
Internal parts and assemblies (550-sheet paper feeder) ..........................................................................1585
Input device - 2,100-sheet high capacity input (HCI) paper feeder............................................................................. 1587
Parts and diagrams: HCI covers............................................................................................................................................... 1587
Parts and diagrams: HCI main body......................................................................................................................................1588
Output devices............................................................................................................................................................................................................1589
Output device - Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS)................................................................................................................1589
Covers, panels, and doors ............................................................................................................................................................1589
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) covers 6800/X677 models..............1589
Internal parts and assemblies....................................................................................................................................................1591
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) main body 6800/X677 models
(1 of 2)..................................................................................................................................................................................................1591
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) main body 6800/X677 models
(2 of 2)................................................................................................................................................................................................1593
Output device - Intermediate paper transfer unit (IPTU)....................................................................................................1594
Parts and diagrams: Intermediate paper transfer unit 6800/X677 models .............................................1594
Output device - 3-bin staple stacker.................................................................................................................................................1594
Covers, panels, and doors ............................................................................................................................................................1595
Parts and diagrams: 3 bin staple stacker covers 6800/X677 models...............................................1595
Internal parts and assemblies...................................................................................................................................................1596
Parts and diagrams: 3 bin staple stacker main body 6800/X677 models ......................................1596
Numerical parts list............................................................................................................................................................................................................. 1622
Document feeder / scanner ............................................................................................................................................................................... 1541
Integrated scanner assembly................................................................................................................................................................ 1541
Base printer ...................................................................................................................................................................................................................1543
Control panels ..................................................................................................................................................................................................1543
Control panels .......................................................................................................................................................................................1543
Covers, panels, and doors........................................................................................................................................................................1544
Parts and diagrams: Covers 6700 models........................................................................................................................1544
Parts and diagrams: Covers X654 models.......................................................................................................................1546
xxii
Parts and diagrams: Covers 6800 models.......................................................................................................................1548
Parts and diagrams: Covers X677 models........................................................................................................................1550
Internal parts and assemblies.............................................................................................................................................................. 1552
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (1 of 7)6700/6800 models ............................................................ 1552
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (2 of 7)6700/6800 models ...........................................................1555
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (3 of 7)6700/6800 models ...........................................................1558
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (4 of 7)6700/6800 models ............................................................1561
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (5 of 7)6700/6800 models ...........................................................1563
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (6 of 7)6700/6800 models ...........................................................1564
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (7 of 7)6700/6800 models............................................................1566
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (1 of 9)X654/X677 models.............................................................1568
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (2 of 9)X654/X677 models............................................................ 1570
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (3 of 9)X654/X677 models ............................................................1572
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (4 of 9)X654/X677 models.............................................................1574
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (5 of 9)X654/X677 models ............................................................1576
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (6 of 9) X654/X677 models ...........................................................1577
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (7 of 9) X654/X677 models........................................................... 1579
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (8 of 9)X654/X677 models ...........................................................1580
Parts and diagrams: Internal assemblies (9 of 9)X654/X677 models ...........................................................1582
Input devices.................................................................................................................................................................................................................1584
Input device - 550-sheet paper feeder ...........................................................................................................................................1584
Covers, panels, and doors ............................................................................................................................................................1584
Covers, panels, and doors (550-sheet paper feeder)....................................................................................1584
Internal parts and assemblies...................................................................................................................................................1585
Internal parts and assemblies (550-sheet paper feeder) ..........................................................................1585
Input device - 2,100-sheet high capacity input (HCI) paper feeder............................................................................. 1587
Parts and diagrams: HCI covers............................................................................................................................................... 1587
Parts and diagrams: HCI main body......................................................................................................................................1588
Output devices............................................................................................................................................................................................................1589
Output device - Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS)................................................................................................................1589
Covers, panels, and doors ............................................................................................................................................................1589
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) covers 6800/X677 models..............1589
Internal parts and assemblies....................................................................................................................................................1591
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) main body 6800/X677 models
(1 of 2)..................................................................................................................................................................................................1591
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) main body 6800/X677 models
(2 of 2)................................................................................................................................................................................................1593
Output device - Intermediate paper transfer unit (IPTU)....................................................................................................1594
Parts and diagrams: Intermediate paper transfer unit 6800/X677 models .............................................1594
Output device - 3-bin staple stacker.................................................................................................................................................1594
Covers, panels, and doors ............................................................................................................................................................1595
Parts and diagrams: 3 bin staple stacker covers 6800/X677 models...............................................1595
Internal parts and assemblies...................................................................................................................................................1596
Parts and diagrams: 3 bin staple stacker main body 6800/X677 models ......................................1596
xxiii
HP Color LaserJet Enterprise 5700, 6700, X557, X55745, X654, X65455, X65465, MFP 5800, 6800, X57945,
X58045, X677, X67755, X67765 WIFI - Supplemental Certificate of Volatility ............................................................................ 1651
Index...........................................................................................................................................................................................................................................................1663
xxiv
List of videos
View a video of how to use the HP Partner First Portal to access WISE........................................................................................................ vii
View a video of how to use WISE to find technical support videos (model number search)......................................................... viii
View a video of how to use WISE to find technical support videos (Product detail page [PDP] search)............................... viii
View a video of cleaning the document feeder glass and flatbed glass......................................................................................................43
View a video that demonstrates how to load paper in a way that reduces the number of paper jams............................. 366
View a video of how to clear a jam in Tray 3, and the optional trays.............................................................................................................. 376
View a video of how to clear a jam in the high-capacity input Tray 4............................................................................................................388
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area............................................................................................................. 395
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area.............................................................................................................398
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area.............................................................................................................400
View a video that demonstrates how to load paper in a way that reduces the number of paper jams............................. 409
xxv
View a video of how to clear a jam in Tray 2...................................................................................................................................................................... 417
View a video of how to clear a jam in Tray 3, and the optional trays..............................................................................................................423
View a video of how to clear a jam in the high-capacity input Tray 4............................................................................................................435
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area............................................................................................................. 442
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area............................................................................................................. 445
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area..............................................................................................................447
View a video of how to clear a jam in the fuser exit area on finisher............................................................................................................ 456
View a video of how to clear a jam in the floor-standing finisher punch area........................................................................................463
View a video of cleaning the document feeder glass and flatbed glass....................................................................................................491
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the image transfer belt...............................................................................534
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the hard-disk drive......................................................................................... 560
xxvi
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the fax PCA..........................................................................................................568
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the USB expansion kit.................................................................................. 576
View a video of removing and replacing the toner cartridges (manual unlock).................................................................................... 737
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the paper pickup assembly......................................................................756
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the lifter drive assembly............................................................................ 822
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the fuser drive assembly........................................................................... 861
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the main drive assembly............................................................................870
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the drive PCA..................................................................................................... 1011
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the rear PCA..................................................................................................... 1025
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the lifter drive assembly........................................................................... 1135
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the pickup drive assembly...................................................................... 1140
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the auto close assembly.......................................................................... 1146
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the media size detection assembly...................................................1151
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the pickup drive assembly...................................................................... 1194
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the upper feed assembly.........................................................................1257
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the lower feed assembly..........................................................................1267
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the upper and lower output bins........................................................ 1301
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the left lower rear cover...........................................................................1306
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the punch assembly................................................................................... 1435
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the SWB assembly....................................................................................... 1447
xxvii
1 Printer information, configurations, and
specifications
Item Description
1 Document feeder
2 Output bin
3 Jam access
4 Input tray
5 Flatbed scanner
Technical specifications
Learn about the document feeder and scanner specifications.
Review the technical specifications for the document feeder and scanner.
Table 1-1 Copy and scan specifications (document feeder and scanner) (1 of 3)
Copies and scans up Not available Not available Not available Not available Not available
to 80 pages per minute
(ppm)
150-page document
feeder with dual-head
scanning for single-
pass duplex copying
and scanning
Table 1-2 Copy and scan specifications (document feeder and scanner) (2 of 3)
Table 1-3 Copy and scan specifications (document feeder and scanner) (3 of 3)
Copies and scans up Not available Not available Not available Not available
to 80 pages per minute
(ppm)
150-page document
feeder with dual-head
scanning for single-
pass duplex copying
and scanning
Technical specifications 3
Information (base printer)
Learn about the base printer.
8 2
3
7
4
6
5
Item Description
1 Control panel with color touchscreen display (tilts up for easier viewing)
2 On/off button
Insert a USB flash drive for printing without a computer or to update the printer firmware.
5 Tray 1 (multipurpose tray) and right door (access for clearing jams)
6 Tray 2
8 Output bin
Item Description
1 Control panel with color touchscreen display (tilts up for easier viewing)
2 On/off button
Insert a USB flash drive for printing or scanning without a computer or to update the printer firmware.
7 Tray 2
9 Front door, for access to the imaging drums and toner collection unit
10 Output bin
1
2
Item Description
3 SuperSpeed USB 3.0 host port (for job storage and private printing)
4 Power connection
13 9
12
10
11
Item Description
4 Control panel with color touchscreen display (tilts up for easier viewing)
Insert a USB flash drive for printing or scanning without a computer or to update the printer firmware.
6 Convenience stapler
7 On/off button
11 Optional Tray 4
12 Optional Tray 3
13 Tray 2
Item Description
4 Control panel with color touchscreen display (tilts up for easier viewing)
Insert a USB flash drive for printing or scanning without a computer or to update the printer firmware.
6 Convenience stapler
7 On/off button
12 Tray 3
13 Tray 2
13 13
Item Description
4 Control panel with color touchscreen display (tilts up for easier viewing)
Insert a USB flash drive for printing or scanning without a computer or to update the printer firmware.
6 Convenience stapler
7 Hardware integration pocket (HIP) for connecting accessory and third-party devices
9 On/off button
13 Optional Tray 4
14 Optional Tray 3
15 Tray 2
17 Front door, for access to the imaging drums and toner collection unit
18 Output bin
19 Hardware integration pocket (HIP) location for models with an inner finisher
Item Description
4 Control panel with color touchscreen display (tilts up for easier viewing)
Insert a USB flash drive for printing or scanning without a computer or to update the printer firmware.
6 Convenience stapler
7 Hardware integration pocket (HIP) for connecting accessory and third-party devices
8 On/off button
13 Tray 3
14 Tray 2
16 Front door, for access to the imaging drums and toner collection unit
Item Description
3 Fax models only: Telephone "line out" port (for attaching an extension phone, answering machine, or other
device)
4 SuperSpeed USB 3.0 host port (for job storage and private printing)
5 Fax models only: Fax "line in" port (for attaching the fax phone line to the printer)
6 Power connection
● FutureSmart 5 firmware
● HP Web JetAdmin
● 2 GB RAM memory
● FutureSmart 5 firmware
● HP Web JetAdmin
● 6800zf, 6800zfsw, 6800zfw+, 6801zfsw, 6801zfw+: 256.5 mm (10.1 in) color touchscreen control panel
● 6 GB RAM memory
● X677dn, X677zs, X677z+, X67755dn, X67755zs, and X67755z+: 55/52 pages per minute (letter/A4)
● X677dn, X67755dn, and X67765dn: 203 mm (8 in) color touchscreen control panel
● X677zs, X677z+, X67755zs, X67755z+, X67765zs, and X67765z+: 256.5 mm (10.1 in) color touchscreen
control panel
● 6700dn - #6QN33A
● 6701dn - #58M42A
Dual-band Wireless
Prints 52 pages per minute (ppm) on A4 and Not included Available option on the
55 ppm on letter-size paper, with a maximum of 6700
61 ppm on A4 and 65 ppm on letter-size paper
(configured at time of purchase)
Prints 61 ppm on A4 and 65 ppm on letter-size Not included Included for the 6701
paper
32 GB embedded Multi-Media Controller (eMMC) Not available Not available Available option
● X654dn - #6QQ00A
● X65455dn - #49L02A
● X65465dn - #49L04A
Printer stand with storage compartment Optional Optional Optional Available option
2,100-sheet High Capacity Paper Tray/ Optional Optional Optional Available option
Stand
Prints 52 pages per minute (ppm) on A4 Not included Not included Available option
and 55 ppm on letter-size paper, with a
maximum of 61 ppm on A4 and 65 ppm
on letter-sized paper (configured at time
of purchase)
Prints 52 pages per minute (ppm) on A4 Not included Not included Not applicable
and 55 ppm on letter-size paper
Prints 61 ppm on A4 and 65 ppm on Not included Not included Not applicable
letter-sized paper
32 GB embedded Multi-Media Controller Not available Not available Not available Available option
(eMMC)
512 GB FIPS Hard Disk Drive Optional Optional Optional Available option
Custom color printer skins Not available Not available Not available Available option
● 6800dn - #6QN35A
● 6800zf - #6QN36A
● 6800zfsw - #6QN37A
● 6800zfw+ - #6QN38A
● 6801zfsw - #76H10A
● 6801zfw+ - #76H11A
Paper handling features 6800dn 6800zf 6800zfsw 6800zfw+ 6801zfsw 6801zfw+ 6800
Configurabl
e
Tray 2 (550-sheet
capacity)
Printer stand with storage Optional Optional Not Not Not Not Available
compartment available available available available option
Paper handling features 6800dn 6800zf 6800zfsw 6800zfw+ 6801zfsw 6801zfw+ 6800
Configurabl
e
Hardware integration
pocket (HIP) for
connecting accessory
and third-party devices
Prints up to 52 pages
per minute (ppm) on A4
and 55 ppm on letter-sized
paper, with a maximum
of 61 ppm on A4 and
65 ppm on letter-sized
paper (configured at time
of purchase)
Copy and scan features 6800dn 6800zf 6800zfsw 6800zfw+ 6801zfsw 6801zfw+ 6800
Configurabl
e
ADF copy/scan speed 160 Not Not Not Not Not Available
images-per-minute (ipm) included included included included included option
single-sided, and 80 ipm
double-sided
150-page document
feeder with dual-head
scanning for single-pass
duplex copying and
scanning
6 GB base memory
256 GB Solid-state drive Optional Optional Optional Optional Optional Optional Available
option
512 GB FIPS Hard Disk Optional Optional Optional Optional Optional Optional Available
Drive option
HP Trusted Platform
Module for encrypting all
data that passes through
the printer
● X677zs - #6QQ02A
● X677z+ - #6QQ03A
● X67755dn - #49K86A
● X67755zs - #49K87A
● X67755z+ - #49K88A
● X67765dn - #49K90A
● X67765zs - #49K91A
● X67765z+ - #49K92A
Paper handling features X677dn X677zs X677z+ X67755dn X67755zs X67755z+ X677
Configurabl
X67765dn X67765zs X67765z+ e
Tray 2 (550-sheet
capacity)
Printer stand with storage Optional Not Not Optional Not Not Available
compartment available available available available option
Prints up to 52 pages per minute (ppm) Not included Not included Available option
on A4 and 55 ppm on letter-sized paper,
with a maximum of 61 ppm on A4 and 65
ppm on letter-sized paper (configured at
time of purchase)
Prints up to 52 pages per minute (ppm) Not included Not included Available option
on A4 and 55 ppm on letter-sized paper
Prints up to 61 pages per minute (ppm) Not included Not included Available option
on A4 and 65 ppm on letter-sized paper
Inline scan bar analyzes output for print Included on z+ Included on z+ Included on z+ Available option
quality issues models models models
ADF copy/scan speed 160 images-per- Not included Not included Available option
minute (ipm) single-sided, and 80 ipm
double-sided
ADF copy/scan speed 220 ipm single- Not included Available option
sided, and 110 ipm double-sided
6 GB base memory
512 GB FIPS Hard Disk Drive Optional Optional Optional Available option
32 GB embedded Multi-Media Controller Not available Not available Not available Available option
(eMMC)
Small color touchscreen control panel Not included Not included Available option
Custom color printer skins Not available Not available Not available Available option
Printer dimensions
Make sure your printer environment is large enough to accommodate the printer.
1 1
2 2
3
3
Printer dimensions
Make sure your printer environment is large enough to accommodate the printer.
1 1
2 2
3
3
Printer dimensions 25
Table 1-23 Dimensions for the printer
Printer dimensions
Make sure your printer environment is large enough to accommodate the printer.
2
2
3
3
Printer dimensions 27
Figure 1-18 Printer dimensions (zfw+ models)
1
2
2
3
3
Printer dimensions
Make sure your printer environment is large enough to accommodate the printer.
3
3
Printer dimensions 29
Table 1-29 Dimensions for the printer (z model)
3
3
2
2
3
3
HP recommends that 30 mm ( (1.81 in)) be added to the printer dimensions to make sure there is
sufficient space to open doors and covers, and to provide proper ventilation. See the printer dimensions
sections in this manual.
CAUTION: Power requirements are based on the country/region where the printer is sold. Do not
convert operating voltages. This will damage the printer and void the printer warranty.
5 4
Number Description
1 Connector
2 Lock
4 Tray cassette
5 Left cover
6 Lock lever
Technical specifications
Table 1-33 550-sheet paper feeder technical specifications
Feature Specification
Media types Plain paper, recycled paper, heavy paper, bond paper, glossy paper, label, and index
card
Custom maximum: 215.9 mm (8.5 in) (W) x 355.6 mm (14 in) (L)
Media weights Non-glossy paper: 60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 163 g/m2 (43 lb)
Glossy paper: 120 g/m2 (32 lb) to 200 g/m2 (53 lb)
Capacity 55 mm (2.2 in) stack (approximately 550 sheets of 75g/m2 (20 lb) paper)
Feature Specification
5 2
Number Description
1 Connector
2 Lock
3 Right door
4 HCI cassette
5 Lock lever
Technical specifications
Table 1-34 HCI paper feeder technical specifications
Feature Specification
Media types Plain paper, recycled paper, heavy paper, and bond paper
Capacity 210 mm (8.3 in) stack (approximately 2,100 sheets of 75g/m2 (20 lb) paper)
1
3
Number Description
1 Stapler-stacker door
2 Staple door
3 Output bin 2
4 Output bin 1
5 Jogger guide
Technical specifications
Table 1-35 3-bin stapler-stacker technical specifications
Feature Specification
Media types Plain paper, recycled paper, heavy paper, bond paper, and glossy paper
Media sizes, output bin 1 Stack mode: 148 mm (5.8 in) (W) x 210 mm (8.3 in) (L) to 216 mm (8.5 in) (W) x 355 mm
(14 in) (L)
Media sizes, output bin 2 Stack mode: 148 mm (5.8 in) (W) x 210 mm (8.3 in) (L) to 216 mm (8.5 in) (W) x 355 mm
(14 in) (L)
Media weights, output bin 1 Stack mode/job offset mode, non-glossy paper: 60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 163 g/m2 (43 lb)
Stack mode/job offset mode, glossy paper: 120 g/m2 (32 lb) to 200 g/m2 (53 lb)
Staple mode, non-glossy paper: 60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 120 g/m2 (32 lb)
Feature Specification
Media weights, output bin 2 Stack mode, non-glossy paper: 60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 163 g/m2 (43 lb)
Stack mode, glossy paper: 120 g/m2 (32 lb) to 200 g/m2 (53 lb)
Capacity, output bin 1 Stack mode/job offset mode: 48 mm (1.9 in) stack (approximately 400 sheets of 75
g/m2 (20 lb) paper)
Staple mode: 48 mm (1.9 in) stack (approximately 6 sets of 50 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20
lb) paper)
Capacity, output bin 2 Stack mode: 19 mm (0.75 in) stack (approximately 100 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb) paper)
Capacity, stapler Up to 50 sheets (60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 120 g/m2 (32 lb) paper)
1
3
Number Description
1 Connector
2 Front door
3 Output bin 4
4 Output bin 3
5 Output bin 2
Technical specifications
Table 1-36 Floor-standing stapler=stacker technical specifications
Feature Specification
Media types, output bin 1 Plain paper, recycled paper, heavy paper, bond paper, glossy paper, label, and index
card
Media types, output bins 2 and 4 Plain paper, recycled paper, heavy paper, bond paper, and glossy paper
Media types, output bin 3 Plain paper, recycled paper, heavy paper, bond paper, glossy paper, and index card
Media sizes, output bin 1 Stack mode: 76 mm (3 in) (W) x 127 mm (5 in) (L) to 216 mm (8.5 in) (W) x 355 mm (14 in)
(L)
Feature Specification
Media sizes, output bin 2 Stack mode: 148 mm (5.8 in) (W) x 210 mm (8.3 in) (L) to 216 mm (8.5 in) (W) x 355 mm
(14 in) (L)
Media sizes, output bin 3 Stack mode: 101 mm (4 in) (W) x 152 mm (6 in) (L) to 216 mm (8.5 in) (W) x 355 mm (14 in)
(L)
Job offset mode: A5-R, B5, A4, Executive, Letter, and Legal
Media sizes, output bin 4 Stack mode: 148 mm (5.8 in) (W) x 210 mm (8.3 in) (L) to 216 mm (8.5 in) (W) x 355 mm
(14 in) (L)
Job offset mode: A5-R, B5, A4, Executive, Letter, and Legal
Media weights, output bin 1 Stack mode: 60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 216 g/m2 (80 lb)
Media weights, output bin 2 Stack mode, non-glossy paper: 60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 163 g/m2 (43 lb)
Stack mode, glossy paper: 120 g/m2 (32 lb) to 200 g/m2 (53 lb)
Media weights, output bin 3 Stack mode/job offset mode: 60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 216 g/m2 (80 lb)
Media weights, output bin 4 Stack mode/job offset mode: 60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 216 g/m2 (80 lb)
Staple mode, non-glossy paper: 60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 163 g/m2 (43 lb)
Capacity, output bin 1 Stack mode: 19 mm (0.75 in) stack (approximately 100 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb) paper)
Capacity, output bin 2 Stack mode: 30 mm (1.2 in) stack (approximately 200 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb) paper)
Capacity, output bin 3 Stack mode/job offset mode: 131 mm (5.2 in) stack (approximately 1,100 sheets of 75
g/m2 (20 lb) paper)
Capacity, output bin 4 Stack mode/job offset mode: 210 mm (8.3 in) stack (approximately 1,900 sheets of
75g/m2 (20 lb) paper)
Staple mode: 210 mm (8.3 in) stack (approximately 36 sets of 50 sheets of 75 g/m2
(20 lb) paper)
Capacity, stapler Up to 50 sheets (60 g/m2 (16 lb) to 120 g/m2 (32 lb) paper)
Stapling position Square binding: binding in one place (upper left, lower left, upper right, lower right)
Edge binding: 2-place binding (left edge, right edge), 3-place binding (left edge, right
edge)
Feature Specification
Number Description
1 Connector
2 Output bin
Technical specifications
Table 1-37 IPTU technical specifications
Feature Specification
Feature Specification
Clean the pickup rollers and separation pad in the document feeder (MFP)
Learn about cleaning the document feeder rollers and pads.
Over time, specks of debris might collect on the document feeder rollers and pads which can affect
performance.
NOTE: The figures in this topic show a typical MFP printer. However, the procedure is correct for all
MFP printers.
1. . Open the document-feeder cover. Figure 2-1 Open the document-feeder cover
2. . Remove any visible lint or dust from each Figure 2-2 Clean the document feeder rollers
of the feed rollers and the separation pad
using compressed air or a clean lint-free cloth
moistened with warm water. Carefully rotate the
roller as you clean it.
View a video of cleaning the document feeder glass and flatbed glass.
1. Press the power button to turn the printer off, and then disconnect the power cable from the
electrical outlet.
3. Clean the scanner glass (callout 1) and the document feeder strips (callout 2, callout 3) with a soft
cloth or sponge that has been moistened with nonabrasive glass cleaner.
CAUTION: Do not use abrasives, acetone, benzene, ammonia, ethyl alcohol, or carbon
tetrachloride on any part of the printer; these can damage the printer. Do not place liquids directly
on the glass or platen. They might seep and damage the printer.
NOTE: If you are having trouble with streaks on copies when you are using the document feeder,
be sure to clean the small strips of glass on the left side of the scanner (callout 2, callout 3).
4. Dry the glass and white plastic parts with a chamois or a cellulose sponge to prevent spotting.
6. Connect the power cable to an outlet, and then press the power button to turn the printer on.
Base printer 45
4. . Hold both ends of the toner cartridge and rock
it back and forth end to end to evenly distribute
the toner that is inside.
1. Open Tray 1.
3. Push the pickup roller assembly to the right and then away from the printer.
6. Clean the Tray 1 pickup and separation rollers. Use a damp, lint-free cloth to gently clean the rollers.
CAUTION: Do not touch the spongy portion of the roller. Skin oils on the roller can cause paper-
handling and print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves or thoroughly
washing your hands before handling the assembly.
8. Push down on the Tray 1 separation roller until it snaps into place.
9. Insert the keyed right end of the pickup roller assembly into the provided slot, and then rotate the
left end into place to install it.
2. Slide the blue lever (callout 1) to the right, and then remove the separation roller assembly (callout 2)
by pulling it out from the printer.
3. Locate the pickup roller assembly, and then pull it away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: As the roller assembly can be hard to grip, you might need to reach under and behind the
rollers to securely grip it.
CAUTION: Skin oils on the roller can cause paper-handling and print-quality problems. HP
recommends using disposable gloves or thoroughly washing your hands before handling the
assembly.
4. Clean the Tray 2 pickup and separation rollers. Use a damp, lint-free cloth to gently clean the rollers.
6. Insert the separation roller assembly into the printer to install it.
Theory of operation 57
Document feeder / scanner
Learn about the printer document feeder and scanner components.
The document feeder will not function when the document feeder cover is open. The paper path is
incomplete if the document feeder cover is lifted from the glass.
When the printer duplex scans from the document feeder, the paper moves through one time, because
the document feeder has a contact image sensor (CIS) scanner for side two which is scanned
simultaneously with side one.
NOTE: Duplex scanning is model specific. Some printer models might not support duplex scanning
and printing.
The standard operation of the document feeder consists of the standby (paper loading) mode, pick, feed,
and lift steps:
In standby mode, the lift plate is in the down position. When a document is loaded into the input tray,
the paper-present sensor detects its presence.
When a copy/scan is initiated, the document feeder motor engages the gear train and raises the lift
plate until the document makes contact with the pick roller. The document feeder then begins the
pick, feed, and lower sequence.
● Pick
The pick roller rotates and moves one or more sheets forward into the document feeder where
the sheets engage with the separation roller. The separation roller contacts the document feeder
separation pad, which separates multiple sheets into a single sheet.
● Feed
The single sheet continues through the document feeder paper path (aided by the pre-scan rollers)
until the leading edge of the page activates the top-of-form sensor. Activation of this sensor initiates
the scan process, and the scanner acquires the image as the document moves over the document
feeder glass. The post-scan rollers then eject the sheet into the output area. The pick and feed steps
are repeated as long as paper is detected by the paper-present sensor.
● Home
When the top-of-form sensor detects the trailing edge of the last page, the last sheet is ejected and
the motor turns on a sequence that rests the separation floor back down in standby mode, which
allows it to detect when more media is loaded.
● CIS scanner
The CIS (contact image sensor) scanner captures an image using the printer's optical path. Red,
green, and blue LEDs sequentially illuminate a small strip of the document (often called a raster line),
and the optical system captures each color in a single row of CCD sensors that cover the entire
page width. Because only one color is captured for each line per exposure, the three colors are
recombined electronically to create the full color image. For monochromatic scans or copies, all
three LEDs are illuminated to create a white light for the scan so the raster line can be captured in
one exposure.
The drive system moves the CIS scanner along the document length to create the image. In this
printer, the drive system consists of a small DC motor with an optical encoder, a drive belt, and
a guide rod. The speed of the drive system is proportional to the scan resolution (300 ppi is
much faster than 1200 ppi) and also proportional to the type of scan (color scans are slower than
monochromatic scans).
The formatter processes the scanner data into either a copy or a scan to the computer. For copies,
the image data is sent directly to the printer without being transmitted to the computer. Depending
on user selections for the copy settings, the formatter enhances the scanner data significantly
before sending it to the printer. Image data is captured at 300 ppi for copies and is user selectable
for scans to the computer. Each pixel is represented by 8 bits for each of the three colors (256 levels
for each color), for a total of 24 bits per pixel (24-bit color).
Basic operation
Learn about the basic operation of the printer.
The printer routes all high-level processes through the formatter, which stores font information,
processes the print image, and communicates with the host computer.
● Engine-control system
● Laser/scanner system
● Image-formation system
● Integrated scanner assembly (document feeder and sub-scanner assembly) (not shown)
Sequence of operation
Learn about the printer sequence of operation.
The DC controller PCA controls the operating sequence, as described in the following table.
Waiting From the time the power is turned on, the door is ● Heats the fuser roller in the fuser
closed, or when the printer exits sleep mode until
the printer is ready for printing. ● Pressurizes the fuser film
Standby From the end of the waiting sequence, the ● Is in the Ready state
last rotation until the formatter receives a print
command, or until the printer is turned off. ● Enters Sleep mode if the formatter sends the
sleep command
Initial rotation From the time the formatter receives a print ● Rotates each motor
command until the paper enters the paper path.
● Rotates each fan
Printing From the time the first sheet of paper enters the ● Forms the image on the photosensitive drums
paper path until the last sheet has passed through
the fuser. ● Transfers the toner to the paper
Last rotation From the time the last sheet of paper exits the fuser ● Moves the last printed sheet into the output
until the motors stop rotating. bin
Sequence of operation 61
Formatter-control system
Learn about how the formatter operates.
CAUTION: Under NO circumstances should a formatter from a different printer be installed during
the repair or troubleshooting processes. The formatter stores important data specific to the model of
printer it is installed in and is not deigned to be swapped or repurposed in any way. Return a used
formatter to HP.
● Serial number, product number, product name, page count, and supported cartridges information
change and might make a product unusable
If a used formatter is installed and causes this issue, the partner must cover the costs of the repair in
the form of a product replacement. There is no method in the field to recover a printer where a used
formatter is installed.
IMPORTANT: When a formatter PCA or DC controller is replaced a pairing operation must be
completed to make the printer functional.
● Receives and processes print data from the various printer inputs
● Monitors control panel functions and relaying printer status information through the control panel
and the network or bi-directional interface
● Develops and coordinates data placement and timing with the DC controller PCA
● Communicates with the host computer through the network or the bidirectional interface
The formatter receives a print job from the network or bidirectional interface and separates it into image
information and instructions that control the printing process. The DC controller PCA synchronizes the
image formation system with the paper input and output systems, and then signals the formatter to
send the print image data.
Power management
Learn about printer power management.
Power management conserves power after the printer has been idle for an adjustable length of time.
When the printer is in sleep mode, the control-panel back-light is turned off, but the printer retains all
printer settings, downloaded fonts, and macros. Power management can be modified or turned off from
the control-panel menus.
The printer exits sleep mode and enters the warm-up cycle when any of the following occurs.
● A print job, valid data, or a PML or PJL command is received at the serial port.
● Connecting an operational live network Ethernet cable or fax line (fax models).
● Inserting a USB drive in either the front USB port or the USB port on the back of the device.
TIP: Error messages override the sleep delay message. The printer enters sleep mode at the
selected time, but the error message continues to appear.
Set the sleep timer and configure the printer to use 1 watt or less of power
The sleep settings affect how much power the printer uses, the wake/sleep time, how quickly the printer
enters sleep mode, and how quickly the printer wakes up from sleep mode.
To configure the printer to use 1 watt or less of power while in sleep mode, enter the time for the Sleep
after Inactivity setting.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select Settings.
● General
● Energy Settings
● Sleep Settings
3. Select Sleep after Inactivity to specify the number of minutes the printer is inactive before it enters
sleep mode. Enter the appropriate time period.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, navigate to the Settings application, and then
select the Settings icon.
a. General
b. Energy Settings
c. Sleep Schedule
Set the sleep timer and configure the printer to use 1 watt or less of power 63
3. Select the New Event button, and then select the type of event to schedule: Wake Event or Sleep
Event.
4. For a wake or sleep event, configure the time and the days of the week for the event. Select Save to
save the setting.
PJL is an integral part of printer configuration, in addition to the standard PCL and PostScript (PS). With
standard cabling, the printer can use PJL to perform a variety of functions.
● Dynamic I/O switching: The printer can be configured with a host on each I/O by using dynamic
I/O switching. Even when the printer is offline, it can receive data from more than one I/O
simultaneously, until the I/O buffer is full.
● Context-sensitive switching: The printer can automatically recognize the personality (PS or PCL) of
each job and configure itself to serve that personality.
● Isolation of print environment settings from one print job to the next: For example, if a print job is
sent to the printer in landscape mode, the subsequent print jobs print in landscape only if they are
formatted for landscape printing.
Control panel
Learn about the control panel.
The formatter sends and receives printer status and command data to and from the control panel.
Walk-up USB
Learn about the walk-up USB function.
This printer features printing from a USB flash drive. This printer supports printing the following types of
files from the USB flash drive.
● .jpg
● ps and .PS
When a USB flash drive is inserted into the front of the printer, the control panel will display the USB
Flash Drive menu. The files present on the USB flash drive can be accessed from the control panel.
NOTE: The USB flash drive must be formatted using the FAT32 format. Drives formatted with NTFS
will not work.
The low-end data model (LEDM) provides one consistent data representation method and defines the
dynamic and capabilities tickets shared between clients and devices, as well as the access protocol,
event, security, and discovery methods.
CPU
Learn about the printer microprocessor.
Input/output (I/O)
Learn about printer I/O functionality.
NOTE: Some of the following printer I/O functions are model specific. For example, not all printer
models have a fax function.
Walk-up USB
The printer includes a Hi-Speed USB 2.0 front port for walkup USB printing.
10/100/1000 networking
The printer includes a 10/100/1000 network (Ethernet) connection.
Fax
The printer includes a fax phone line connection.
NOTE: Fax models only. For some fax model printers, the telephone extension port is plugged and not
operational.
Wireless
Wireless products contain a wireless card to enable 802.11b/g/n wireless communication with dual band
support for 2.4Ghz and 5 Ghz.
Memory
Learn about printer memory functionality.
NOTE: Some of the following printer memory functions are model specific. For example, not all printer
models have Flash memory.
NOTE: For more information about a specific printer model, see the Printer information,
configurations, and specifications section in the service manual.
Flash memory
NAND: Stores fax memory.
● SFP: 1.25 GB
● MFP: 1.5 GB
NOTE: MEt is available only in PCL mode; it is not functional when printing in PS mode.
Engine-control unit
Learn about the engine control unit.
● DC controller
● Fuser control
DC controller
Learn about the DC controller.
The DC controller controls the operation of the printer and its components. The DC controller starts the
printer operation when the printer power is turned on and the power supply sends DC voltage to the
DC controller. After the printer enters the standby period, the DC controller sends out various signals to
operate motors, solenoids, and other printer components based on the print command and image data
that the host computer sends.
DC controller 67
Figure 3-3 DC controller diagram
Fan
Motor
Solenoid
Photointerrupter
Motor
Fan Clutch
Solenoid
LED
Switch
Photointerrupter
Photointerrupter
Cartridge DC controller
(Y/M/C/K) High-voltage Sensor
power supply
LED
T2 roller
Input accessory
ITB ass’y
Switch
Control panel
Fan
Low-voltage
AC input power supply
Formatter
Sensor
DC controller 69
Table 3-2 Printer electrical components (continued)
Photo interrupter OUT_FULL_SNS FD1 media full sensor, fuser output sensor
Photo interrupter TCU_FULL_SNS ITB toner collection unit near full sensor
Photo interrupter CAC_SNS (1st) (X654/X677 Cartridge release unit home position sensor Y
models only)
Photo interrupter CAC_SNS (2nd) (X654/ Cartridge release unit home position sensor M
X677 models only)
Photo interrupter CAC_SNS (5rd) (X654/ Cartridge release unit home position sensor C
X677 models only)
Photo interrupter CAC_SNS (4th) (X654/ Cartridge release unit home position sensor K
X677 models only)
Motors
Learn about the printer motors.
The printer uses several motors for the paper-feed and image-formation processes.
Motors 71
Table 3-3 Motors
● Magenta developer
● Cyan developer
● Black developer
● Registration roller
SCN_MTR_34st
Fans
Learn about the printer fans.
The printer has three fans for preventing the temperature from rising in the printer and for cooling the
printed pages.
CRG_FAN Cartridge fan Around the toner cartridges Intake Variable (full/95%/75%)
PS_FAN Power supply fan Around the low-voltage power Intake Variable (full/half)
supply unit
The low-voltage power supply converts the AC power into the DC voltage that the printer components
use.
Fans 73
Figure 3-4 Low-voltage power supply
AC input
Fuse
FU401 (100V)
Fuser DC controller
Fuse
FU401 (200V)
Fuse
FU101
+3.3VM +3.3VB
+3.3V +5VC
generation FET FET
circuit
+3.3VB2
Rectifying FSRPS_CLK
circuit FET
+24VA
Protection
circuit
The low-voltage power supply converts the AC power into three DC voltages, which it then subdivides, as
described in the following table.
+3.3V +3.3VA ON ON ON
Over-current/over-voltage protection
Learn about LVPS protections.
The low-voltage power supply automatically stops supplying the DC voltage to the printer components
whenever it detects excessive current or abnormal voltage. The low-voltage power supply has a
protective circuit against over-current and over-voltage to prevent failures in the power supply circuit.
CAUTION: If DC voltage is not being supplied from the low-voltage power supply, the protective
function might be running. In this case, turn the power switch off and unplug the power cord.
Do not turn the power switch on until the root cause is found and corrected.
If the protective function is active, the DC controller notifies the formatter of a low-voltage power
supply failure. In addition, the low-voltage power supply has two fuses to protect against over-current. If
over-current flows into the AC line, the fuse stops the AC power.
For the customer and service technician safety, the printer has a function to stop +24VB power when the
24V interlock switch is turned off. This stops the DC power supply to the following loads.
● Fuser motor
● Pickup motor
The remote switch control circuit turns on or off the printer power so that the AC power flows even if the
power switch is turned off. Unplug the printer power cord before disassembling the printer.
Over-current/over-voltage protection 75
Table 3-6 Low-voltage power supply functions
Function Description
Active OFF Inactive OFF is a state that the power supply is OFF.
Inactive OFF Active OFF is a state of sleep. The low-voltage power supply is output only to formatter and DC
controller.
Low-voltage power supply When +24V is supplied from the low-voltage power supply, the DC controller always monitors
failure detection output status of 24VA. The DC controller determines it as low-voltage power supply malfunction
if 24VA would not become the specified value at the specified timing. When the DC controller
monitors AC voltage input from inlet, it also determines it as low-voltage power supply
malfunction if AC voltage input from inlet would not reach the specified voltage.
The DC controller controls the high-voltage power supply to generate high-voltage biases. The high-
voltage power supply generates the high-voltage biases that are applied to the following components:
T1 roller
T2 roller
Y M C K
DC controller
Fuser control
Learn about the fuser control process.
The fuser heater control circuit and the fuser safety circuit control the fuser temperature based on the
commands from the DC controller. The printer uses an on-demand fusing method. There are two types
of fusers, a conventional ODF fuser and a zone-heated A2ODF fuser in which a heater is divided into
seven zones.
Fuser control 77
Figure 3-6 ODF fuser control
H1,H2
FU1
Pressure roller
TH2
H1 Fuser main heater Heats the fuser film (Letter width compatible)
H2 Fuser sub heater Heats the fuser film (A4 width compatible)
TH1 Main thermistor Detects the center temperature of the fuser film (contact type)
TH2 Sub thermistor 1 Detects the temperature at one end of the fuser heater (contact
type)
TH3 Sub thermistor 2 Detects the temperature at one end of the fuser heater (contact
type)
FU1 Thermal fuse Prevents an abnormal temperature rise of fuser heater (non-contact
type)
Fuser film
Zone 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Table 3-8
Fuser control 79
Table 3-8 (continued)
TH11 Main thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 1 (built-in type)
TH21 Main thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 2 (built-in type)
TH41 Main thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 4 (built-in type)
TH51 Main thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 5 (built-in type)
TH71 Main thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 7 (built-in type)
TH22 Sub thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 2 (built-in type)
TH32 Sub thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 3 (built-in type)
TH4R Sub thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 4 (built-in type)
TH4F Sub thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 4 (built-in type)
TH52 Sub thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 5 (built-in type)
TH62 Sub thermistor Detects the temperature of the fuser zone 6 (built-in type)
TH31 Sub thermistor Detects the excursion of the fuser heater (built-in type)
AC input
DC controller
Zero crossing /ZEROX
detection
circuit
Fuser
FSAFE4
SUB_TH2 FSAFE3
TH3
MAITN_TH FSAFE2
TH1
SUB_TH1 FSAFE1
TH2
+24VBRL
+24VB
FU1
H1, H2
Pressure roller
Fuser control 81
Figure 3-9 A2ODF fuser control block diagram
AC input
DC controller
Zero crossing /ZEROX
detection
circuit
Fuser
+24VBRL
+24VB
TP1
FSAFE4
TH FSAFE3
FSAFE2
H1-7
TH1-7 FSAFE1
Pressure roller
The fuser heater protective function detects an excessive temperature rise of the fuser and interrupts
power supply to the fuser heater. The printer has the following protective functions to prevent the fuser
heater from excessive rising temperature.
● DC controller: The DC controller constantly monitors the temperature of the thermistor. The DC
controller stops the FUSER HEATER CONTROL signal output and turns off the relays (RL401/RL402)
to interrupt power supply to the fuser heater when it detects an excessive temperature.
● Thermal fuse (ODF fuser): Contact of the thermal fuse opens and it interrupts power supply to the
fuser heater when the temperature of the fuser heater is abnormally high.
● Thermoswitch (A2ODF fuser): The contact of the thermoswitch breaks to interrupt power supply to
the fuser heater when the temperature of the fuser heater is abnormally high.
The DC controller controls the laser scanner system by following the instruction from the formatter.
The DC controller formats the latent electrostatic image on the surface of photosensitive drum by
controlling the components of the laser scanner system as dictated by the VIDEO signals.
● Laser assembly
● Scanner mirror
NOTE: The printer has one laser scanner assembly each for yellow, magenta, cyan, and black.
Photosensitive drum
Laser ass’y
C
BD sensor
Laser ass’y
K
Scanner mirror
DC controller
BD failure detection No
The printer has door interlock switches. In the case that one of the following doors opens, the interlock
switches stop output to the laser for the user or service technician’s safety.
● Front door
Image-formation process
Learn about the image-formation process.
The DC controller controls the image-formation system according to commands from the formatter. The
DC controller controls the internal components of the image-formation system to form the toner image
on the photosensitive drum surface. The toner image is then transferred to the print media and fused.
The system consists of the following components:
● Toner cartridges
● Fuser
Fuser
ITB
T1 roller
T2 roller
Y M C K
Cartridge
DC controller
Image-formation process 85
Figure 3-12 Image-formation system motors
Y M C K
DC controller
TCU_FULL
DRM_HP123
T1_HP DRM_HP4
RD1
RD2
Y M C K MS
DEV_HP
ENV
DC controller
Light from the pre-exposure LED strikes the surface of the photosensitive drum to remove any residual
electrical charges from the drum surface.
LED
Photosensitive drum
To prepare for latent image formation, the surface of the photosensitive drum is charged with a uniform
negative charge. The primary charging roller receives the primary charging bias, and then the roller
charges the drum by direct contact.
Photosensitive drum
The laser beam strikes the photosensitive drum to neutralize the negative charge on the portions of the
drum surface where the image will form. An electrostatic latent image forms where the negative charge
was neutralized. The neutralized areas on the drum are ready to accept toner.
Step 4: Development
Learn about the image formation development step.
A developing bias is applied to the developing roller. The toner acquires a negative charge as a result
of the friction from the developing roller rotating against the developing blade. Because the negatively
charged surface of the photosensitive drums were neutralized where they have been struck by the laser
beam, the toner adheres to those areas on the drums. The latent image becomes visible on the surface
of the drum.
Developer roller
Developer blade
Developing bias
Photosensitive drum
The toner on the photosensitive drum is transferred to the ITB. T1 bias is applied to the T1 roller to charge
the ITB positive. The ITB attracts the negatively charged toner from the surface of each photosensitive
drum. The complete toner image forms on the ITB.
Step 4: Development 89
Figure 3-18 Primary transfer
Photosensitive
drum
ITB
T1 roller
T1 bias
The paper acquires a positive charge from the secondary-transfer roller, and attracts the negatively
charged toner from the surface of the ITB. The complete toner image transfers onto the paper.
ITB
Paper
T2 roller
T2 bias
Step 7: Separation
Learn about the image formation separation step.
The stiffness of the paper causes it to separate from the ITB as the ITB bends. The static-charge
eliminator removes excess charge from the paper for stable paper feeding and print quality.
ITB
Paper
Static charge eliminator
T2 roller
Step 8: Fusing
Learn about the image formation fusing step.
The printer uses an on-demand fusing method to adhere the toner image onto the page. As the page
passes through the heated and pressurized rollers in the fuser the toner melts onto the page. The toner
image is now permanently fused to the page. A fusing bias applied to the pressure roller improves image
quality.
Fuser film
Paper
Pressure roller
ITB cleaning process is to remove the residual toner on the ITB surface.
The residual toner is scraped off by the cleaning blade and then collected into the toner collection box
ass’y by the toner feed screw.
Step 8: Fusing 91
Figure 3-22 ITB cleaning
Toner cartridges
Learn about the toner cartridges.
The following sections discuss the printer toner cartridges. The printer has four toner cartridges, one for
each color: cyan, magenta, yellow, and black.
Design
Learn about toner cartridge design.
Each toner cartridge is filled with toner and consists of the following components:
● Photosensitive drum
● Developer
● Primary-charging roller
● Memory chip
The printer has four cartridges, one for each color: yellow, magenta, cyan and black. Each of them has
the same structure
The X654/X677 models have two cartridge types: four (YMCK) toner cartridges and four imaging drums
(YMCK).
DC controller
DEV
DRM_HP4
DRM_HP123
M 4DEV/3DMR/ITB
Photosensitive
drum
Primary charging
Developer roller
roller
E-label
Cartridge
DEV_HP
Design 93
Figure 3-24 Toner cartridge and imaging drum block diagram
Feed/toner-supply controller
P-cartridge
M TS_MOTOR
T-cartridge
BUFF_PTR_PCA(1st/2st/3st/4st)
Toner supply mechanism
● ITB-drive roller
● Primary-transfer roller
● ITB cleaner
Developer motor
T1_HP
ITB cleaner
T1 roller
The secondary transfer roller assembly transfers the toner image on the ITB to the paper.
Calibration
Learn about the printer calibration process.
The printer calibrates itself to maintain proper print-quality. The calibration corrects color-
misregistration and color-density variation due to environmental changes or internal variation in the
printer.
Calibration functions
Learn about color calibration functions.
The DC controller controls the pickup, feed, and delivery system according to commands from the
formatter. The pickup, feed, and delivery system uses a series of rollers to move the paper through the
printer.
The pickup, feed, and delivery system consists of the following three functional blocks.
● Pickup-and-feed-block: Controls the movement of the paper from each pickup source to the fuser
inlet
● Fuser-and-delivery-block: Controls the movement of the paper from the fuser to the delivery
destination
● Duplex block: Controls the movement of the paper from the duplex switchback unit to the duplex
re-pickup unit
Pickup-and-feed block
Pickup-and-feed block
The following figure shows the sensors and switches for the pickup, feed, and delivery system.
DUP_FL_SNS
OUT_FULL_SNS
PAPOUT-M_SNS
PAPOUT-L_SNS
LOOP_SNS
REFEED_SNS
MS
REG_SNS
RREREG_SNS
MP_PAP_SNS
TRANS_SNS
CST_FACE_SNS
CST_PAP_SNS
CST_SIZE1
CST_SIZE2
CST
CST_SIZE3 CST_SIZE4
Abbreviation Component
Abbreviation Component
The following figure shows the motors, clutches, and solenoids for the pickup, feed, and delivery system.
D_SL
R_CL
MPSL
F_CL
LIFT FEED
D_SL
R_CL
MPSL
FEED2
F_CL
LIFT FEED1
The DC controller adjusts the feed speed to improve the print quality depending on the paper type. The
paper is fed at a specified speed according to the print mode designated by the formatter.
Glossy media 1 5 5
Glossy media 2 5 5
Glossy media 3 5 5
Glossy film 5 5
OHT 5 5
Designated media 3 3 3
Media detection
Learn about pickup, feed, and delivery media detection.
The printer is equipped with media sensor on paper path, and can detect media type fed. The media
sensor consists of an optical sensor which detects surface roughness and ultrasonic sensor which
detects paper weight, and the distance between the optical sensor and the print media is kept constant
by roller.
The followings are print modes that can be switched for media detection.
● Normal
● Heavy media 1
● Heavy media 2
● Heavy media 3
● Light media
● Glossy media 1
● Glossy media 2
● Glossy media 3
● Rough media
● OHT
● Glossy film
Jam detection/prevention
Learn about pickup, feed, and delivery jam detection.
The printer uses the following sensors to detect the presence of paper and to check whether paper is
being fed correctly or has jammed.
OUT_FULL_SNS
PAPOUT-M_SNS
PAPOUT-L_SNS
REFEED_SNS
REG_SNS
PREREG_SNS
TRANS_SNS
Figure 3-32 Jam detection sensors (6700/6800 models models and 550-sheet paper feeder)
Simplex paper path
Duplex paper path
OUT_FULL_SNS
PAPOUT-M_SNS
PAPOUT-L_SNS
REFEED_SNS
REG_SNS
PREREG_SNS
SR23
OUT_FULL_SNS
PAPOUT-M_SNS
PAPOUT-L_SNS
REFEED_SNS
REG_SNS
PREREG_SNS
SR4
The printer determines that a jam has occurred if one of these sensors detects paper at an
inappropriate time. The DC controller stops the print operation and notifies the formatter.
● No pick jam 1
● No pick jam 2
● No pick jam 3
The 550-sheet paper feeder is installed at bottom of the printer. It picks up the print media and feeds it to
the printer. The paper feeder controller controls the operational sequence of the paper feeder.
The figure below shows the 550-sheet paper feeder paper path.
The figure below shows the paper feeder controller block diagram.
Motor
+3.3VB2
Clutch
+24VA
DC controller Paper feeder controller
Photointerruptor
Switch
The figure below shows the paper feeder electrical components. The table in this section describes the
paper feeder electrical components.
M12
CL6
SR24 SR23
SR22 SW16
SW4
SW6
SW5 SW7
SR21
M15
The table below describes which components the paper feeder motors drive.
M12 Paper feeder feed motor Paper feeder cassette pickup roller No
M15 Paper feeder lifter motor Paper feeder cassette lifter drive assembly No
The paper feeder has the following pickup and feed functions.
● Multiple-feed prevention
● Automatic delivery
The paper feeder uses the following sensor to detect the presence of paper and to check whether
paper is being fed correctly or has jammed.
The HCI is optionally installed at bottom of the printer. It picks up the print media and feeds it to the
printer. The HCI controller controls the operational sequence of the HCI.
HCI controller
Learn about the HCI controller.
Motor
+3.3VB2
Clutch
+24VA
DC controller HCI controller
Photointerruptor
Switch
The figure below shows the HCI electrical components. The table in this section describes the HCI
electrical components.
M13
CL2
SR5 SR4
SR3 SW13
SR6
SW9
SW10
SW8
M14
The table below describes which components the HCI motors drive.
● Automatic delivery
The HCI uses the following sensor to detect the presence of paper and to check whether paper is being
fed correctly or has jammed.
The printer determines that a jam has occurred if the sensor detects paper at an inappropriate time.
3-bin stapler-stacker
Learn about the 3-bin stapler-stacker.
The 3-bin stapler-stacker is installed on the upper side of the printer. It delivers the print media to the
output bin after the staple process. The unit's controller controls the operational sequence of the paper
feeder.
The figure below shows the 3-bin stapler-stacker controller block diagram.
Motor
+3.3VB2
+24VA
Fan
Photointerruptor
Switch
Formatter
The figures below show the 3-bin stapler-stacker electrical components. The table in this section
describes the 3-bin stapler-stacker electrical components.
M21
SL22
M25
M22
SL23
SL21
PS207
PS206 PS204
PS201
PS205
PS211
PS202
PS212 PS213
PS208 PS214 PS203
PS209 PS215
SW3
SW4
PS210 SW21
The table below describes which components the 3-bin stapler-stacker motors drive.
● Staple control
● Automatic delivery
The 3-bin stapler-stacker uses the following sensors to detect the presence of paper and to check
whether paper is being fed correctly or has jammed.
The printer determines that a jam has occurred if the sensors detect paper at an inappropriate time. The
stapler-stacker detects the following jams.
Floor-standing stapler-stacker
Learn about the floor-standing stapler-stacker.
The floor-standing stapler-stacker is installed on the left side of the printer, and it delivers print
media to each output bin. The floor-standing stapler-stacker can perform punch processing and
staple processing on print media. The floor-standing stapler-stacker controller controls the operation
sequence of the floor-standing stapler-stacker.
Output bin 3
Output bin 4
The figure below shows the floor-standing stapler-stacker controller block diagram.
Formatter
IPTU FSSS
Switch
DC controller IPTU FSSS
controller controller
Photointerruptor
Fan
Motor
Solenoid
Sensor
LED
The figures below show the floor-standing stapler-stacker electrical components. The table in this
section describes the floor-standing stapler-stacker electrical components.
M26
M19
M11
M17 M12
M27 SL12
M13
SL11
M25
M23
M28
SL14
M22
M24
M20
M21
SR4
SR7 PS26
PS45 SW11 SR18
PS11
PS37
SR13
SR14 PS18
SR12
PS19
PS38
PS42
SR16 SR18
SR17
SR10
SR15
Photo interrupter SR5 Bin 3 shift roller alienation home position sensor
Photo interrupter SR22 Bin 4 output roller alienation home position sensor
The table below describes which components the floor-standing stapler-stacker motors drive.
M13 Intermediate feed motor Intermediate feed roller and drum ass’y No
M14 Bin 3 shift motor Move in the direction of the width of output bin 3 No
delivery roller
M15 Bin 3 alienation motor Disengage the output bin 3 delivery roller No
M16 MBM feed motor Punch inlet roller, punch exit roller No
M21 Stapler shift motor Moving the stapler in the feed direction No
M22 Jogger motor Move in the direction of the width of jogger Yes
The floor-standing stapler-stacker has a fan that prevents the temperature from rising in the sub power
supply area. The table below describes the floor-standing stapler-stacker fan functions.
FAN11 Sub power supply fan Sub power supply Intake Full Yes
● Stack mode
● Punch mode
● Staple mode
● Automatic delivery
The paper feeder uses the following sensor to detect the presence of paper and to check whether
paper is being fed correctly or has jammed.
The printer determines that a jam has occurred if the sensor detects paper at an inappropriate time.
For HP channel partners access WISE, see Accessing WISE for HP channel partners (HP Partner Portal)
on page 136 or Accessing WISE for HP channel partners (CSDP) on page 135.
WISE is available to call agents, service technicians, and HP internal users. The level of detail available
depends on your access credentials. To learn how to find support content in WISE, watch the video here.
To learn how to find support content in WISE, watch the video here: Finding Error Code and Control Panel
Message Document in WISE.
TIP: The Product Detail Page (PDP) is available from the WISE home page. Enter, and then select a
product name or number in the Go to a Product Detail Page area (callout 1), or select the …or select your
product from a list item (callout 2) on the WISE home page.
Many types of printer documentation and information are available on WISE. This section details
methods for finding error code descriptions and solutions.
TIP: To view a list of control panel message documents (CPMD) per printer, search for the following
topic in WISE: HP LaserJet, OfficeJet, PageWide, ScanJet Enterprise - Control panel message
document (CPMD) list or click the link below.
Use one of the following methods to search for CPMD error code information.
● Method 1: Use the WISE home page Error Code Lookup tool on page 130
● Method 2: Search for error codes using the WISE search function on page 132
● Method 3: Search for error codes using the Product Detail Page on page 133
Method 1: Use the WISE home page Error Code Lookup tool
Use the WISE Error Code Lookup tool to find error code troubleshooting procedures using the following
steps.
1. On the WISE home page, click the Error Code Lookup tool icon.
2. Enter a printer model number (for example, M606) in the Error Code Lookup dialog box.
3. A drop-down list appears. Click on the full printer series name (for example, HP LaserJet Enterprise
M606 series) in the list.
NOTE: Selecting the series item from the drop-down list is recommended for the most accurate
search return.
M606
4. Type the error code (for example, 13.b2.d2) in the Error Code Lookup keyword field, and then select
the search icon.
5. The error code troubleshooting content displays in the All Search Results area.
Method 2: Search for error codes using the WISE search function
Use the WISE search function to find error code troubleshooting procedures using the following steps.
1. On the WISE home page, enter a printer model number (for example, M606) in the Search dialog box.
2. A drop-down list appears. Click on the full printer series name (for example, HP LaserJet Enterprise
M606 series) in the list.
NOTE: Selecting the series item from the drop-down list is recommended for the most accurate
search return.
3. Type the error code (for example, 13.E1.D3) in the Search keyword field, and then select the search
icon.
1 2
4. The error code troubleshooting content displays in the All Search Results area.
Method 3: Search for error codes using the Product Detail Page
Use the WISE Product Detail Page (PDP) to find error code troubleshooting procedures using the
following steps.
1. On the WISE home page, enter a printer model number (for example, M606) in the Go to a Product
Detail page dialog box.
TIP: To find a PDP from a list of products by product type, select the …or select your product from
a list item just below the dialog box.
2. A drop-down list appears. Click on the full printer series name (for example, HP LaserJet Enterprise
M606 series) in the list.
NOTE: Selecting the series item from the drop-down list is recommended for the most accurate
search return.
3. Type the error code (for example, 13.E1.D3) in the Error Code Lookup field, and then select the search
icon.
1 2
4. The error code troubleshooting content displays in the All Search Results area.
IMPORTANT: A Partner Admin must requested access, via the CSDP portal, to create a new user
before you can sign into the CDSP portal.
1. Sign-in to the CSDP portal (click csdp.hp.com to access the sign-in page).
2. On the CSDP home page, click the Knowledge and Training item.
TIP: Use the Knowledge and Training item at the top of the CSDP home page (callout 1), or the
Knowledge and Training action icon (callout 2).
3. Select HP Technical Documentation on the Knowledge and Training page to open the WISE portal
home page.
NOTE: If this is your first visit to the HP Partner Portal, you will be asked to create an account. Follow
the setup directions using your HP Partner credentials.
2. On the HP Partner Portal home page, click the Services & Support item.
This section contains a pre-troubleshooting checklist and a troubleshooting flow chart to filter out many
possible causes of the problem.
● Use the pre-troubleshooting check list to gather information about the problem from the customer.
● Use the troubleshooting flowchart to pinpoint the root cause of hardware malfunctions. The
flowchart guides you to the section of this chapter that contains steps for correcting the
malfunction.
NOTE: The customer is responsible for checking supplies and for using supplies that are in good
condition.
Pre-troubleshooting checklist
The following table includes basic questions to ask the customer to quickly help define the problem(s).
● Is the power-supply plug inserted in the printer and the wall outlet (not a surge
protector)?
● Is the printer exposed to ammonia gas, such as that produced by diazo copiers
or office cleaning materials?
NOTE: Diazo copiers produce ammonia gas as part of the copying processes.
Ammonia gas (from cleaning supplies or a diazo copier) can have an adverse
effect on some printer components (for example, the toner cartridge or
cartridges OPC).
● Is the printer exposed to an air conditioning or heating vent that can cause
temperature fluctuations?
● Are the paper guides aligned with the stack (no gaps in the stack or excessive
pressure causing the stack to bow)?
NOTE: If country/region specific toner cartridges are available for the printer, make
sure the correct cartridge is installed.
Transfer unit and fuser ● Are the transfer unit and fuser installed correctly?
NOTE: For printers with an intermediate transfer belt (ITB), is the ITB installed
correctly and fully seated. If a replacement ITB was installed, was all of the
packing materials removed?
● Was a toner cartridge (or cartridges) opened soon after being moved from a
cold to a warm room? If so, allow the toner cartridge (or cartridges) to sit at
room temperature for 1 to 2 hours.
Miscellaneous ● Check for and remove any non-HP components (toner cartridges, memory
modules, and EIO cards) from the printer.
● Remove the printer from the network and ensure that the failure is associated
with the printer before beginning troubleshooting.
● For any color print-quality issues (color printers only), calibrate the printer, and
then print a diagnostics page to verify print quality.
Troubleshooting flowchart
This flowchart highlights the general processes to follow to quickly isolate and solve printer hardware
problems.
Each row depicts a major troubleshooting step. Follow a “yes” answer to a question to proceed to the
next major step. A “no” answer indicates that more testing is needed. Go to the appropriate section in
this chapter and follow the instructions there. After completing the instructions, go to the next major
step in this troubleshooting flowchart.
Yes No If the event log does not print, check for error
messages.
Yes. This is the end of the No Verify that all I/O cables are connected correctly and
troubleshooting process. that a valid IP address is listed on the HP Jetdirect
configuration page.
Firmware upgrades
Learn about printer firmware upgrades.
To download the most recent firmware upgrade for the printer, go to:
a. Select Get drivers, Software, and Firmware, and then select the appropriate product by name.
NOTE: More than one printer model might be listed. Make sure to select the correct model so
that the upgraded firmware supports all of the printer functions.
– Enter the product name in the Find my product dialogue box, and then select Go.
TIP: Click on the How do I find my product name/number? link to see a short video on
identifying the printer's name and number.
NOTE: More than one printer model might be listed. Make sure to select the correct model so
that the upgraded firmware supports all of the printer functions.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Reports button.
Firmware Revision
Rev
HP LaserJet M
Sep\13\2019 6:56:00 AM
The firmware update might take 10 minutes or longer based on the input/output (I/O) transfer rates and
the time it takes for the printer to reinitialize.
3. Select the Firmware Upgrade link from the General tab or from the Troubleshooting tab.
4. Browse to the location that the firmware upgrade file was downloaded to, and then select the
firmware file. The file has a .bdl file extension. Select the Install button to perform the upgrade.
NOTE: Do not close the browser window OR interrupt communication until the HP Embedded Web
Server (EWS) displays the confirmation page.
5. After the printer reinitializes, print a configuration page and verify that the latest firmware version
has been installed.
2. Touch the middle of the control panel display when you see the 1/8 under the logo.
1 2
3. Use the arrow buttons to highlight +3 Administrator, and then touch the OK button.
4. Use the arrow buttons to highlight +1 Download, and then touch the OK button.
5. Insert the USB flash drive with the .bdl file on it into the USB port on the printer.
NOTE: If the error message No USB Thumbdrive Files Found displays on the control panel display,
try using a different portable storage device.
6. Use the arrow buttons to highlight USB Thumbdrive, and then touch the OK button.
7. Use the arrow buttons to highlight the .bdl file, and then touch the OK button.
TIP: If there is more than one .bdl file on the storage device, make sure to select the correct file for
this printer.
8. When the message Complete displays on the control panel display, touch the down arrow button
several times until the message Continue displays.
9. Touch the OK button to begin the upgrade. When the upgrade is complete, the printer will initialize to
the Ready state.
10. When the upgrade process is complete, print a configuration page and verify that the upgrade
firmware version was installed.
2. Turn the printer on, and then wait until it reaches the Ready state.
3. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
6. Insert the USB flash drive with the .bdl file on it into the USB port on the printer.
TIP: If there is more than one .bdl file on the storage device, make sure to select the correct file for
this printer.
● Upgrade
● Re-install
● Downgrade
9. When the upgrade is complete, the printer will initialize to the Ready state.
10. When the upgrade process is complete, print a configuration page and verify that the upgrade
firmware version was installed.
Engine test
Learn about troubleshooting the printer using the engine test diagnostic.
When the engine test is performed, a test page with lines prints if the engine is functioning correctly.
NOTE: Depending on printer models, either a simplex engine test page, a duplex engine test page, or
both simplex and duplex engine test pages might be available.
Use a small pointed object to depress and hold the engine test button (location varies depending on the
printer model). An engine test page prints. The test page can use only Tray 2 as the paper source, so
make sure that paper is loaded in Tray 2.
The printer includes a diagnostic test mode for the touchscreen control panels.
Use the diagnostics in this section to test the control-panel hardware and embedded firmware. These
tests are useful for checking control-panel functionality independent of the printer control-panel system
diagnostics.
2. Observe the control panel screen as it cycles through the following colors:
● Red
● Green
● Blue
● Black
● White
Use the following procedure to open the control panel system diagnostics tests.
1 2
3. On the Pre-boot menu screen, use the following buttons to navigate the tests.
Button Description
Button Description
Not used.
4. Use the down arrow button to scroll to +3 Administration, and then press the OK button to select
it.
5. Use the down arrow button to scroll to +E CP Diagnostics, and then press the OK button to select
it.
Screen test
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic screen test.
3. Touch the touchscreen to scroll though the remaining touchscreen test screens.
Screen Description
Screen Description
Screen Description
Checkerboard
Multicolor stripes
Touch test
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic touch test.
SoftKey test
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic SoftKey test.
2. Use the down arrow button to scroll to 3 SoftKey Test, and then press the OK button to select it.
Backlight test
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic backlight test.
After selecting the 4 Backlight Test, the screen automatically dims, and then returns to full
brightness.
Sound test
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic sound test.
2. Use the down arrow button to scroll to 5 Sound Test, and then press the OK button to select it.
After selecting the 5 Sound Test, the printer emits a series of audible tones.
IMPORTANT: The control-panel system diagnostic tests include a 6 Keyboard Test item. This test is not
valid for printers that do not have a pull out keyboard installed, even though this option is present in the
control-panel system diagnostic tests menu.
If the 6 Keyboard Test is opened on a non-flow printer, the printer power must be turned off to exit the
test.
HP does not recommend turning the printer power off during the control-panel system diagnostic tests.
3. When prompted, touch the H key on the keyboard or the Home button to exit the test.
Version
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic version information.
2. Use the down arrow button to scroll to 7 Version, and then press the OK button to select it.
NOTE: The following types of information are for the control panel only, not the printer.
● Panel ID
● Hardware (version)
● Firmware (version)
● KB Hw (version)
● KB Firm (version)
● LCD Vendor
Replace the
control panel.
Open the
diagnostic function.
Perform the
touch test.
Y
Turn the product
power off,
and then
on again.
Control panel
has no
sound
Can sounds
be heard?
N
Y
Open the
diagnostic function.
Perform the sound test.
Can sounds
be heard?
Y
N
Do not replace the
control panel.
Turn the product power off.
Remove the control panel.
Check the cables to the speaker.
Replace the control panel. N Reseat the cables to the speaker.
Turn the product power on.
Can sounds be heard?
Open the
diagnostic function.
Perform the Home
button test.
Open the
diagnostic function.
Perform the
Home button test.
Hardware integration pocket (HIP) is not functioning (control panel functional) 165
Figure 4-48 Hardware integration pocket (HIP) is not functioning (control panel functional)
Hardware integration
pocket (HIP)
not functional
(control panel
functional)
To display: At the printer control panel, select the Settings menu, and then select the Print menu (SFP) or
the Copy/Print menu (MFP).
To print: At the printer control panel, touch (MFP) or use the arrow buttons (SFP) to select the printer
icon . For the SFP, press the OK button to print the pages.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Disable preview
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Secret
Top Secret
Urgent
Copy Settings Watermark Text Font Letter Gothic* Select the font of
the text watermark.
MFP Antique Olive
New Century
Schoolbook Roman
Garamond Antiqua
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
60 point
3*
5 - (Darker)
Copy Settings Stamps Stamp Content User-defined value Use to set a stamp
in any or all the
MFP None* following locations
in the document:
IP address
● Top Left
User name
● Top Center
Product information
● Top Right
Page number
● Bottom Left
Date and time
● Bottom
Center
● Bottom Right
Copy Settings Stamps Text Font Letter Gothic* Select the font of
the stamp.
MFP Antique Olive
New Century
Schoolbook Roman
Garamond Antiqua
20 point
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
When Include
margins is enabled,
the printer reduces
the image slightly
to fit the entire
scanned image
within the printable
area on the page.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Mixed Letter/Legal
Legal (8.5x14)
Executive (7.25x10.5)
Statement (5.5x8.5)
Oficio (8.5x13)
4x6
5x7
5x8
A4 (210x297 mm)
A5 (148x210 mm)
A6 (105x148 mm)
B5 (182x257 mm)
B6 (128x182 mm)
10x15cm
DPostcard JIS
(148x200 mm)
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Copy Settings Paper Selection Paper Size Match original size* Select the size of
paper to use when
MFP Letter (8.5x11) printing or making
copies.
Legal (8.5x14)
Executive (7.25x10.5)
Statement (5.5x8.5)
Oficio (8.5x13)
3x5
4x6
5x7
5x8
A4 (210x297 mm)
A5 (148x210 mm)
A6 (105x148 mm)
B5 (182x257 mm)
B6 (128x182 mm)
10x15cm
DPostcard JIS
(148x200 mm)
Envelope #9
Envelope #10
Envelope Monarch
Envelope #10
Envelope B5
Envelope C5
Envelope C6
Envelope DL
Custom
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Copy Settings Paper Selection Paper Type Any Type Select the type of
paper to use when
MFP Plain* printing or making
copies.
Light 60-74g
Intermediate 85-95g
Mid-Weight 96-110g
Heavy 111-130g
Cardstock 176-220g
Mono Transparency
Labels
Letterhead
Envelope
Preprinted
Prepunched
Colored
Bond
Recycled
Rough
HP EcoFFICIENT
Light Bond
Copy Settings Paper Selection Paper Tray Automatically detect* Select which tray
to use when
MFP Manually Feed printing or making
copies.
Tray 1
Tray 2
Copy Settings Booklet Booklet Format Borders on each Enabled Select to have
page borders printed on
MFP Disabled* the page.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Four
Copy Settings Page Order Right, then down Select to print the
pages in rows or
MFP Down, then right columns.
5*
9 - (Darker)
5*
9 - (More)
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
5*
9 - (Cleaner)
3*
5 - (More)
Photograph
Copy Settings Erase Edges Use inches Enabled* Use the Erase
Edges feature to
MFP Disabled remove blemishes,
such as dark
borders or staple
marks, by cleaning
the edges of the
scanned image.
Disabling Use
inches changes
the measurements
to millimeters.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Copy Settings Erase Edges Front Side Specify a different Sets the width of
width for each edge the edge to clean.
MFP
Apply same width to
all edges*
Default = 0.00
Copy Settings Erase Edges Back Side Specify a different Sets the width of
width for each edge the edge to clean.
MFP
Apply same width to
all edges
Copy Settings
MFP
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
The Temporary
Job Storage Limit
feature specifies
the number of
temporary jobs
that can be stored
on the printer. The
maximum allowed
value is 300.
Default Print Paper Selection Paper size Select from a list of Configures the
Options sizes that the printer default paper size,
Paper type supports. type and tray used
for print jobs.
Paper tray
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
PCL and PCL Font Settings Font Source Internal Selects the font
Postscript source for the
Settings Disk resident* user-soft default
font. The list of
available options
varies depending
on the installed
printer options.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
PCL and PCL Font Settings Font Number Range: 0-110 Specifies the font
Postscript number for the
Settings Default = 0 user-soft default
font using the
source that is
specified in the
Font Source menu.
The printer assigns
a number to each
font and lists it on
the PCL font list.
The font number
displays in the Font
# column of the
printout.
PCL and PCL Font Settings Font Pitch Range: 0.44-99.99 If the Font Source
Postscript option and the Font
Settings Default = 10 Number setting
indicate a contour
font, then use this
feature to select a
default pitch (for a
fixed-spaced font).
PCL and PCL PCL Settings Form Length Range: 5-128 lines Controls the PCL
Postscript print-command
Settings Default = 60 options. PCL is
a set of printer
commands that
HP developed to
provide access to
printer features.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
PCL and PCL PCL Settings Symbol Set Select from a list of Select any one of
Postscript symbol sets. several available
Settings symbol sets from
the control panel.
A symbol set
is a unique
grouping of all the
characters in a
font. The factory
default value
for this option
is PC-8. Either
PC-8 or PC-850
are recommended
for line-draw
characters.
PCL and PCL PCL Settings Append CR to LF Enabled When enabled, this
Postscript option appends
Settings Disabled* a carriage return
to each line
feed encountered
in backwards-
compatible PCL
jobs.
PCL and PCL PCL Settings Suppress Blank Enabled This option is for
Postscript Pages users who are
Settings Disabled* generating their
own PCL, which
could include extra
form feeds that
would cause blank
pages to be
printed. When the
On option is
selected, form
feeds are ignored if
the page is blank.
PCL and PCL PCL Settings Media Source Standard* Use to select
Postscript Mapping and maintain input
Settings Classic trays by number
when you are not
using the printer
driver, or when the
software program
has no option for
tray selection. The
following options
are available:
Standard: Tray
numbering is
based on newer HP
LaserJet models.
Classic: Tray
numbering is
based on HP
LaserJet 4 and
older models.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Print Quality General Toner Density A sliding bar appears Lighten or darken
with the indicator set the print on the
in the middle between page by changing
Less and More. the toner density
setting.
Tray 3
Tray 4
Tray 5
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Print Quality Image Print Test Page Use the Print Test
Registration Page option to
print a page to
test the image
registration. It
provides alignment
guides in the X
and Y directions so
you can determine
which adjustments
are necessary.
Sense transparency
only
Print Quality Auto Sense All Other Trays Sense first page
Behavior
Sense transparency
only
Print Quality Adjust Paper Select from a list Print mode Select from a list of Changing the Print
types of paper types paper types mode setting is
that the printer usually the first
supports. The Reset Paper Types thing to try
available to resolve print-
options are the quality problems.
same for each Problems can
paper type. include toner not
sticking well to
the page, a faint
image of the page
repeated on the
same or following
page, incorrect
gloss level, and so
on.
Print Quality Adjust Paper Select from a list Resistance mode Normal* Use this setting
types of paper types to correct print
that the printer Up 1 quality problems
supports. The in low-humidity
available Up 2 environments and
options are the highly resistive
same for each paper.
paper type.
Use the Up options
to solve print
quality problems
that are related
to faded images
or scattered toner
on certain paper
types.
The Up options
raise the
secondary transfer
bias.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Print Quality Adjust Paper Select from a list Paper curl mode Normal* Use this setting to
types of paper types reduce paper curl
that the printer Reduced in print jobs.
supports. The
available
options are the
same for each
paper type.
Alternate
Reduced Temp
Alternate
Alternate
Alternate 2
Alternate 3
On
On
On
Alternate
Alternate 1
Alternate
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Light
Normal*
Maximum
Exclusively: The
printer never
selects a different
tray when the user
has indicated that
a specific tray
should be used,
even if that tray is
empty.
When available:
The printer pulls
from another tray
if the specified
tray is empty, even
though the specific
tray was indicated
for the job.
Always: A prompt
always displays
before using the
multipurpose tray.
Prompt on
mismatch: A
prompt displays
only if the size
or type do not
match or the tray is
empty.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Do not display:
Prevents the
tray configuration
message from
automatically
appearing.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Automatic: Choose
this option to
skip printing blank
sides during a two-
sided print job. The
printer can print
jobs faster when
blank sides are
skipped.
Always: Choose
this option to print
all sides of a two-
sided job, even
if one side is
blank. This might
be preferable for
certain jobs that
use paper types
such as letterhead
or prepunched
paper.
First level Second level Third level Fourth Level Values Description
Defeating interlocks
Learn about defeating printer interlocks.
Different tests can be used to isolate different types of issues. For assembly or noise isolation, run the
diagnostic test when the front, right or toner supply (model specific) door is open.
Defeating the door interlocks allows observation of the paper pick operation.
TIP: Fold a stiff piece of paper, for example a business card or index card, into a strip, and insert
the strip into the slot for the door interlock logic switch.
It might be easier to use a small flat-blade screwdriver to defeat the door interlock.
TIP: Fold a stiff piece of paper, for example a business card or index card, into a strip, and insert
the strip into the slot for the door interlock logic switch.
It might be easier to use a small flat-blade screwdriver to defeat the door interlock.
TIP: Fold a stiff piece of paper, for example a business card or index card, into a strip, and insert
the strip into the slot for the door interlock logic switch.
It might be easier to use a small flat-blade screwdriver to defeat the door interlock.
Figure 4-51 Defeat the toner supply door interlock (X654/X677 models)
Item Description
Item Description
CAUTION: Under NO circumstances should a formatter from a different printer be installed during
the repair or troubleshooting processes. The formatter stores important data specific to the model of
printer it is installed in and is not deigned to be swapped or repurposed in any way. Return a used
formatter to HP.
● Serial number, product number, product name, page count, and supported cartridges information
change and might make a product unusable.
If a used formatter is installed and causes this issue, the partner must cover the costs of the repair in
the form of a product replacement. There is no method in the field to recover a printer where a used
formatter is installed.
This part contains components that are electrostatic discharge (ESD) sensitive. To reduce the
possibility of ESD damage, always touch the sheet-metal chassis to ground yourself before touching an
ESD sensitive part.
Heartbeat LED
The heartbeat LED indicates that the formatter is functioning correctly. While the printer is initializing
after it is turned on, the LED blinks rapidly, and then turns off. When the printer has finished the
initialization sequence, the heartbeat LED pulses on and off.
The following list describes the heartbeat LED operation while the printer is executing the firmware boot
process.
NOTE: If after initialization, the heartbeat LED is not solid green, see Table 4-7 Heartbeat LED, printer
operational on page 192.
● Green
● Yellow (Amber)
– Solid: The FFC between the formatter and DC controller is not connected or is damaged.
● Red
– Solid: Valid SPI code; there is a problem releasing ASIC and running the BIOS.
The following table describes the heartbeat LED operation when the printer completes the firmware
boot process and is in the Ready state.
Off TIP: The heartbeat LED is off if the power cable is disconnected, the product power switch is in the off
position, or the product is in Sleep Mode.
NOTE: This condition is not usually caused by a formatter failure. Turn the power off, and then on again. If
the error persists, perform a firmware upgrade.
HP Jetdirect LEDs
The embedded HP Jetdirect print server has two LEDs. When the printer is connected to a properly
working network through a network cable, the yellow LED indicates network activity, and the green LED
indicates the link status.
A blinking yellow LED indicates network traffic. If the green LED is off, a link has failed. For link failures,
check all of the network cable connections.
In addition, try to manually configure the network card link speed setting by using the printer control
panel. To change the link speed, complete the following steps.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Settings button.
● Networking
● Ethernet
● Link Speed
3. Touch the desired link speed setting, and then touch the Done button.
1. From the Home screen on the product control panel, scroll to and select the Support Tools item.
● Diagnostic Tests
● Scanner Tests
● – Sensors
3. Touch the sensor name on the Scanner Tests screen to display a sensor location graphic on the
control panel display.
4. Activate the desired sensor, and then check the control-panel display to verify the sensor state
(active or inactive).
● The State virtual LED next to the sensor number and sensor name illuminates green when the
sensor is active.
● The Toggle virtual LED next to the sensor number and sensor name illuminates green after the
sensor is activated and increments by one each time the sensor is interrupted (activated or
deactivated).
For example, opening the flatbed cover increments the Flatbed cover Toggle item count two
times—once when the door is opened, and once when the door is closed.
5. Select the Reset sensors item to reset the Toggle count item.
-or-
Touch the Cancel button to exit the Scanner Tests screen, and then touch the Cancel button again to
return the Diagnostic Tests menu.
● ADF Y (length)
● Flatbed Y (length)
● Flatbed cover
CAUTION: Do not perform a disable cartridge check on color printers that use a two-part cartridge
design. Doing so might result in toner cross contamination in the supply lines.
Use this diagnostic test to print internal pages or send an external job to the printer when a toner
cartridge is removed or exchanged. Supply errors are ignored while the printer is in this mode.
NOTE: Do not remove or exchange the toner cartridge until after beginning the disable cartridge
check diagnostic.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Troubleshooting
● Diagnostic Tests
Print/stop test
Learn about the print/stop test troubleshooting diagnostic.
Use this diagnostic test to isolate the cause of problems such as image-formation defects and jams
within the engine.
During this test, stop the paper anywhere along the printer paper path. The test can be programmed to
stop printing internal pages or an external print job when the paper reaches a certain position. The test
can also be programmed to stop from 0 to 60,000 ms. If the timer is set to a value that is greater than the
job-print time, the printer can recover in one of two ways.
● After the print job is completed press the OK button to return to the Troubleshooting menu before
the timer times out.
● After the timer times out, touch the Stop button. Activate the door switch to restart the engine and
return it to a normal state.
● 600 ms: The page has passed the registration area and the leading edge is just short of entering the
fuser. The image can be seen on the paper but has not fused. If the defect is visible then the cause
might be the drum, transfer roller, or a roller prior to, or in, the registration area.
● 1200 ms: The leading edge is about 18mm (0.71 in) into the top output bin. The image has gone
through the fuser. If the defect was not visible prior to the fuser, and is visible after the fuser, then
the fuser it is the likely cause of the print quality defect. Inspect the fuser for damage, debris, or
labels stuck to the fuser. Replace the fuser. Discuss media specifications and proper care of the
fuser with the customer.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Troubleshooting
● Diagnostic Tests
● Print/Stop Test
This diagnostic test generates one or more test pages. Use these pages to isolate the cause of jams.
To isolate a problem, specify which input tray to use, and specify the number of copies to print. Print
multiple copies to help isolate intermittent problems. The following options become available after
beginning the diagnostic feature:
● Print Test Page: Run the paper-path test from the default settings: Tray 2, no duplex, and one copy.
To specify other settings, scroll down the menu, and select the setting, and then scroll back up and
select Print Test Page to start the test.
● Number of Copies: Set the numbers of copies to be printed; the choices are 1, 10, 50, 100, or 500.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Troubleshooting
● Diagnostic Tests
This test displays the status of each paper path sensor and allows viewing of sensor status while
printing internal pages.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Troubleshooting
● Diagnostic Tests
NOTE: The cartridge door interlocks must be defeated to run the component tests. A control panel
display prompt appears to indicate removing the toner cartridge, during certain tests.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Troubleshooting
● Diagnostic Tests
● Component Test
The Manual Sensor Test screen shows the sensor number, sensor name (model specific), sensor state
(active or inactive), and the number of times the sensor has been toggled (activated).
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Troubleshooting
● Diagnostic Tests
3. Activate the desired sensor, and then check the control panel display to verify the sensor state
(active or inactive).
● The State virtual LED next to the sensor number and sensor name illuminates green when the
sensor is active.
● The Toggle virtual LED next to the sensor number and sensor name illuminates green after the
sensor is activated and increments by one each time the sensor is interrupted (activated or
deactivated).
For example, opening a door increments the appropriate sensor item count two times—once
when the door is opened, and once when the door is closed.
The Tray/Bin Manual Sensor Test screen shows the sensor number, sensor name (model specific),
sensor state (active or inactive), and the number of times the sensor has been toggled (activated).
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Troubleshooting
● Diagnostic Tests
3. Activate the desired sensor, and then check the control panel display to verify the sensor state
(active or inactive).
● The State virtual LED next to the sensor number and sensor name illuminates green when the
sensor is active.
● The Toggle virtual LED next to the sensor number and sensor name illuminates green after the
sensor is activated and increments by one each time the sensor is interrupted (activated or
deactivated).
For example, opening a door increments the appropriate sensor item count two times—once
when the door is opened, and once when the door is closed.
Item Description
3 Fax MFP models only: Telephone "line out" port (for attaching an extension phone, answering
machine, or other device)
4 SuperSpeed USB 3.0 host port (for job storage and private printing)
5 Fax MFP models only: Fax "line in" port (for attaching the fax phone line to the printer)
6 Power connection
DUP_FL_SNS
OUT_FULL_SNS
PAPOUT-M_SNS
PAPOUT-L_SNS
LOOP_SNS
REFEED_SNS
MS
REG_SNS
RREREG_SNS
MP_PAP_SNS
TRANS_SNS
CST_FACE_SNS
CST_PAP_SNS
CST_SIZE1
CST_SIZE2
CST
CST_SIZE3 CST_SIZE4
Abbreviation Component
Abbreviation Component
M12
CL6
SR24 SR23
SR22 SW16
SW4
SW6
SW5 SW7
SR21
M15
M13
CL2
SR5 SR4
SR3 SW13
SR6
SW9
SW10
SW8
M14
PS207
PS206 PS204
PS201
PS205
PS211
PS202
PS212 PS213
PS208 PS214 PS203
PS209 PS215
SW3
SW4
PS210 SW21
SR4
SR7 PS26
PS45 SW11 SR18
PS11
PS37
SR13
SR14 PS18
SR12
PS19
PS38
PS42
SR16 SR18
SR17
SR10
SR15
8
1
6
7
2
6
3
4
2
6 2
3 Toner supply motor assembly (X654/ 6 Toner supply drive assembly (X654/
X677 models) X677 models)
Item Description
6
2
5
4
4
1
5
2
7
2
6
3
Item Description
5 1
3 2
4 1
3 Pickup assembly
Item Description
1 Controller PCA
2
1
5 1
4 3
4 1
3 Pickup assembly
Item Description
1 Cassette assembly
Item Description
1 Controller PCA
2
1
2
8 3
4
7
51
16
6
1
Item Description
1 Controller PCA
1
5
3 Stapler
J126
J136
J140
J141 J142
J112
J101
J105
J115 J145
J114 J104
J102
J146 J151
J106 J103
J126 Fuser
J26
BATTERY
J23 J25
J8
J24
J15
J4 ASIC
J3
J29
J21
J20
J1
J6
MEMORY
J5
J27
J22
J96 J3
J8
J24 J24
J4 BATTERY J9
J18
J29 J12
J32 J5
J21
J64
ASIC
J22
J38
MEMORY
J7 J20
J26
J15 J11
J14
230 Chapter
Item4 Solve problems
Description Item Description
J521
J511
J552
J512
J554 J551 J532
J544
Pickup clutch
Feed sensor
J521
J511
J552
J512
J554 J551 J532
J544
Pickup clutch
Feed sensor
J503
J401 J301
J402
J202 J501
J104
J302 J102
J103
J204
J105
J203
J201
J101
Stamp solenoid
J761
J711 J734 J750
J720 J795 J741 J760 J781
J732
J715 J782
J714 J716
J735
J717 J751
J710
J790
J752
J719
J792
J780
J721
J718 J765
J733
J742
J766
Switchback motor
J720 Front door switch J781 Stage inlet drum drive solenoid
J732 Punch home position sensor J785 Trailing edge assist motor
Jogger motor
J734 Punch side registration sensor J787 Jogger home position sensor
Staple motor
J735 Chad full sensor (LED) J790 Bin 4 output roller alienation home
position sensor
Chad full sensor
Bin 4 media full sensor 1
Punch inlet roller rotation sensor
Stapler-stacker exit sensor
J741 MBM inlet sensor J792 Stacking guide home position sensor
J622
J621
J652
J641 J611 J612
J642 J613 J651
Timing chart two consecutive prints on LTR paper (Full-color 1/1 speed mode on Hopper)
Print command
1 TOP signal
3 Scanner motor
4 Pickup motor
Pickup motor
5
7 Registration sensor
9 Drum motor
10 ITB motor
11 Developer motor
12 Fuser motor
19 T1 bias (YMC)
20 T1 bias (K)
21 T2 bias
J336 J338
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
<5700/X557/5800/6700/6800>
+24VA
+24VA
+24VA
PGND
PGND
PGND
+3.3VB2
+24VA
PGND
+24VA
PGND
J338D
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 J338LH
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
J336AD
12
4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1
J954 J953
J336ADH
M M
SCN_MTR_12st SCN_MTR_34st
Rear PCA
4 3 2 1
J137 J136
J112
1 2 3 4
J140
DC controller PCA 15 17
<5700/X557/5800/6700/6800>
GND
GND
<6700/X654/6800/X677>
<5700/X5575800/X57954>
10
11
12
13
14
15
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
24V_ILK_SW 24V_ILK_SW
LIFT_MTR LIFT_SNS
+3.3VB2
J951 J950 J949 J952 M
2 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2
SOLD117
SOLD118
J955
FT10 FT9 FT7 FT8 2 1
2 1 1 2 3
J914
5
2 1
J917 2 1
2 1
FR_DOOR_SW
R_DOOR_SW
15
14
13
12
11
10
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
SGND
+24VA
+24VA
2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 5 4 3 2 1
15 17
J202
1 2
J217
4 3 2 1
J331 J332 J333 J334 Rear PCA J346
J322 J321
<5700/X557/6700/6800>
PGND
PGND
+24VA
+24VA
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
FEED_MTR FEED_CL FSR_MTR ITB_BK_MTR 3DRM_MTR 4DEV_MTR
FSR_FAN
T1_SL
M CL M M M M M
SL
2 1
J944B J943 J944 J942 J941 J939 J940 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
+24VB_0
+24VB_0
+3.3VC
+3.3VC
+24VB
+24VB
PGND
PGND
PGND
2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1
J937 J936 J935 J934
4 3 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 2 1 3 2 1 2 1
J209B J209 J216 J215 J214 J210 J206 J203
CST_SIZE1 CST_SIZE2 CST_SIZE3 CST_SIZE4
Drive PCA
4
J207 J207 J208
J212 J211 J205 J213
30 27 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4
SGND
SGND
PGND
SGND
SGND
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
J931D
+3.3VC
GND
3 2 1
J931DH
1 2 3
J931L
3 2 1 4 3 2 1
3 2 1 3 2 1 1 2 3 J932 J933
J931 J930
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
CRG_FAN M
30 27 DC controller PCA
DRM_HP4_SNS DEV_HP_SNS DRM_HP123_SNS
J122 J127 DEV_MTR
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 J103 J104
+3.3VC
GND
+24VB
<6700/X654/6800/X677>
<5700/X557/5800/X57945>
2
N.C
3 2 1 3 2 1 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 1 2 3 1 2 3
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
3
M M
+5VC
GND
J236 J910 2 1
GND_E
12
11
10
J318L
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
3 2 1 3 2 1
J318DH
J318D
3 2 1 1 2
ENC_SNS
Encoder PCA 12 J375
J373
J374
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
+3.3VCFU
+3.3VCFU
+24VAFU
+24VAFU
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
+5VC
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 2 1 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J316 J315 J314 J311 J313 J312 J317
19 13
<6700/X654/6800/X677>
KB_FAN
2
<X57945/X654/X677>
LED3
2 1
LED5
J927
1 2 3 J912 J918 J1 J1
3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 2 1 2 1
TCU_VSCW_SNS 1 2
OUT_FULL_SNS 2 1 J706L
J929L J706DH
J929DH J379P J706D
J928 J929D J911
1 2 3
1 2 3 1 2 3
1 2 3
1 2
PGND(BL)
+5VAFU
+5VAFU
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
3 2 1 3 2 1
3 2 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2 3 4
J351 J352 J354 J353 J355
J262 J261
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
13
12
11
10
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 J121DH
J121D
+5VC
+3.3VCFU
GND
+24VAFU
+5VAFU
GND
+3.3VCFU2
+24VBFU2
+24VBFU2
+24VBFU2
GND
1
+24VAFU3
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
GND
GND
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
25 29 19 13
J121
J132 J131 DC controller PCA J114 J115
C
D
A
1 60 1 35 50 +24VBFU3 50
59 2 34 49 N.C 49 1 28
2
3 33 48 GND 48 2 27
3 58 3 26
4 32 47 47
4 57 5 31 46 46 4 25
56 6 30 45 GND 45 5 24
5
7 29 44 44 6 23
6 55 7 22
8 28 43 GND 43
7 54 9 27 42 42 8 +3.3VL 21
53 10 26 41 GND 41 9 20
J405
J101
J461
J108
8
60
60
35
35
11 25 40 40 10 +3.3VL 19
9 52 11 18
12 24 39 39
10 51 13 23 38 38 12 17
50 14 22 37 37 13 16
11
15 21 36 36 14 15
J182
12 49
28
15 14
J183
16 20 35 35
28
13 48 17 19 34 34 16 13
47 18 18 33 33 17 12
14
19 17 32 32 18 GND 11
15 46 19 10
20 16 31 31
45 20 9
<5700/X557/5800/X57945>
16 21 15 30 30
44 22 14 29 29 21 8
17
22 7
Formatter
13
DC controller PCA
43 23 28 28
18 12 GND 23 6
24 27 27
J107
J181
5
GND
50
50
19 42 25 11 26 26 24 5
41 26 10 25 25 25 4
20 GND
27 9 24 24 26 3
21 40 27 N.C 2
28 8 23 23
22 39 7 28 +24VBFU3 1
29 22 22
38 30 6 21 21
DC controller PCA
23
31 5 20 20
24 37
32 4 19 19
25 36 33 3 18 GND 18
Laser PCA
26 35 34 2 17 17
35 1 16 16
27 34
15 15
28 33 14 14
29 32 13 13
31 12 12
30
11 11
31 30 10 10
32 29 9 GND 9
28 8 8
33
7 7
34 27 6 6
26 5 5
Laser PCA
35
25 4 4
36
3 3
37 24 2 2
38 23 1 1
39 22
40 21
<5700/X557/5800/X57945>
41 20
42 19
43 18
44 17
45 16
46 15
4
47 14
48 13
Formatter
49 12
50 11
51 10
9
<6700/X654/6800/X677>
52
53 8
54 7
55 6
56 5
57 4 64 +24VBFU3 64
58 3 63 N.C 63
59 2 62 GND 62
60 1 61 61
60 60 1 36
59 GND 59 2 35
58 58 3 34
4 33
57 GND 57 5 32
J192
J193
36
36
56 56 6 31
55 7 30
GND 55
8 29
54 54 9 28
53 GND 53 10 27
52 52 11 26
12 25
1 35 51 51
<6700/X654/6800/X677>
13 24
2 34 50 50 14 23
3 33 15 22
49 49
4 32 16 21
5 31 48 48 17 20
6 30 47 47 18 19
3
7 29 19 18
46 46
J102
J191
8 28 20 17
64
64
9 27 45 45 21 16
10 26 44 44 22 15
J471
35
11 25 23 14
43 43
12 24 24 13
13 23 42 42 25 +3.3VL 12
35
14 22 41 41 26 11
15 21 J472 27 +3.3VL 10
40 40
16 20 28 9
17 19 39 39 29 8
18 GND
Laser PCA
18 38 38 30 7
<5700~/X557/6700/X654>
19 17 31 6
37 37
20 16 32 GND 5
21 15 36 36 33 4
22 14 35 35 34 GND 3
23 13 35 N.C 2
34 34
24 12 36 +24VBFU3 1
25 11 33 33
26 10 32 32
27 9
31 31
Laser PCA
28 8
29 7 30 30
30 6 29 29
DC controller PCA
31 5
28 28
32 4
33 3 27 27
34 2 26 26
35 1
25 25
24 24
23 23
22 22
21 21
1
1
20 20
2
19 19
18 18
17 17
1
1
16 16
15 15
14 14
13 13
12 12
11 11
10 10
9 9
8 8
J7
1
5
7 7
2
4
J1822
6 6
3
3
5 5
4
2
4 4
5
1
3 3
2 2
1 1
Memory PCA
1
A
B
C
D
Figure 4-98 General circuit diagram, base printer (2 of 5)
Figure 4-99 General circuit diagram, base printer (3 of 5)
6
PIN3
PIN22
PIN6
PIN5
PIN4
Heater/thermistor
J903 J904B J904
2 1 2 1 2 1
8 8
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
GNDM 1
GNDM 8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
2
3
4
5
6
7
1 2 2 1 2 1 2 1
4 3 2 1 8 8 1 2 1
J276 J287 J283 J281B J281 J284 J286
J272 J271
Fuser PCA
5
J285
J288
J280
J282
J278 J277 J274 J279
1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3
GNDA
+3.3VC
GNDA
+24VB
GNDM
+3.3VM
GNDMR
+3.3VMR
N.C
+24VB
PAPOUT_L_SNS
4
PAPOUT-M_SNS
1
J907 J908
1 2 3 1 2 3
3 2 1
PIN18
PIN19
J909
1 2
FSR_PRS_SNS TP
TH_SW
J906L TP1
6 5 4 3 2 1
J906DH
1 2 3 4 5 6
J906D
MT1
GND
GND
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
J905L
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
4
1 2 3 4 5 6
J905LB J905LA
J905DB J905DA
J905D
<6700/X654/6800/X677~>
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 1 2 3 4 5 6
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
N.C
Drive PCA
MT2
J204
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
+3.3VC
+24VB
+24VB
+24VA
+24VA
+24VB
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
N.C
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 1 2 3 4 5 6
J130 J125 J126
DC controller PCA
J106
J124 J150 J105
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 27
+24VA
+24VA
GND
GND
3.3VB2
GND
<5800/X57945/6800/X677>
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+3.3VAFU
+5VAFU
+5VC
+3.3VC
GND
NC
5 4 3 2 1
J150D
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 J150LH
J124D J150L
1 2 3 4 5
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
+3.3VMR
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
GNDMR
+24_5V
+24_5V
+24_5V
+24_5V
+24_5V
+24_5V
+3.3VM
GNDM
+3.3V
+3.3V
+5VA
GND
GND
GND
N.C
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 2 3 1 2
27
J1 J245 J290 J293 J292
Formatter
J247
2
TB403
TB203
TB202
3 2 1 1 2 3
J926 J301B J250 J244 J241 J248 J246 J243
J149D
5 4 3 2 1
J149DH 3 2 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 3 2 1
J149L
GNDB
PGND
PGND
+24VA
+24VA
+24VA
+24VA
+24VA
N.C
GNDA
GNDB
+3.3VC
N.C
ACN
ACH
CAC_SNS 3 2 1
<X557>
<6800/X677>
SOLD119
SOLD120
1 2 3
2 1 4 3 2 1
J379
M
PS_FAN
ACN
ACH
ENV SNS
SOLD101
SOLD102
CAC_MTR
2 1
J243F2
3
2
1
IL101
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
J201
Drive PCA
1
C
D
A
<X57945/X654/X677>
D
SOLD31
SOLD30
J411DH M
J976 J411D J999 J998 J982
1 2 1 2 3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 J989
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1
N.C
J991 J992 J993 J994
Y_1st M_2st C_3st k_4st
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
+24VAFU3
+24VA
PGND
+3.3VTS
N.C
SGND
+24VA
PGND
+3.3VTS
GND
+24VA
+24VA
+24VA
PGND
PGND
PGND
3.3VB2
2 1 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1
J412 J411 J416 J417 J435 J401 J440
Feed/toner-supply controller PCA
J421 J423 J431 J410 J499
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1011121314 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
N.C
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
PGND
PGND
PGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
+24VA
+24VA
+24VA
+3.3VB2
+3.3VTS
+3.3VTS
+3.3VTS
+3.3VTS
+3.3VTS
+3.3VTS
+3.3VTS
+3.3VTS
+24VAFU
+24VAFU
+24VAFU
+24VAFU
+24VAFU2
+24VAFU2
+24VAFU2
+24VAFU2
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
12
11
10
2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1
J980 J979 J978 J977 12
J499D
1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2
J499DH
CST_SIZE1 CST_SIZE2 CST_SIZE3 CST_SIZE4
Figure 4-100 General circuit diagram, base printer (4 of 5)
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1
J692D J957D J693D J956D J694D J955D J695D J954D
2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1
3 2 1 J958 J959 3 2 1 J960 J961 3 2 1 J962 J963 3 2 1 J964 J965
2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1
J382A J2A J687 1 2 1 2 J382B J2B J792 1 2 1 2 J382C J2C J795 1 2 1 2 J382D J2D J787 1 2 1 2
Toner supply Toner supply CL CL Toner supply Toner supply CL CL Toner supply Toner supply CL CL Toner supply Toner supply CL CL
sensor LED sensor PCA sensor LED sensor PCA sensor LED sensor PCA sensor LED sensor PCA
PCA CAC_SNS PCA CAC_SNS PCA CAC_SNS PCA CAC_SNS
U_CL1 T_CL1 U_CL2 T_CL2 T_CL3 U_CL3 T_CL4 U_CL4 A
6 5 4 3 2 1
D
<Note 1> <Note 2> <Note 3> <Note 4> <Note 5>
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
SGND
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
10
11
12
13
SGND
SGND
+24VAFU
2 1
+3.3VB2
J938 1 2 3
+24VBFU2
+24VBFU2
+24VBFU2
GND
GND
+3.3VCFU2
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7 +3.3VCFU2
6 GND
5
4
3
2
1
J910B
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
13
12
11
10
1 2
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
2 1
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
CST
J317D LOOP_SNS
J317DH
13 17 3 2 1 J318LA
Rear PCA J925A 1 2 23 18
J323 J321A High-voltage power supply PCA
J263 J92
MP_PAP_SNS
C
2 1
<X557/6700/6800> <X557/6700/6800> SL
MP_SL
J137A J136B
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
<6700/~X654/6800/X677> <X557/5800/X57945/x654/~6800/X677> <X57945/6700/X654/6800/X677>
Figure 4-101 General circuit diagram, base printer (5 of 5)
+3.3VCFU2
GND
+3.3VB2
J131A J132A
2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 Right PCA
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Right PCA DC controller PCA
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
J937A J936A J935A J934A 29
15
14
13
12
11
10
J317 J315A
25
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
J322A J321B
+24VAFU
+24VBFU2
+24VBFU2
+24VBFU2
GND
+5VAFU
GND
+3.3VCFU2
2 1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
<X57945/X654/X677> <X57945/X654/X677> 1 2 3 1 2 3
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
J318DB
J318DHB J923B J910A
J139 J136C J318LB B
1 2 29 25
DC controller PCA J327B Rear PCA
9 17 3 2 1 REFEED_SNS LOOP_SNS
1 2 High-voltage power supply
J925B J261A J262A
2 1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
SGND
SL
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
MP_PAP_SNS MP_SL
3 2 1
2 1 J924B
+3.3VCFU2
GND
+3.3VB2
J35
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
1 2
RREREG_SNS
FDOOR_SW
9 17
Rear PCA
J324 J321C
J511FDH D
J511D
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
OUT1
OUT2
SGND
SGND
SGND
PGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
PGND
PGND
PGND
SGND
+24VA
+24VA
+24VA
+24VAF
+24VAF
+3.3VB2
+3.3VOPF
+3.3VOPF
+3.3VOPF
+3.3VOPF
+3.3VOPF
OPLIFT_SNS
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J532FD
J532FDH B
N.C
3 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1
Figure 4-102 General circuit diagram, 550-sheet paper feeder
J532FL
J21 J63 J64
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2 1
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 2 1 3 2 1 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 J512D
2 1
M SW4 SW5 SW6 SW7
SW16 M CL
SR21 J512DH
CL6 M15
M12
SGND
+3.3VOPF
SGND
+3.3VOPF
SGND
3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1
J24 J41 J4
3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1
A
6 5 4 3 2 1
J511HDH
J511HD
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
D
SGND
+3.3VOPF
SGND
+3.3VOPF
+24VA
+24VA
+24VA
PGND
PGND
PGND
+3.3VB2
5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J521 J522 J511H
HCI controller PCA
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
SGND
PGND
SGND
+24VAF
+24VAF
+3.3VOPF
+3.3VOPF
+3.3VOPF
+3.3VOPF
+3.3VOPF
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J532HD
J532HDH
N.C
2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 2 1 4 3 2 1 3 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1
J532HL
J82 J70 J71 J88 J89 J76 J74 J77
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 B
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 2 1
2 1 4 3 2 1 3 2 1
1 2 2 1 1 2
SW13 M CL
M SW9 SW8 SW10
CL2 SR6
M13 M14
+3.3VOPF
SGND
+3.3VOPF
SGND
+3.3VOPF
SGND
3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1
J85 J83 J84
3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1
M21
SW3 PS206 M25 PS205 PS204 PS203 PS202 PS201 SL22
M SL
1 2 M 1 2
1 2 3 1 2 3
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 J7202L
J7006 J35 J34 J17 J1 J2 J44 2 1
J32
1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 J7202DHB
1 2 3 4
J7202DB
SOLD6
SOLD5
+24VAF
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J302B J301B J503B
SL23 M24
M22 M27 SL
PS212 PS211 PS210 PS209 PS208 1 2
PS207 M
M M
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 1 2 J7303L
2 1
J15 J20 J21 J24 J22 J23 J18 J16
J7303DH 1 2
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 4
J7303D
SOLD4
SOLD3
4
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J402B J202B J501B J401B
5 4 3 2 1 J105 4 3 2 1 J102
GND
GND
+3.3V
+3.3V
3
GND
GND
GND
+24VA
+24VS
+24VA
+24VB
+3.3VB2
+24VAF
3 2 1
FT1
FT7
J7301D
J7301DH 2 1
2 1 4 3 2 1 5 4 3 2 1
J27 J19 J26
FAN21
2
1 2 J7301L 1 2 4 3 2 1 5 4 3 2 1
2 1
SW4 SW21
4 3 2 1
1 2
SL M
SL21 PS213
M26
PS214
+24VA
+24VA
+3.3VB2
GND
GND
GND
GND
J124LH J9916
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 J124L 6 5 4 3 2 1
PS215
Staple unit
Printer
1
A
B
C
D
Figure 4-104 General circuit diagram, 3-bin stapler-stacker
247 Diagrams: General circuit diagrams
PS27 M12 PS11 M11
1
3
PS19
1
3
1 2 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 4 4 3 2 1
2
4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
SL11 J74 J72 J70 J852 J49 J48 12 J50 J52 J51 J874 J32 J576 J416 J31
FT20
FT21
1 2 3 4 1 2 3
1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 6 5 4 3 2 1
SL
1 2
N.C
N.C
N.C
11
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
12
J33DH
J33D 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4
J33L
GND
GND
GND
GND
+3.3VF
GND
11
12
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
+24VSA3
GND
+24VSB
GND
+3.3VF
+24VSB_2
GND
+3.3VF
GND
GND
GND
+24VSA
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
+24VSB
+24VSA
2 1 3 2 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 2 1
12
J781 J782 J780 J742 J735 J732 J721 J733 J720
J734
PS36 PS18 PS12 M15
1
3
1
3
SR7 LED2
PS37 SR5
M19 M18 M17 1 2 M M14
5
SL12 SR4
PS26
2
4
2
4
M M M 1 2 3 1 2
1
3
1 2 3 4 3 2 1 M
SL
J64 J169 J93 J85
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 1 2 1 2 J170 J80 J77 1 2 3
1 2 3 1 2 3 4 3 2 1
2
4
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4 3 2 1
J752 J751 J750 J761 J760 J741
J792 J790 J768 J766 J765
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
+5VF
4
J792D J790D
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J173D J138D J140D
6 5 4 3 2 1 6 5 4 3 2 1 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 J792L 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 J790L J167D
J792LH J790LH 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J173LH 1 2 3 4 5 6 J138L 1 2 3 4 5 6 J140L 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
J173L J167L J138LH J140LH
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
J167LH
3 2 1
J163D
1 2 3 J163LH
4 3 2 1 2 1 J163L 4 3 2 1 3 2 1 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 4 3 2 1
J160 J422 J159 J158 J421 J164 J174 J173 J175 J176 J167 J138 J139 J140 J141 J816
1
3
1
3
1 2 3 4 LED3 1 2 3 4
3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1
3 2 1 1 2 3 4 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 1 2 3 4
1 2 3 2 1
M M 1 2 M M
2
4
2
4
J163 SR18 PS42 SR22 SR17 SR16 SR15 SR14 SR13 SR12
M28 PS43 M27 PS38 M25 PS45 M26
3 2 1
SR19
3
SR11 4 4
1 2 3
SL14 M 5 +24VSB3 5 J857 J97 M20
6 6 1 2 3 4 PS32 PS31 PS30 SR9 SR8
SL 1 2 3
1 2 3 M22 M21
1 2 3 4 M
1 2 7 7
J119 J110 8 8 M M
GND 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 1 2 3
1 2 3 4 1 2 3
9 9
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 J102 J111
J856L J97L J103 J150
4 3 2 1 3 2 1 1 2 3 1 2 3
J108 J107 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3 4 J116DH 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 J97D
J116D J97DH
J822
PCA
9
TEA FIX
J821
+24VSB3
GND
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
2 1 4 3 2 1 3 2 1
J832 J833 J834
PCA
J831
9
TEA MOV
GND
+24VSB3
GND
GND
GND
GND
13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
5
5
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
J717
J714
+24VA
4
4
+3.3VF
+24VSA
+24VSA
+24VSA
+3.3VB2
GND GND
3
3
2
2
+3.3VF +3.3VF
1
1
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
GND
5
4
J702
J719
J715
4
3
J1LB
J1LA
J1DB
J1DA
GND
3
2
GND
2
1
+3.3VF
1
A8
A8
4
J718
GND
3
B6
B6
2
1 2 3
+3.3VF N.C
1
1
1
1
<IPTU>
2
2
J701
2
N.C FG
3
3
FAN11
3
4
4
4
1
J871D
J716
GND
3
2
J871DH
J1L
J1D
1
2
3
Sub power supply PCA
MT2
+3.3VF
1
4
A
B
C
D
Figure 4-105 General circuit diagram, floor-standing stapler-stacker
Chapter 4 Solve problems 248
6
FAN1
FAN2
3 2 1
SR1
3 2 1
M1
PS1 SL1
1
3
1 2 3 SW1 M
SL
J290 1 2 1 2
1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2
4
GND
+24VA
+24VAF
GND
GND
GND
GND
GND
+3.3VIPT
GND
GND
GND
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 2 1 5 4 3 2 1 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
J651 J652 J642 J641
5
4
J621
4
J622
3
3
GND
2
GND
2
1
1
+3.3VIPT
+3.3VIPT
J613 J612
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2
GND
+24VA
+3.3VB2
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
4
J1LB
J1LA
J1DB
J1DA
A8
A8
6
5
4
B6
B6
3 GND
N.C
1
1
2
2
2
<FSSS>
IPTU controller PCA
1
FG
3
3
4
4
1
J611
+3.3VB2
2
J1L
J1D
3
GND
4
GND
5
+24VA
6
+24VA
7
8
3
MT4
+24VA
+24VA
+3.3VB2
GND
GND
GND
J124LH
J243M J9916 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 J124L
2 1 6 5 4 3 2 1
2
Printer
1
A
B
C
D
Figure 4-106 General circuit diagram, IPTU
Internal test and information pages
Learn about printer test and information pages.
NOTE: Depending on the model, up to three pages print when printing a configuration page. In
addition to the main configuration page, the HP embedded Jetdirect configuration and the wireless
pages print.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Reports button.
● Configuration/Status pages
HP LaserJet M
1 4
5
6
2
Sep/13/2019 6:56:00 AM
4 Memory
Certain information, such as the firmware date codes, the IP address, and the email gateways, is
especially helpful while servicing the printer. This information is on the various configuration pages.
Accessories and internal storage Optional installed formatter devices and Main configuration page (Installed
accessories information Personalities and Options)
All optional devices that are installed on
the printer should be listed on the main
configuration page.
Tray and bin information Size and type by tray (including installed Main configuration page (Paper Trays
optional paper feeders) information and Options)
Engine cycles, service ID, and cartridge Engine information Main configuration page (Device
information Information)
The second configuration page is the HP embedded Jetdirect page, which contains the following
information:
HP LaserJet M
1 4
5
2
6
3
Sep/13/2019 6:56:00 AM
Item Description
5 IPv4 information
6 IPv6 information
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
NOTE: The View option is control-panel type dependent (might not be available).
Configuration/Status Pages Settings Menu Map Cancel Shows a map of the entire
control panel system and
View the selected values for each
setting.
Print
HP provides approximations
of the remaining life for
the supplies as a customer
convenience. The actual
remaining supply levels
might be different than the
approximations provided.
Configuration/Status Pages File Directory Page Cancel Shows the file name and
folder name for files that are
View stored in the printer memory.
Configuration/Status Pages Web Services Status Page Cancel Shows the detected Web
Services for the printer.
View
Fax Reports Fax Activity Log Cancel Contains a list of the faxes
that have been sent from or
Fax models only View received by this printer.
Fax Reports Billing Codes Report Cancel Provides a list of billing codes
that have been used for
Fax models only View outgoing faxes. This report
shows how many sent faxes
Print were billed to each code.
Fax Reports Blocked Fax List Cancel A list of phone numbers that
are blocked from sending
Fax models only View faxes to this printer.
Fax Reports Speed Dial List Cancel Shows the speed dials that
have been set up for this
Fax models only View printer.
Fax Reports Fax Call Report Cancel A detailed report of the last
fax operation, either sent or
Fax models only View received.
Other Pages PCL Font List Cancel Prints the available PCL fonts.
Settings menu
Learn about the control-panel Settings menu.
NOTE: You can perform basic printer setup by using the Settings menu. Use the HP Embedded Web
Server for more advanced printer setup. To open the HP Embedded Web Server, enter the printer IP
address or host name in the address bar of a Web browser.
TIP: If prompted, enter the EWS personal identification number (PIN) from a sticker on the printer
(typically located inside the front door or on a toner cartridge tray).
To display: At the printer control panel, select the Settings menu, and then select the General menu.
To print: At the printer control panel, touch (MFP) or use the arrow buttons (SFP) to select the printer
icon . For the SFP, press the OK button to print the pages.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
Date/Time Settings Date/Time Format Date Format DD/MMM/YYYY Use the Date/Time
Settings menu to
MMM/DD/YYYY specify the date
and time and to
YYYY/MMM/DD configure date/time
settings.
Date/Time Settings Date/Time Format Time Format 12 hour (AM/PM) Select the format
that the printer uses
24 hours to show the date and
time, for example 12-
hour format or 24-
hour format.
Date/Time Settings Date/Time Adjust for Daylight Check box If you are in an area
Savings that uses daylight
savings time, select
the Adjust for
Daylight Savings
box.
Energy Settings Sleep Schedule A list of scheduled Event Wake Select whether to
events displays. Type add or edit a Wake
MFP Sleep event or a Sleep
event, and then
select the time and
the days for the
wake or sleep event.
Energy Settings Sleep Schedule A list of scheduled Event Select days of the
events displays. Days week from a list.
MFP
Energy Settings Sleep Timer Settings Sleep Mode/Auto Range: 1 to 120 Set the number
Off After minutes of minutes after
MFP which the printer
Default = 60 minutes enters Sleep or
Auto Off mode. Use
the arrow buttons
on the control
panel to increase
or decrease the
number of minutes.
Energy Settings Sleep Timer Settings Sleep/Auto Off Enabled* Enable or disable the
Timer printer sleep or auto
SFP Disabled off function.
Energy Settings Sleep Timer Settings Sleep Mode/Auto Range: 1 to 120 Set the number
Off After minutes of minutes after
SFP which the printer
Default = 60 minutes enters Sleep or
Auto Off mode. Use
the arrow buttons
on the control
panel to increase
or decrease the
number of minutes.
Display Settings Language Settings Language Select from a list of Use to select a
languages that the different language
printer supports. for control panel
messages and
specify the default
keyboard layout.
When you select
a new language,
the keyboard
layout automatically
changes to match
the factory default
for the selected
language.
Display Settings Keyboard Layout Each language has Select the default
a default keyboard keyboard layout
layout. To change it, that matches the
select from a list of language you want
layouts. to use.
Display Settings Clearable Warnings Display during job* Use this feature
to set the period
Display until cleared that a clearable
warning displays
on the control
panel. If the On
setting is selected,
clearable warnings
appear until the
Clearable Warnings
button is pressed. If
the Job setting is
selected, clearable
warnings stay on the
display during the
job that generated
the warning and
disappear from the
display when the
next job starts.
Automatic: The
printer attempts
to reprint jammed
pages when
sufficient memory is
available. This is the
default setting.
E-mail (MFP)
Fax (MFP)
General (MFP)
Print (MFP)
Security (MFP)
Cancel (SFP)
Reset (SFP)
To display: At the printer control panel, select the Settings menu, and then select the Scan/Digital Send
Settings menu.
To print: At the printer control panel, touch (MFP) or use the arrow buttons (SFP) to select the printer
icon . For the SFP, press the OK button to print the pages.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Require preview
Previews are
required for all
users.
Disable preview:
Previews are
disabled for all
users.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
JPEG is a good
choice for most
graphics. Most
computers have
a browser that
can view .JPEG
files. This file type
produces one file
per page.
TIFF is a standard
file format that
many graphics
programs support.
This file type
produces one file
per page.
PDF/A (Archivable):
provides
archivable text and
image quality.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Mixed: Use to
optimize the
setting for text and
for pictures.
Text: Use to
optimize the text
portion of the copy
when text and/or
pictures are on the
original.
Printed picture:
Use for line
drawings and
preprinted images,
such as magazine
clippings or pages
from books.
Photograph: Best
suited for making
copies of printed
pictures.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Automatically Automatically
detect color or detect color or
gray black: When pages
without color are
Color detected, the
printer creates
Black an image of the
page in 1-bit
Black/Gray black if other
settings allow. If
the other settings
don't allow (File
Type, for example),
the image is in
grayscale.
Automatically
detect color or
gray: When pages
without color are
detected, the
printer creates
an image of the
page in grayscale.
Select this option
for the best image
quality for non-
color pages.
Color: Scans
documents in
color.
Black/Gray: Scans
documents in
grayscale.
Black: Scans
documents in
black and white
with a compressed
file size.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Notify when
job completes:
Select to receive
notification for this
job only.
Print: Select
to print the
notification at this
printer.
Adjust the
Darkness setting
to increase or
decrease the
amount of white
and black in the
colors.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Automatic Tone
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
To display: At the printer control panel, select the Settings menu, and then select the Fax menu.
To print: At the printer control panel, touch (MFP) or use the arrow buttons (SFP) to select the printer
icon . For the SFP, press the OK button to print the pages.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
NOTE: To set up
LAN fax or Internet
fax, use the HP
Embedded Web
Server. To open the
HP Embedded Web
Server, type the
printer network
address into a Web
browser. To
configure the fax
features, select
the Fax tab.
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Fax Dialing Fax Dial Volume Off These settings
Settings control how the
Low* fax modem dials
the outgoing fax
High number when
faxes are sent.
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Fax Dialing Dialing Mode Tone*
Settings
Pulse
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Fax Dialing Redial Interval 1 – 5 Minutes
Settings
Default = 5
minutes
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Fax Dialing Fax Send Speed Fast*
Settings
Medium
Slow
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Fax Dialing Dialing Prefix
Settings
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Fax Dialing Detect Dial Tone
Settings
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Fax Dialing Redial on Error Range: 0 – 9
Settings
Default = 2
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Fax Dialing Redial on No Range: 0 – 2
Settings Answer
Default = 0
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Fax Dialing Redial on Busy Range: 0 – 9
Settings
Default = 3
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup General Fax Send Fax Number Enabled If this feature
Settings Confirmation is enabled, you
Disabled* must enter the fax
number twice.
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup General Fax Send PC Fax Send Enabled* Enables users who
Settings have the correct
Disabled driver installed to
send faxes through
the printer from
their computers.
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup General Fax Send JBIG Compression Enabled* The JBIG
Settings compression
Disabled reduces fax-
transmission time,
which can
result in lower
phone charges.
However, using
JBIG compression
sometimes causes
compatibility
problems with
older fax
machines. If this
occurs, turn off the
JBIG compression.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup General Fax Send Error Correction Enabled* When error-
Settings Mode correction mode
Disabled is enabled
and an error
occurs during fax
transmission, the
printer sends or
receives the error
portion again.
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup General Fax Send Fax Header Prepend* Use to prepend
Settings or overlay the fax
Overlay header page.
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Billing Codes Enable Billing Off When billing codes
Codes are enabled, a
On* prompt displays
that asks the
user to enter the
billing code for an
outgoing fax. This
prompt does not
appear if the Allow
users to edit billing
codes check box is
not checked.
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Billing Codes Default Billing Specify a default
Code billing code for
faxing. If you
specify a default
billing code, this
code displays in
the Billing Code
field when the
user sends an
outgoing fax. If this
field is blank, no
default billing code
is provided for the
user.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Billing Codes Minimum Length Range: 1 – 16 Specify the
required length of
Default = 1 the billing code.
Billing codes can
be between 1 and
16 characters long.
Fax Send Settings Fax Send Setup Billing Codes Allow users to edit Off
billing codes
On*
Fax Send Settings Default Job Image Preview Make optional* Use the Image
Options Preview feature to
Require preview scan a document
and display a
Disable preview preview before
completing the job.
Select whether
this feature is
available on the
printer.
Require preview
Previews are
required for all
users.
Disable preview:
Previews are
disabled for all
users.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Resolution Standard (100 x Select the
Options 200dpi)* resolution for
outgoing faxes. If
Fine (200 x 200dpi) you increase the
resolution, faxes
Superfine (300 x might be clearer
300dpi) but they could
transmit more
slowly. Some file
types, for example
a file that will
be processed with
OCR, require a
specific resolution.
When these file
types are selected,
the Resolution
setting might
be automatically
changed to a valid
value.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax Send Settings Default Job Original Sides 1-sided* Use to describe
Options the layout for each
2-sided side of the original
document. First
Pages flip up select whether the
original document
is printed on
one side or both
sides. Then touch
the Orientation
setting to
indicate whether
the original
has portrait
or landscape
orientation. If it is
printed on both
sides, also select
the 2-sided format
that matches the
original document.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Original Sides Orientation Portrait* For some features
Options to work correctly,
Landscape you must specify
the way the
content of the
original document
is placed on the
page.
Portrait: This
setting means the
short edge of the
page is along the
top.
Landscape: This
setting means the
long edge of the
page is along the
top.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax Send Settings Default Job Notification Do not notify* Use to receive
Options notification about
Notify when job the status of a
completes sent document.
Notify when
job completes:
Select to receive
notification for this
job only.
Notify only
if job fails:
Select to receive
notification only if
the job is not sent
successfully.
E-mail: Select
to receive the
notification in an
email. Touch the
text box following
Email Address, and
then enter the
email address for
the notification.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Notification Include Thumbnail When sending an
Options analog fax, select
Include Thumbnail
to receive a
thumbnail image
of the first page
of the fax in your
notification.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Notification Notification E-mail Provide the
Options address email address
that will receive
notifications.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax Send Settings Default Job Content Orientation Portrait* For some features
Options Orientation to work correctly,
Landscape you must specify
the way the
content of the
original document
is placed on the
page.
Portrait: This
setting means the
short edge of the
page is along the
top.
Landscape: This
setting means the
long edge of the
page is along the
top.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Original Size Select from a list Use to describe
Options of sizes that the the page size
printer supports. of the original
document.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Image Adjustment Darkness Use to improve the
Options overall quality of
the copy.
Adjust the
Darkness setting
to increase or
decrease the
amount of white
and black in the
colors.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Image Adjustment Contrast Adjust the
Options Contrast setting
to increase
or decrease
the difference
between the
lightest and
darkest color on
the page.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Image Adjustment Background Adjust the
Options Cleanup Background
Cleanup setting if
you are having
trouble copying a
faint image.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax Send Settings Default Job Image Adjustment Sharpness Adjust the
Options Sharpness setting
to clarify or
soften the image.
For example,
increasing the
sharpness could
make text appear
crisper, but
decreasing it could
make photographs
appear smoother.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Image Adjustment Automatic Tone The printer
Options automatically
adjusts the
Darkness,
Contrast, and
Background
Cleanup settings
to the most
appropriate for
the scanned
document.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Optimize Text/ Manually adjust* Optimize For Optimizes the
Options Picture output for a
Text particular type
of content. You
Printed picture can optimize the
output for text,
Photograph printed pictures, or
a mixture.
Manually adjust:
Use to manually
optimize the
setting for text or
for pictures.
Text: Use to
optimize the text
portion of the copy
where text and/or
pictures are on the
original.
Printed picture:
Use for line
drawings and
preprinted images,
such as magazine
clippings or pages
from books.
Photograph: Best
suited for making
copies of printed
pictures.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax Send Settings Default Job Multi-feed Disabled This setting stops
Options Detection the scanning
Enabled* process if it
detects multiple-
page feeds
through the
document feeder.
Fax Send Settings Default Job Blank Page Disabled* Prevents blank
Options Suppression pages in the
Enabled original document
from being
included in the
output document.
Fax Receive Fax Receive Setup Ringer Volume Off Use to configure
Settings settings for
Low* receiving faxes.
High
Slow
Default = 600 ms
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax Receive Fax Printing Schedule Add Print incoming If you are using
Settings Schedule faxes a fax printing
Touch this to Edit schedule, use this
set up a fax Store incoming menu to configure
printing schedule if Delete faxes when to print
you selected the faxes.
Use Fax Printing Time
Schedule option.
Event Days
Add blocked
numbers: Enter a
fax number into
the Fax Number
to Block field, and
then touch the
arrow button to
add a new number
to the blocked fax
list.
To remove blocked
numbers: Select a
number and touch
the Delete button
to delete it from
the blocked fax list.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Notify when
job completes:
Select to receive
notification for this
job only.
Notify only
if job fails:
Select to receive
notification only if
the job is not sent
successfully.
Fax Receive Default Job Stamp Received Enabled Use this option to
Settings Options Faxes add the date, time,
Disabled* sender’s phone
number, and page
number to each
page of the faxes
that this printer
receives.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Fax Receive Default Job Fit to Page Enabled* Use to shrink faxes
Settings Options that are larger
Disabled than Letter-size or
A4-size so that
they can fit onto
a Letter-size or
A4-size page. If
this feature set
to Disabled, faxes
larger than Letter
or A4 will flow
across multiple
pages.
Received faxes
To print: At the printer control panel, touch (MFP) or use the arrow buttons (SFP) to select the printer
icon . For the SFP, press the OK button to print the pages.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Black Cartridge
Continue:
Completes the
current print job.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Continue:
Completes the
current print job.
Prompt to continue:
Allows the user
to decide whether
or not to finish
printing.
Continue:
Completes the
current print job.
Prompt to continue:
Allows the user
to decide whether
or not to finish
printing.
Continue:
Completes the
current print job.
Prompt to continue:
Allows the user
to decide whether
or not to finish
printing.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
SFP
Networking menu
Learn about the control-panel Networking menu.
To display: At the printer control panel, select the Settings menu, and then select the Networking menu.
To print: At the printer control panel, touch (MFP) or use the arrow buttons (SFP) to select the printer
icon . For the SFP, press the OK button to print the pages.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
No: A security
settings page is
not printed.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
DHCP (Dynamic
Host Configuration
Protocol): Use
for automatic
configuration from
a DHCPv4 server.
If selected and
a DHCP lease
exists, the DHCP
Release menu and
the DHCP Renew
menu are available
to set DHCP lease
options.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
NOTE: This
feature assigns a
static IP address
that might
interfere with a
managed network.
Legacy: The
address 192.0.0.192
is set, consistent
with older HP
Jetdirect printers.
No*
No*
Ethernet TCP/IP IPV4 Settings Primary DNS Range: 0-255 Specify the IP
address (n.n.n.n) of
Default = a Primary Domain
xxx.xxx.xx.xx Name System
(DNS) Server.
Ethernet TCP/IP IPV4 Settings Secondary DNS Range: 0-255 Specify the IP
address (n.n.n.n) of
Default = 0.0.0.0 a Secondary DNS
Server.
Off: IPv6 is
disabled.
On: IPv6 is
enabled.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Ethernet TCP/IP IPV6 Settings Address Manual Settings Use this item
to enable and
Enable manually configure
a TCP/IPv6
Address address.
Ethernet TCP/IP IPV6 Settings DHCPV6 Policy Router Specified Router Specified:
The stateful
Router auto-configuration
Unavailable* method to be used
by the print server
Always is determined by
a router. The
router specifies
whether the print
server obtains
its address,
its configuration
information, or
both from a
DHCPv6 server.
Router
Unavailable: If
a router is
not available,
the print server
should attempt to
obtain its stateful
configuration from
a DHCPv6 server.
Always: Whether a
router is available,
the print server
always attempts to
obtain its stateful
configuration from
a DHCPv6 server.
Ethernet TCP/IP IPV6 Settings Primary DNS Range: 0-255 Specify the IP
address (n.n.n.n) of
Default = a Primary Domain
xxx.xxx.xx.xx Name System
(DNS) Server.
Ethernet TCP/IP IPV6 Settings Secondary DNS Range: 0-255 Specify the IP
address (n.n.n.n) of
Default = 0.0.0.0 a Secondary DNS
Server.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
To specify a
proxy server, enter
its IPv4 address
or fully-qualified
domain name. The
name can be up to
255 octets.
For some
networks, you
might need to
contact your
Internet Service
Provider (ISP) for
the proxy server
address.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
NOTE: The Support Tools sub-menu contains the options for maintaining the printer and
troubleshooting printer problems.
Maintenance menu
Learn about the control-panel Maintenance menu.
Backup/Restore menu
Learn about the control-panel Backup/Restore menu.
To display: At the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu, select the Maintenance menu,
and then select the Backup/Restore menu.
To print: At the printer control panel, touch (MFP) or use the arrow buttons (SFP) to select the printer
icon . For the SFP, press the OK button to print the pages.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
Back up Data Enable Scheduled Backups Days Between Backups Enter the number of days
To display: At the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu, select the Maintenance menu,
and then select the Calibration/Cleaning menu.
To print: At the printer control panel, touch (MFP) or use the arrow buttons (SFP) to select the printer
icon . For the SFP, press the OK button to print the pages.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
To display: At the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu, select the Maintenance menu,
and then select the USB Firmware Upgrade menu.
Insert a USB storage device with a firmware upgrade bundle into the USB port, and follow the on-screen
instructions.
Service menu
Learn about the control-panel Service menu.
To display: At the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu, and then select the Service menu.
Troubleshooting menu
Learn about the control-panel Troubleshooting menu.
To display: At the printer control panel, select the Support Tools menu, and then select the
Troubleshooting menu.
In the following table, asterisks (*) indicate the factory default setting.
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Supplies Status
Page
Usage Page
Web Services
Status Page
PS Font List
Event Log
PQ
Troubleshooting
Pages
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Diagnostic Tests Paper Path Test Source Tray Select from a list Generates a test
of the available page for testing
trays. paper handling
features. You can
define the path
that is used for
the test in order to
test specific paper
paths
Diagnostic Tests Paper Path Test Number of Copies Range: 1–500 Sets the default
number of copies
Default = 1 for a copy job. This
default applies
when the Copy
or Quick Copy
function is initiated
from the printer
Home screen. The
factory default
setting is 1.
Diagnostic Tests Paper Path Test Test Duplex Path Enable Prints on both
sides of the paper.
Disable*
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
MFP
MFP
First level Second level Third level Fourth level Values Description
Clean up debug
information
Send to E-mail
Export to USB
Clean up debug
information
Send to E-mail
Export to USB
Service menu
Learn about the printer Service menu.
Service menu access is restricted by using a personal identification number (PIN). Only authorized
service people should access the Service menu. When selecting Service from the list of menus, the
printer prompts the user to enter an eight-digit PIN.
NOTE: The printer automatically exits the Service menu after about one minute if no items are
selected or changed.
2. Use the arrow buttons to scroll to Service, and then press the OK button.
3. Make sure that Service Access Code is selected for the Access Type item.
NOTE: Use the arrow buttons to select and change the Access Type item if necessary.
● 10670022 (SFP)
● 10680022 (MFP)
● Service
3. Make sure that Service Access Code is selected for the Access Type item.
● 10670022 (SFP)
● 10680022 (MFP)
Cycle Counts Total Engine Cycles Set the page count that
was stored in NVRAM
prior to installing a new
formatter.
Cycle Counts Copy Scan Count Set the total copy pages
that have been scanned.
MFP
Scanner Settings ADF Settings Leading edge front Set the calibration values.
● Reset to level 2
● Reset to level 3
● Set to non-HP
managed mode
MFP Mechanical
Calibration
MFP Enabled*
MFP StandardEIC
Workflow
WorkflowEIC
Reconfigure
Printer resets
Learn about the printer resets.
2. Use the arrow buttons to scroll to General, and then press the OK button.
3. Use the arrow buttons to scroll to Restore Factory Settings, and then press the OK button.
4. A verification message advises that completing the reset function might result in loss of data.
Select the Reset button to complete the process.
● General Settings
1. To calculate YY, subtract 1990 from the calendar year. If the printer was first used in 2002, calculate
YY as follows: 2002 - 1990 = 19. YY = 12.
● Multiply 9 by 30: 9 x 30 = 270 and add 17 to 270: 270 + 17 = 287. Thus, DDD = 287.
Use the printer Service ID number to determine whether the printer is still under warranty. Use the
following formula to convert the Service ID into the actual date the printer was placed-in-service. For the
example below, use the Service ID previously calculated (12287).
1. Add 1990 to YY to get the actual year that the printer was installed.
2. Divide DDD by 30. If there is a remainder, add 1 to the result. This is the month.
b. 287 divided by 30 = 9 with a remainder of 17. Because there is a remainder, add 1 to 9 to get 10,
which represents October.
c. The remainder in step 2 is 17, so that is the date. The complete date is 17-October-2002.
Cold reset using the Pre-boot menu from a non-touchscreen control panel
CAUTION: This procedure resets all printer configurations and settings to factory defaults (customer
configurations and settings are lost).
1. Press the Cancel button when you see the 1/8 under the logo
2. Use the arrow buttons to highlight +3:Administrator item, and then press the OK button.
3. Use the arrow buttons to highlight +8:Startup Options item, and then press the OK button.
4. Use the arrow buttons to highlight 2 Cold Reset item, and then press the OK button.
Cold reset using the Pre-boot menu from a touchscreen control panel
CAUTION: This procedure resets all printer configurations and settings to factory defaults (customer
configurations and settings are lost).
1. Touch the middle of the control-panel display when you see the 1/8 under the logo
1 2
2. Use the arrow buttons to highlight +3:Administrator item, and then press the OK button.
3. Use the arrow buttons to highlight +8:Startup Options item, and then press the OK button.
4. Use the arrow buttons to highlight 2 Cold Reset item, and then press the OK button.
5. Touch the Home button to return to the main Pre-boot menu and highlight the 1:Continue item, and
then press the OK button.
There are two locations/partitions on the hard drive where the firmware components are stored:
● The Active, where the operating system and firmware currently are executing.
If the Active location is damaged, or a Partial Clean was performed, the printer automatically copies
over the OS and firmware files from the Repository location and the printer recovers.
CAUTION: The Format Disk option performs a disk initialization for the entire disk. The operating
system, firmware files, and third party files (among other files) are completely lost. HP does not
recommend this action.
Partial Clean
The Partial Clean option erases all partitions and data on the disk drive, except for the firmware
repository where a backup copy of the firmware file is stored. This allows the disk drive to be
reformatted without having to download a firmware upgrade file to return the printer to a bootable
state.
● Customer-defined settings, third-party solutions, firmware files, and the operating system are
deleted.
● Rebooting the printer restores the firmware files from the Repository location, but does not restore
any customer-defined settings.
● For previous HP printers, a Hard Disk Initialization is similar to executing the Partial Clean function
for this printer.
CAUTION: HP recommends backing-up printer configuration data before executing a Partial Clean to
retain customer-defined settings (if needed). See the Backup/Restore item in the Device Maintenance
menu.
● The printer will not respond to commands from the control panel.
● Executing the Partial Clean function is helpful for troubleshooting hard disk problems.
This procedure resets all printer configurations and settings to factory defaults (customer
configurations and settings are lost).
1. Press the Cancel button when you see the 1/8 under the logo
2. Use the arrow buttons to highlight +3:Administrator item, and then press the OK button.
3. Use the arrow buttons to highlight Partial Clean item, and then press the OK button.
This procedure resets all printer configurations and settings to factory defaults (customer
configurations and settings are lost).
1. Touch the middle of the control-panel display when you see the 1/8 under the logo
1 2
2. Use the arrow buttons to highlight +3:Administrator item, and then press the OK button.
3. Use the arrow buttons to highlight Partial Clean item, and then press the OK button.
5. Touch the Home button to return to the main Pre-boot menu and highlight the Continue item, and
then press the OK button.
Format Disk
The Format Disk option erases the entire disk drive.
CAUTION: After executing a Format Disk option, the printer is not bootable.
● Customer-defined settings, third-party solutions, firmware files, and the operating system are
deleted.
NOTE: Rebooting the printer does not restore the firmware files
● Rebooting the printer restores the firmware files from the Repository location, but does not restore
any customer-defined settings.
● After executing the Format Disk function, the message 99.09.67 displays on the control panel.
CAUTION: HP recommends not using the Format Disk option unless an error occurs and the solution
in the printer service manual recommends this solution. After executing the Format Disk function, the
printer is unusable.
HP recommends backing-up printer configuration data before executing a Format Disk to retain
customer-defined settings (if needed). See the Backup/Restore item in the Device Maintenance menu.
● The printer will not respond to commands from the control panel.
● Executing the Format Disk function is helpful for troubleshooting hard disk problems.
This procedure resets all printer configurations and settings to factory defaults (customer
configurations and settings are lost).
1. Press the Cancel button when you see the 1/8 under the logo
2. Use the arrow buttons to highlight +3:Administrator item, and then press the OK button.
3. Use the arrow buttons to highlight Format Disk item, and then press the OK button.
NOTE: When the Format Disk operation is complete, reload the printer firmware.
This procedure resets all printer configurations and settings to factory defaults (customer
configurations and settings are lost).
1. Touch the middle of the control-panel display when you see the 1/8 under the logo
1 2
2. Use the arrow buttons to highlight +3:Administrator item, and then press the OK button.
3. Use the arrow buttons to highlight Format Disk item, and then press the OK button.
NOTE: When the Format Disk operation is complete, reload the printer firmware.
Power-on checks
Learn about power-on checks.
The basic printer functions should start up when the printer is connected into an electrical outlet and
the power switch is pushed to the on position. If the printer does not start, use the information in this
section to isolate and solve the problem.
If the control panel display remains blank, random patterns display, or asterisks remain on the control
panel display, perform power-on checks to find the cause of the problem.
During normal operation, a cooling fan begins to spin briefly after the printer power is turned on. Place
a hand over the fan intake vents located on the right-side cover. When the fan is correctly operating, air
passing into the printer is felt. Lean close to the printer to hear the fan operating. If the fan is operating,
the dc side of the power supply is functioning.
After the fan is operating, the main motor turns on (unless the top cover is open, a jam condition is
sensed, or the paper-path sensors are damaged). Visually and audibly determine that the main motor is
turned on.
If the fan and main motor are operating correctly, the next troubleshooting step is to isolate print engine,
formatter, and control panel problems. Perform an engine test. If the formatter is damaged, it might
interfere with the engine test. If the engine-test page does not print, try removing the formatter, and then
performing the engine test again. If the engine test is then successful, the problem is almost certainly
with the formatter, the control panel, or the cable that connects them.
1. Verify that power is available to the printer. If the printer is plugged into a surge protector or
uninterruptible power supply (UPS), remove it. Plug the printer directly into a known operating wall
receptacle (make sure that the wall receptacle provides the correct voltage and current for the
printer).
NOTE: Unplug any other devices on the same circuit that the printer is using.
2. Try another known operating wall receptacle and a different power cord.
3. To eliminate a thermal switch issue, unplug the power cord and leave it unplugged for over 20
minutes. Re-attach the power cord, and then turn the power on again.
4. During normal operation, a cooling fan or fans begin to spin briefly after the printer power is turned
on. Place a hand over the cover vent or vents to feel air passing out of the printer. Lean close to
NOTE: Operational fans, motors, and control-panel lights indicate the following:
● The power supply is providing either or both 24 Vdc and 5 Vdc voltages.
5. If the printer powers on, but the control panel is blank, make sure that the control-panel display wire
harness or harnesses and flat flexible cable or cables (FFCs) are connected.
NOTE: The following conditions indicate that the printer has frozen while in Sleep mode or Sleep
delay. Opening a door or pressing a control-panel button should cause the printer to wake up from
Sleep mode or Sleep delay.
If the control panel is not responding, or if it appears black or blank, try the following:
b. Verify that the system is correctly functioning by printing a test page. Does the test page print
correctly?
c. Verify that the control panel is correctly functioning. If it is not, turn the printer off and
reseat the control-panel assembly cable connections at the control-panel assembly and the
formatter.
d. Try upgrading the firmware. If the firmware upgrade fails to resolve the problem, and the
printer still freezes while in Sleep mode or Sleep delay, elevate the case.
e. If the error persists and the EWS functions correctly, replace the control-panel assembly.
6. If normal start-up noises are not heard, turn the printer off, and then remove any installed
accessories (for example, envelope feeders, paper feeders, or output accessories).
7. Turn the printer on, and then listen for start-up noises. If normal start-up noises are heard, the
problem might be with an accessory.
8. Perform an engine test. The engine test procedure varies by printer, so refer to the printer Service
Manual to get instructions.
CAUTION: Under NO circumstances should a formatter from a different printer be installed during
the repair or troubleshooting processes. The formatter stores important data specific to the model
of printer it is installed in and is not designed to be swapped or repurposed in any way. Return a
used formatter to HP.
● Serial number, product number, product name, page count, and supported cartridges
information change and might make a product unusable
If a used formatter is installed and causes this issue, the partner must cover the costs of the
repair in the form of a product replacement. There is no method in the field to recover a printer
where a used formatter is installed.
● HP internal link: 33.02.01 error or printer name and/or product number changes after replacing
the formatter
● HP external partner link: 33.02.01 error or printer name and/or product number changes after
replacing the formatter
To access the HP partner link, you must first log in to the HP Partner First Portal and then connect
to WISE.
NOTE: If the engine test page does not print, turn the printer off, reconnect the formatter power
connector, remove the embedded MultiMedia Card (eMMC), and then try the engine test again. If
the page prints, the problem might be the eMMC.
10. If after replacing the formatter or eMMC normal start-up noises are still not heard, replace the DC
controller.
11. If the print engine appears to be correctly operating (the engine test page successfully printed) and
the control panel is still blank, replace the power supply.
Engine diagnostics
Learn about internal engine diagnostics that help in troubleshooting print quality, paper path, noise,
assembly, and timing issues.
Engine test
Learn about troubleshooting the printer using the engine test diagnostic.
When the engine test is performed, a test page with lines prints if the engine is functioning correctly.
NOTE: Depending on printer models, either a simplex engine test page, a duplex engine test page, or
both simplex and duplex engine test pages might be available.
Use a small pointed object to depress and hold the engine test button (location varies depending on the
printer model). An engine test page prints. The test page can use only Tray 2 as the paper source, so
make sure that paper is loaded in Tray 2.
Defeating interlocks
Learn about defeating printer interlocks.
Different tests can be used to isolate different types of issues. For assembly or noise isolation, run the
diagnostic test when the front, right or toner supply (model specific) door is open.
Defeating the door interlocks allows observation of the paper pick operation.
TIP: Fold a stiff piece of paper, for example a business card or index card, into a strip, and insert
the strip into the slot for the door interlock logic switch.
It might be easier to use a small flat-blade screwdriver to defeat the door interlock.
TIP: Fold a stiff piece of paper, for example a business card or index card, into a strip, and insert
the strip into the slot for the door interlock logic switch.
It might be easier to use a small flat-blade screwdriver to defeat the door interlock.
TIP: Fold a stiff piece of paper, for example a business card or index card, into a strip, and insert
the strip into the slot for the door interlock logic switch.
It might be easier to use a small flat-blade screwdriver to defeat the door interlock.
Figure 4-115 Defeat the toner supply door interlock (X654/X677 models)
CAUTION: Do not perform a disable cartridge check on color printers that use a two-part cartridge
design. Doing so might result in toner cross contamination in the supply lines.
Use this diagnostic test to print internal pages or send an external job to the printer when a toner
cartridge is removed or exchanged. Supply errors are ignored while the printer is in this mode.
When the printer is in this mode, access the troubleshooting menus and print internal pages (the print
quality pages will be the most useful). This test can be used to isolate problems, such as noise, and to
isolate print-quality problems that are related to a toner cartridge.
NOTE: Do not remove or exchange the toner cartridge until after beginning the disable cartridge
check diagnostic.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Troubleshooting
● Diagnostic Tests
Item Description
CAUTION: Under NO circumstances should a formatter from a different printer be installed during
the repair or troubleshooting processes. The formatter stores important data specific to the model of
printer it is installed in and is not deigned to be swapped or repurposed in any way. Return a used
formatter to HP.
● Serial number, product number, product name, page count, and supported cartridges information
change and might make a product unusable.
If a used formatter is installed and causes this issue, the partner must cover the costs of the repair in
the form of a product replacement. There is no method in the field to recover a printer where a used
formatter is installed.
This part contains components that are electrostatic discharge (ESD) sensitive. To reduce the
possibility of ESD damage, always touch the sheet-metal chassis to ground yourself before touching an
ESD sensitive part.
The following list describes the heartbeat LED operation while the printer is executing the firmware boot
process.
NOTE: If after initialization, the heartbeat LED is not solid green, see Table 4-25 Heartbeat LED, printer
operational on page 317.
● Green
● Yellow (Amber)
– Solid: The FFC between the formatter and DC controller is not connected or is damaged.
● Red
– Solid: Valid SPI code; there is a problem releasing ASIC and running the BIOS.
Solid: BIOS initiates PROSAC to change the LED from red to green.
The following table describes the heartbeat LED operation when the printer completes the firmware
boot process and is in the Ready state.
Off TIP: The heartbeat LED is off if the power cable is disconnected, the product power switch is in the off
position, or the product is in Sleep Mode.
NOTE: This condition is not usually caused by a formatter failure. Turn the power off, and then on again. If
the error persists, perform a firmware upgrade.
HP Jetdirect LEDs
The embedded HP Jetdirect print server has two LEDs. When the printer is connected to a properly
working network through a network cable, the yellow LED indicates network activity, and the green LED
indicates the link status.
A blinking yellow LED indicates network traffic. If the green LED is off, a link has failed. For link failures,
check all of the network cable connections.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Settings button.
● Networking
● Ethernet
● Link Speed
3. Touch the desired link speed setting, and then touch the Done button.
If the printer is not correctly functioning, complete the steps (in the order given) in the following checklist.
If the printer fails a checklist step, follow the corresponding troubleshooting suggestions for that step. If
a checklist step resolves the problem, skip the remaining checklist items.
1. If the control panel is blank or black, check the following before proceeding:
● Check to make sure that the printer is not in Sleep mode (press a button on the control panel).
● Make sure that the line voltage is correct for the printer power configuration. (See the label that
is on the back of the printer for voltage requirements.) If a power strip is in use, and its voltage
is not within specifications, connect the printer directly into the electrical outlet. If it is already
connected into the outlet, try a different outlet.
NOTE: The following conditions indicate that the printer has frozen while in Sleep mode. Opening
a door or pressing a control-panel button causes the printer to wake up from Sleep mode.
If the control panel is not responding, or if it appears black or blank, try the following:
TIP: The LED on the formatter will blink if the control panel is not detected or the cables are
not properly seated.
● Try printing from a host computer. Does the printer print a test page?
iii. Turn the printer power on, and then check for functionality of the control-panel by
pressing a button on the control panel.
d. Try upgrading the firmware. If the firmware upgrade fails to resolve the problem, and the
printer still freezes while in Sleep mode, elevate the case.
e. If the error persists and the EWS functions correctly, replace the control-panel assembly.
2. The control panel should indicate a Ready, Paused, or Sleep mode on status. If an error message
displays, resolve the error.
● Try using the Power-on checks section in this manual to solve the problem.
3. For network connection errors, verify that the network port is active and that the cables are
securely seated.
a. Check the network cable connections between the printer and the computer or network port.
Make sure that the connections are secure.
b. Make sure that the cables are not faulty by trying different cables, if possible.
4. Print a configuration page. If the printer is connected to a network, an HP Jetdirect page also prints.
a. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Reports button.
Open the following menus:
i. Configuration/Status Pages
TIP: Multiple report pages can be selected, and then printed together.
● If the pages do not print, check that at least one tray contains paper.
TIP: Make sure that the selected paper size and type meet HP specifications. Also open the
Trays menu on the printer control panel and verify that the tray is configured correctly for the
paper type and size.
● If the page does not print correctly, the problem is with the printer hardware.
● If the page prints correctly, the printer hardware is working. The problem is with the host
computer, with the print driver, or with the program.
5. Print a supplies status page and then check that the maintenance items below are not at their
end-of-life.
NOTE: HP long-life consumables and maintenance kit life specifications are estimations. Actual
individual life/yield during normal use varies depending on usage, environment, media, and other
factors. Estimated life is not an implied guarantee or warrantable.
a. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Reports button.
Open the following menus:
i. Configuration/Status Pages
TIP: Multiple report pages can be selected, and then printed together.
6. Verify that the correct print driver for this printer is installed. Check the program to make sure
that the print driver for this printer is used. The print driver is on the CD that came with
the printer, or can be downloaded from this Web site: http://www.hp.com/support/colorlj6700
or http://www.hp.com/support/colorlj6800MFP or http://www.hp.com/support/colorlj6801MFP or
http://www.hp.com/support/colorljX654 or http://www.hp.com/support/colorljX677MFP.
7. Print a short document from a different program that has worked in the past. If this solution works,
the problem is with the program. If this solution does not work (the document does not print),
complete these steps:
a. Try printing the job from another computer that has the printer software installed.
b. If the printer is connected to the network, connect the printer directly to a host computer with
a USB cable. Redirect the printer to the correct port, or reinstall the software (make sure to
select the new connection type).
Use the diagnostics in this section to test the control panel hardware and display using the printer
firmware system diagnostics.
Use the following procedure to open the control panel system diagnostics tests.
2. Touch the middle of the control panel display when you see the 1/8 under the logo.
1 2
3. On the Pre-boot menu screen, use the following buttons to navigate the tests.
Button Description
Not used.
4. Use the down arrow button to scroll to +3 Administration, and then press the OK button to select
it.
Screen test
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic screen test.
3. Touch the touchscreen to scroll though the remaining touchscreen test screens.
Screen Description
Screen Description
Screen Description
Checkerboard
Multicolor stripes
Touch test
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic touch test.
SoftKey test
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic SoftKey test.
2. Use the down arrow button to scroll to 3 SoftKey Test, and then press the OK button to select it.
Backlight test
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic backlight test.
After selecting the 4 Backlight Test, the screen automatically dims, and then returns to full
brightness.
Sound test
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic sound test.
2. Use the down arrow button to scroll to 5 Sound Test, and then press the OK button to select it.
After selecting the 5 Sound Test, the printer emits a series of audible tones.
Version
Learn about the control panel system diagnostic version information.
2. Use the down arrow button to scroll to 7 Version, and then press the OK button to select it.
NOTE: The following types of information are for the control panel only, not the printer.
● Panel ID
● Hardware (version)
● Firmware (version)
● KB Hw (version)
● KB Firm (version)
● LCD Vendor
For HP channel partners access WISE, see Accessing WISE for HP channel partners (HP Partner Portal)
on page 136 or Accessing WISE for HP channel partners (CSDP) on page 135.
WISE is available to call agents, service technicians, and HP internal users. The level of detail available
depends on your access credentials. To learn how to find support content in WISE, watch the video here.
To learn how to find support content in WISE, watch the video here: Finding Error Code and Control Panel
Message Document in WISE.
TIP: The Product Detail Page (PDP) is available from the WISE home page. Enter, and then select a
product name or number in the Go to a Product Detail Page area (callout 1), or select the …or select your
product from a list item (callout 2) on the WISE home page.
TIP: To view a list of control panel message documents (CPMD) per printer, search for the following
topic in WISE: HP LaserJet, OfficeJet, PageWide, ScanJet Enterprise - Control panel message
document (CPMD) list or click the link below.
Use one of the following methods to search for CPMD error code information.
● Method 1: Use the WISE home page Error Code Lookup tool on page 334
● Method 2: Search for error codes using the WISE search function on page 335
● Method 3: Search for error codes using the Product Detail Page on page 337
Method 1: Use the WISE home page Error Code Lookup tool
Use the WISE Error Code Lookup tool to find error code troubleshooting procedures using the following
steps.
1. On the WISE home page, click the Error Code Lookup tool icon.
2. Enter a printer model number (for example, M606) in the Error Code Lookup dialog box.
NOTE: Selecting the series item from the drop-down list is recommended for the most accurate
search return.
M606
4. Type the error code (for example, 13.b2.d2) in the Error Code Lookup keyword field, and then select
the search icon.
5. The error code troubleshooting content displays in the All Search Results area.
Method 2: Search for error codes using the WISE search function
Use the WISE search function to find error code troubleshooting procedures using the following steps.
2. A drop-down list appears. Click on the full printer series name (for example, HP LaserJet Enterprise
M606 series) in the list.
NOTE: Selecting the series item from the drop-down list is recommended for the most accurate
search return.
3. Type the error code (for example, 13.E1.D3) in the Search keyword field, and then select the search
icon.
1 2
4. The error code troubleshooting content displays in the All Search Results area.
Method 3: Search for error codes using the Product Detail Page
Use the WISE Product Detail Page (PDP) to find error code troubleshooting procedures using the
following steps.
1. On the WISE home page, enter a printer model number (for example, M606) in the Go to a Product
Detail page dialog box.
TIP: To find a PDP from a list of products by product type, select the …or select your product from
a list item just below the dialog box.
2. A drop-down list appears. Click on the full printer series name (for example, HP LaserJet Enterprise
M606 series) in the list.
NOTE: Selecting the series item from the drop-down list is recommended for the most accurate
search return.
3. Type the error code (for example, 13.E1.D3) in the Error Code Lookup field, and then select the search
icon.
1 2
4. The error code troubleshooting content displays in the All Search Results area.
IMPORTANT: A Partner Admin must requested access, via the CSDP portal, to create a new user
before you can sign into the CDSP portal.
1. Sign-in to the CSDP portal (click csdp.hp.com to access the sign-in page).
2. On the CSDP home page, click the Knowledge and Training item.
TIP: Use the Knowledge and Training item at the top of the CSDP home page (callout 1), or the
Knowledge and Training action icon (callout 2).
NOTE: If this is your first visit to the HP Partner Portal, you will be asked to create an account. Follow
the setup directions using your HP Partner credentials.
1. Sign-in to the HP Partner Portal (click https://partner.hp.com to access the sign-in page).
NOTE: A complete CPMD is not included in this service manual. Click on the links below to access a
CPMD on the HP Web-based Interactive Search Engine (WISE) site.
HP Color LaserJet Enterprise 6700, 6701, MFP 6800, 6801 - Control Panel Message Document (CPMD)
HP Color LaserJet Enterprise X654, X65455, X65465, MFP X677, MFP X67755, MFP X67765 - Control
Panel Message Document (CPMD)
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Reports menu icon.
3. Touch Supplies Status Page, and then touch the Print icon to print the page.
CAUTION: The Format Disk option performs a disk initialization for the entire disk. The operating
system, firmware files, and third party files (among other files) will be completely lost. HP does not
recommend this action unless it is specified as a solution in the CPMD.
TIP: The Pre-boot menu is also remotely accessible by using a telnet network protocol (Remote
Admin) to establish an administration connection to the printer.
2. Touch the middle of the control-panel display when you see the 1/8 under the logo.
1 2
Button Description
Not used.
4. Use the arrow buttons on the touchscreen to navigate the Pre-boot menu.
CAUTION: This procedure resets all printer configurations and settings to factory defaults (customer
configurations and settings are lost).
1. Touch the middle of the control-panel display when you see the 1/8 under the logo.
1 2
2. Use the down arrow button to highlight the +3:Administrator item, and then touch the OK button.
3. Use the down arrow button to highlight the +8:Startup Options item, and then touch the OK
button.
4. Use the down arrow button to highlight the 2 Cold Reset item, and then touch the OK button to
select it.
5. Touch the Home button to return to the main Pre-boot menu and highlight the 1:Continue item, and
then touch the OK button.
Remote Admin
Learn about the printer Remote Admin function.
The Remote Admin feature allows remote access the printer Pre-boot menu (BIOS environment). The
printer functions as a telnet server which uses the telnet networking protocol to transmit text data. Any
computer (with telnet installed and enabled) can function as the telnet client to remotely display and
interact with the Pre-boot menu.
IMPORTANT: While the Remote Admin function allows remote access the Pre-boot menu, for security
reasons the Remote Admin connection must be initiated by a person that is physically present at the
printer.
Cold reset using the Pre-boot menu from a touchscreen control panel 345
Required software and network connection
Before using the Remote Admin feature, make sure that the telnet network protocol is installed and
enabled on the remote telnet client computer.
NOTE: This section describes enabling and configuring the telnet feature for computers using a
Windows® operating system.
HP recommends that the telnet client computer be a Windows-based system; however, there are
other operating systems that support the telnet network protocol. For information about enabling and
configuring the telnet network protocol for other operating systems, see the owner's manual for that
operating system.
NOTE: The figures and menus in this section are for the Windows 10® operating system. Screens and
menu selections might vary slightly for other operating systems.
1. Use the Start menu to open the Windows Settings dialog box, and then search for Turn Windows
features on or off. Click the Turn Windows features on or off item.
2. In the Windows Features box, scroll down to Telnet Client. If the check box is not checked, click the
box to select it, and then click the OK button.
TIP: If the check box is already checked then the telnet client function is already enabled. Click the
Cancel button.
Network connection
The remote telnet client computer must have direct network access to the printer for the Remote Admin
function to operate. This means that the telnet client computer must be on the same network as the
printer.
The Remote Admin function cannot be accessed through a network firewall or other remote access
network security programs.
If a private network is not accessible, ask the network administrator to set up a virtual private network
(VPN) connection to the network.
NOTE: This person might need to sign in with an administrator or service password depending on how
the printer is configured.
2. The HP logo displays on the printer control panel. When a 1/8 with an underscore displays, touch the
middle of the screen to open the Pre-boot menu.
4. Use the arrow buttons on the touchscreen to scroll down and highlight the +A:Remote Admin item,
and then touch the OK button to select it.
5. Use the arrow buttons on the touchscreen to scroll down and highlight the 1:Start Telnet item, and
then touch the OK button to select it.
● If an error message displays, use the steps below to identify the problem.
– The printer should be configured to use a static IP address, but is configured to use
DHCP instead.
– The printer is configured to use a static IP address, but the IP address is incorrect.
c. The printer is correctly configured to use DHCP, but the DHCP server is not turned on or is
malfunctioning.
7. When the printer telnet server function is initialized, the following screen appears. Use the
information on this screen to connect the remote telnet client computer to the printer.
NOTE: The printer is now ready to receive remote telnet client commands.
1. From the Start menu open the Command Prompt desktop application.
TIP: Type cmd in the application search dialogue box to find the application.
3. Type o <IP ADDRESS> at the telnet prompt, and then press the Enter key.
NOTE: For <IP ADDRESS>, substitute the IP address that was displayed in step 7 of the "Start the
telnet server function at the printer" topic.
TIP: If the telnet connection fails to establish a connection, the printer is probably behind a firewall
or on a different network that the remote telnet client computer.
4. Type the PIN that was displayed in step 7 of then "Start the telnet server function at the printer"
topic at the prompt, and then press the Enter key.
IMPORTANT: Make sure to type the PIN correctly. After five incorrect PIN entries, the printer
terminates the Remote Admin connection. The Remote Admin feature must be re-initiated at the
printer. See the "Start the telnet server function at the printer" topic.
5. The following screen displays when the correct PIN is entered. and the Remote Admin connection
is successful. For information about the Pre-boot menu and options, see "Pre-boot menu options" in
the printer Service Manual.
NOTE: Because a Remote Admin connection is an unsecured telnet network protocol connection,
the following Pre-boot menu items are disabled for the remote telnet client computer.
NOTE: The following procedure describes terminating a Remote Admin connection from the remote
telnet client computer.
2. Use the arrow buttons on the keyboard to scroll down to the +A:Remote Admin item, and then press
the Enter key.
3. Use the arrow buttons on the keyboard to scroll down to the 2:Stop Telnet item, and then press the
Enter key. The Remote Admin connection between the printer and the remote telnet client computer
terminates.
IMPORTANT: The printer remains in the Pre-boot menu. Have the person that is physically present
at the printer do the following:
● Touch the Home button to return to the main Pre-boot menu and highlight the 1:Continue item,
and then touch the OK button. The printer will continue to initialize.
Print the 50 most recent events in the Event Log. For each event, the printed log shows the error number,
page count, error code, and description or personality.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Troubleshooting menu
icon.
For HP channel partners access WISE, see Accessing WISE for HP channel partners (HP Partner Portal)
on page 136 or Accessing WISE for HP channel partners (CSDP) on page 135.
WISE is available to call agents, service technicians, and HP internal users. The level of detail available
depends on your access credentials. To learn how to find support content in WISE, watch the video here.
TIP: The Product Detail Page (PDP) is available from the WISE home page. Enter, and then select a
product name or number in the Go to a Product Detail Page area (callout 1), or select the …or select your
product from a list item (callout 2) on the WISE home page.
Many types of printer documentation and information are available on WISE. This section details
methods for finding error code descriptions and solutions.
TIP: To view a list of control panel message documents (CPMD) per printer, search for the following
topic in WISE: HP LaserJet, OfficeJet, PageWide, ScanJet Enterprise - Control panel message
document (CPMD) list or click the link below.
Use one of the following methods to search for CPMD error code information.
● Method 1: Use the WISE home page Error Code Lookup tool on page 354
● Method 2: Search for error codes using the WISE search function on page 356
● Method 3: Search for error codes using the Product Detail Page on page 357
Method 1: Use the WISE home page Error Code Lookup tool
Use the WISE Error Code Lookup tool to find error code troubleshooting procedures using the following
steps.
1. On the WISE home page, click the Error Code Lookup tool icon.
2. Enter a printer model number (for example, M606) in the Error Code Lookup dialog box.
3. A drop-down list appears. Click on the full printer series name (for example, HP LaserJet Enterprise
M606 series) in the list.
NOTE: Selecting the series item from the drop-down list is recommended for the most accurate
search return.
M606
4. Type the error code (for example, 13.b2.d2) in the Error Code Lookup keyword field, and then select
the search icon.
5. The error code troubleshooting content displays in the All Search Results area.
Method 2: Search for error codes using the WISE search function
Use the WISE search function to find error code troubleshooting procedures using the following steps.
1. On the WISE home page, enter a printer model number (for example, M606) in the Search dialog box.
2. A drop-down list appears. Click on the full printer series name (for example, HP LaserJet Enterprise
M606 series) in the list.
NOTE: Selecting the series item from the drop-down list is recommended for the most accurate
search return.
3. Type the error code (for example, 13.E1.D3) in the Search keyword field, and then select the search
icon.
1 2
4. The error code troubleshooting content displays in the All Search Results area.
Method 3: Search for error codes using the Product Detail Page
Use the WISE Product Detail Page (PDP) to find error code troubleshooting procedures using the
following steps.
1. On the WISE home page, enter a printer model number (for example, M606) in the Go to a Product
Detail page dialog box.
TIP: To find a PDP from a list of products by product type, select the …or select your product from
a list item just below the dialog box.
2. A drop-down list appears. Click on the full printer series name (for example, HP LaserJet Enterprise
M606 series) in the list.
NOTE: Selecting the series item from the drop-down list is recommended for the most accurate
search return.
3. Type the error code (for example, 13.E1.D3) in the Error Code Lookup field, and then select the search
icon.
1 2
4. The error code troubleshooting content displays in the All Search Results area.
IMPORTANT: A Partner Admin must requested access, via the CSDP portal, to create a new user
before you can sign into the CDSP portal.
1. Sign-in to the CSDP portal (click csdp.hp.com to access the sign-in page).
2. On the CSDP home page, click the Knowledge and Training item.
TIP: Use the Knowledge and Training item at the top of the CSDP home page (callout 1), or the
Knowledge and Training action icon (callout 2).
3. Select HP Technical Documentation on the Knowledge and Training page to open the WISE portal
home page.
NOTE: If this is your first visit to the HP Partner Portal, you will be asked to create an account. Follow
the setup directions using your HP Partner credentials.
2. On the HP Partner Portal home page, click the Services & Support item.
● The first two characters are numeric and represent the system component that is causing the error.
For example, in error code 10.22.15, 10 = Supplies for HP LaserJets.
● The remaining four characters (W, X, Y, and Z values) further define the error.
The CPMD is a comprehensive list of error codes, diagnostic and troubleshooting steps to clear or
resolve the error, and other helpful information such as service mode pins and part numbers.
The CPMD is continually updated and republished with the latest information for the following error
codes.
11.WX.YZ Real-time clock Internal error with the clock on the formatter.
41.WX.YZ Fuser, Laser scanner, or Paper path Miscellaneous error including general and
misprint or mismatch errors typically involving
(but not limited to) the fuser, the laser scanner,
or the paper path.
61.WX.YZ Engine (PageWide) Print engine error with the 8–bit data package.
81.WX.YZ Near Field Communication (NFC) Wireless, Bluetooth or internal EIO error.
90.WX.YZ Internal diagnostics Internal test of systems (i.e. disk, CPB, display) or
interconnection error.
7
1
2
6
3
5
Item Description
4 Optional Tray 4
5 Optional Tray 3
6 Tray 2
7 Output bin
The auto-navigation feature assists in clearing jams by providing step-by-step instructions on the control
panel.
When you complete a step, the printer displays instructions for the next step until you have completed all
steps in the procedure.
2. Use paper that is not wrinkled, folded, or damaged. If necessary, use paper from a different
package.
3. Use paper that has not previously been printed or copied on.
4. Make sure the tray is not overfilled. If it is, remove the entire stack of paper from the tray, straighten
the stack, and then return some of the paper to the tray.
5. Make sure the paper guides in the tray are adjusted correctly for the size of paper. Adjust the guides
so they are touching the paper stack without bending it.
7. If you are printing on heavy, embossed, or perforated paper, use the manual feed feature and feed
sheets one at a time.
8. Open the Trays menu on the printer control panel. Verify that the tray is configured correctly for the
paper type and size.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
2. Open the right door and remove paper from the area shown.
4. Make sure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
6. Load the paper back into the tray and restart the print job.
7. If the same jam appears remove and clean the tray 1 pick, feed and separation rollers.
c. Grasp the left- and right-side of the separation roller assembly, and then lift the assembly up.
f. Install the rollers back into tray one and test the tray by printing from tray 1.
8. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
5. Remove the paper from the tray and discard any bent, curled, or damaged sheets.
7. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
8. If the error persists, clean the Tray 2 pick, feed, separation rollers.
To remove the roller assembly, gently pull on the side of the assembly and slide out as shown.
NOTE: Make sure your hands are clean before touching the rollers. Oils or debris from hands
can cause paper pickup issues.
9. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
Use the following procedure to check for paper in all possible jam locations related to the 550-sheet
trays. When a jam occurs, the control panel displays an animation that assists in clearing the jam.
View a video of how to clear a jam in Tray 3, and the optional trays
6. Remove the paper from the tray and discard any bent, curled, or damaged sheets.
8. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
9. If the error persists, clean the Tray 3 pick, feed, separation rollers.
To remove the roller assembly, gently pull on the side of the assembly and slide out as shown.
NOTE: Make sure your hands are clean before touching the rollers. Oils or debris from hands
can cause paper pickup issues.
10. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
7. Open Tray 4.
9. Make sure that the tray width and length guides are set to the correct paper size for the paper
being installed into the tray and that the tray is not over filled above the fill mark (line below 3
triangles on rear guide).
11. If the error persists, clean the Tray 4 pick, feed, separation rollers.
To remove the roller assembly, gently pull on to the side of the rollers as shown.
NOTE: Make sure your hands are clean before touching the rollers. Oils or debris from hands
can cause paper pickup issues.
12. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
7. Open Tray 4.
9. Make sure that the tray width guide is set to the correct paper size for the paper being installed into
the tray and that the tray is not over filled above the fill mark (line below 3 triangles on rear guide).
11. If the error persists, clean the Tray 4 pick, feed, and separation rollers.
To remove the roller assembly, gently pull on to the side of the rollers as shown.
NOTE: Do not touch the rubber part of the rollers with hands. Oils or debris from hands can
cause paper pickup issues.
12. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
z = paper tray. This can be trays 1-5 or "D" for duplex jobs
Or
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area
CAUTION: The fuser can be hot while the printer is in use. Wait for the fuser to cool before
handling it.
5. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
6. Ensure the paper tray guides are set to the correct size for the paper loaded.
7. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
z = paper tray. This can be trays 1-5 or "D" for duplex print jobs.
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area
CAUTION: The fuser can be hot while the printer is in use. Wait for the fuser to cool before
handling it.
4. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
5. Ensure the paper tray guides are set to the correct size for the paper loaded.
6. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
y = jam type (A or D)
z = Paper tray. This can be 0-5 or "D" for duplex print jobs.
Or
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area
NOTE: The fuser is hot while the printer is in use. Wait for the fuser to cool before clearing jams.
a. Squeeze the release levers on the handles (circle call-outs) and then remove the fuser.
c. Open the fuser access and check for a z-fold paper jam.
4. If the error persists, ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP
specifications for the printer.
5. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
NOTE: The fuser is hot while the printer is in use. Wait for the fuser to cool before clearing jams.
2. Gently remove any jammed paper from the duplexer paper path.
4. If the error persists, ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP
specifications for the printer.
5. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
z = paper type that is being printed on. This can be 0-9 or A-F.
2. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
3. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
8
2
3
7
6 4
5
Item Description
1 Document feeder
5 Optional Tray 4
6 Optional Tray 3
7 Tray 2
8
2
7 3
6 4
5
Item Description
1 Document feeder
6 Tray 3
7 Tray 2
The auto-navigation feature assists in clearing jams by providing step-by-step instructions on the control
panel.
When you complete a step, the printer displays instructions for the next step until you have completed all
steps in the procedure.
View a video that demonstrates how to load paper in a way that reduces the number of paper
jams
2. Use paper that is not wrinkled, folded, or damaged. If necessary, use paper from a different
package.
3. Use paper that has not previously been printed or copied on.
4. Make sure the tray is not overfilled. If it is, remove the entire stack of paper from the tray, straighten
the stack, and then return some of the paper to the tray.
5. Make sure the paper guides in the tray are adjusted correctly for the size of paper. Adjust the guides
so they are touching the paper stack without bending it.
7. If you are printing on heavy, embossed, or perforated paper, use the manual feed feature and feed
sheets one at a time.
8. Open the Trays menu on the printer control panel. Verify that the tray is configured correctly for the
paper type and size.
NOTE: The printer model referenced in this video might be different from your printer model, but the
steps to clear the jam are the same.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
3. Remove any jammed paper from the document feeder input area.
5. Make sure the guides in the document-feeder input tray are adjusted to the correct size for the
document before loading paper.
NOTE: To avoid document feeder jams, to copy narrow documents, use the flatbed scanner.
Remove all staples and paper clips from original documents. Do not feed damaged or wrinkled
paper.
NOTE: Original documents that are printed on heavy, glossy paper can jam more frequently than
originals that are printed on plain paper.
IMPORTANT: Warning: Do not run labels through the automatic document feeder (ADF).
6. If the paper continues to jam, remove and clean the document feeder rollers.
b. Release the blue locking arm to drop the assembly down. Slide the pickup and feed roller
assembly to the left, and then pull it away from the document feeder to remove it.
c. Lift the roller cover up and then slide the roller toward the front of the printer to remove it.
7. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
1. If you can see the jammed sheet in Tray 1, remove the jammed sheet by gently pulling it straight out.
4. Make sure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
5. Make sure the Tray 1 guides are set to the correct paper size and that the paper tray is not overfilled
(paper is below the 3 triangles on the right guide).
6. Load the paper back into the tray and restart the print job.
7. If the same jam appears remove and clean the tray 1 pick, feed and separation rollers.
b. Push the pickup roller assembly to the right and then away from the printer.
f. Install the rollers back into tray one and test the tray by printing from tray 1.
8. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
5. Remove the paper from the tray and discard any bent, curled, or damaged sheets.
7. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
8. If the error persists, clean the Tray 2 pick, feed, separation rollers.
To remove the roller assembly, gently pull on the side of the assembly and slide out as shown.
NOTE: Make sure your hands are clean before touching the rollers. Oils or debris from hands
can cause paper pickup issues.
9. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
Use the following procedure to check for paper in all possible jam locations related to the 550-sheet
trays. When a jam occurs, the control panel displays an animation that assists in clearing the jam.
View a video of how to clear a jam in Tray 3, and the optional trays
6. Remove the paper from the tray and discard any bent, curled, or damaged sheets.
8. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
9. If the error persists, clean the Tray 3 pick, feed, separation rollers.
To remove the roller assembly, gently pull on the side of the assembly and slide out as shown.
NOTE: Make sure your hands are clean before touching the rollers. Oils or debris from hands
can cause paper pickup issues.
10. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
7. Open Tray 4.
9. Make sure that the tray width and length guides are set to the correct paper size for the paper
being installed into the tray and that the tray is not over filled above the fill mark (line below 3
triangles on rear guide).
11. If the error persists, clean the Tray 4 pick, feed, separation rollers.
To remove the roller assembly, gently pull on to the side of the rollers as shown.
NOTE: Make sure your hands are clean before touching the rollers. Oils or debris from hands
can cause paper pickup issues.
12. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
7. Open Tray 4.
9. Make sure that the tray width guide is set to the correct paper size for the paper being installed into
the tray and that the tray is not over filled above the fill mark (line below 3 triangles on rear guide).
11. If the error persists, clean the Tray 4 pick, feed, and separation rollers.
To remove the roller assembly, gently pull on to the side of the rollers as shown.
NOTE: Do not touch the rubber part of the rollers with hands. Oils or debris from hands can
cause paper pickup issues.
12. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
z = paper tray. This can be trays 1-5 or "D" for duplex jobs
Or
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area
CAUTION: The fuser can be hot while the printer is in use. Wait for the fuser to cool before
handling it.
5. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
6. Ensure the paper tray guides are set to the correct size for the paper loaded.
7. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
z = paper tray. This can be trays 1-5 or "D" for duplex print jobs.
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area
CAUTION: The fuser can be hot while the printer is in use. Wait for the fuser to cool before
handling it.
4. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
5. Ensure the paper tray guides are set to the correct size for the paper loaded.
6. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
y = jam type (A or D)
z = Paper tray. This can be 0-5 or "D" for duplex print jobs.
Or
View a video of how to clear a jam in the right door and fuser area
NOTE: The fuser is hot while the printer is in use. Wait for the fuser to cool before clearing jams.
a. Squeeze the release levers on the handles (circle call-outs) and then remove the fuser.
c. Open the fuser access and check for a z-fold paper jam.
4. If the error persists, ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP
specifications for the printer.
5. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
NOTE: The fuser is hot while the printer is in use. Wait for the fuser to cool before clearing jams.
2. Gently remove any jammed paper from the duplexer paper path.
4. If the error persists, ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP
specifications for the printer.
5. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
z = paper type that is being printed on. This can be 0-9 or A-F.
2. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
3. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
These jams can only be present if the floor standing finisher is installed
4. Make sure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
5. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
13.60 jam errors in the fuser exit area when printing to a stapler/stacker or floor-standing
finisher
Use the following procedure to check for paper in all possible jam locations in the fuser exit area when
printing to a finisher. When a jam occurs, the control panel displays an animation that assists in clearing
the jam.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
NOTE: The images provide do not show any accessories or copy module attached to the printer.
View a video of how to clear a jam in the fuser exit area on finisher.
a. Squeeze the release levers on the handles (circle call-outs) and then remove the fuser.
13.60 jam errors in the fuser exit area when printing to a stapler/stacker or floor-standing finisher 457
b. Remove any paper jammed in the fuser exit area.
4. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
5. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
5. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
6. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
View a video of how to clear a jam in the floor-standing finisher punch area
NOTE: Use the directions on the inside to assist in clearing the jam.
5. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
6. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
When a jam occurs, the control panel displays a message and an animation that assists in clearing the
jam.
x = 0, 1, 3, 4, 5
1. Remove any paper jams from the output bins by gently grasping the leading edge and remove it.
NOTE: Use the directions on the inside to assist in clearing the jam.
5. Ensure the type and quality of the paper being used meets the HP specifications for the printer.
6. If the error persists, contact your HP-authorized service or support provider, or contact customer
support at www.hp.com/go/contactHP.
Cause Solution
The correct size paper is not loaded in the tray. Load the correct size paper in the tray.
The correct size paper is not selected in the software program Confirm that the settings in the software program and printer
or printer driver. driver are correct, because the software program settings
override the printer driver and control panel settings, and the
printer driver settings override the control panel settings.
The correct size paper for the tray is not selected in the printer From the control panel, select the correct size paper for the
control panel. tray.
The paper size is not configured correctly for the tray. Print a configuration page to determine the paper size for
which the tray is configured.
The guides in the tray are not against the paper. Verify that the paper guides are touching the paper.
Cause Solution
A driver for a different printer is in use. Use a driver for this printer.
Cause Solution
The paper size is not configured correctly for the input tray. Print a configuration page or use the control panel to
determine the paper size for which the tray is configured.
The guides in the tray are not against the paper. Verify that the guides are touching the paper.
Table 4-31 Printer will not duplex (print 2-sided jobs) or duplexes incorrectly
Cause Solution
The duplex job is trying to use unsupported paper. Verify that the paper is supported for duplex printing.
The printer driver is not set up for duplex printing. Set up the printer driver to enable duplex printing.
The first page is printing on the back of preprinted forms or Load preprinted forms and letterhead in Tray 1 with the
letterhead. letterhead or printed side down, with the top of the page
leading into the printer. For Tray 2-X, load the paper printed
side up with the top of the page toward the right of the printer.
The printer model does not support automatic 2-sided printing. The printer model does not support automatic 2-sided printing.
Cause Solution
The correct size paper is not loaded. Load the correct size paper.
The correct paper type for the input tray is not selected in the From the printer control panel, select the correct paper type
printer control panel. for the input tray. Trays configured for a paper type with a
specific weight range will not match a print job that specifies
an exact weight, even if the specified weight is within the
weight range.
Paper from a previous jam has not been completely removed. Open the printer and remove any paper in the paper path.
Closely inspect the fuser area for jams.
None of the optional trays appear as input tray options. The optional trays only display as available if they are installed.
Verify that any optional trays are correctly installed. Verify
that the printer driver has been configured to recognize the
optional trays.
An optional tray is incorrectly installed. Print a configuration page to confirm that the optional tray is
installed. If not, verify that the tray is correctly attached to the
printer.
The paper size is not configured correctly for the input tray. Print a configuration page or use the control panel to
determine the paper size for which the tray is configured.
The guides in the tray are not against the paper. Verify that the guides are touching the paper.
Cause Solution
Paper does not meet the specifications for this printer. Use only paper that meets the HP paper specifications for this
printer. Non-recycled, 75 g/m2 (20 lb) paper is optimal for office
use.
The correct paper type for the input tray is not selected in the From the printer control panel, select the correct paper type
printer control panel. for the input tray. Trays configured for a paper type with a
specific weight range will not match a print job that specifies
an exact weight, even if the specified weight is within the
weight range.
Paper is damaged or in poor condition. Remove paper from the input tray and load paper that is in
good condition.
The printer is operating in an excessively humid environment. Verify that the printing environment is within humidity
specifications.
The print job consist of large, solid-filled areas. Large, solid-filled areas can cause excessive curl. Try using a
different pattern.
Paper used was not stored correctly and might have absorbed Remove paper and replace it with paper from a fresh,
moisture. unopened package. Store paper in a plastic bag to protect it
from humidity.
Paper has poorly cut edges. Remove paper, flex it, rotate it 180 degrees or turn it over,
and then reload it into the input tray. Do not fan paper. If the
problem persists, replace the paper.
The specific paper type was not configured for the tray or Configure the software for the paper (see the software
selected in the software. documentation). Configure the tray for the paper.
The paper has previously been used for a print job. Do not re-use paper.
NOTE: Tray 1 and Tray 2 are optimal for paper pickup when using special paper or media other than
20lb plain paper. For Tray 1 and Tray 2 the printer increases the number of attempts to pick up a page,
which increases the reliability of successfully picking the page from the tray and decreases the
possibility of a mispick jam.
HP recommends using Tray 1 or Tray 2 if the printer is experiencing excessive or reoccurring jams from
trays other than Tray 1 and Tray 2, or for print jobs that require media other than 20lb plain paper.
2. Load the tray with the correct size of paper for the job.
3. Make sure the paper size and type are set correctly on the printer control panel.
4. Make sure the paper guides in the tray are adjusted correctly for the size of paper. Adjust the
guides to the appropriate indentation in the tray.
6. The rollers above the tray might be contaminated. Clean the rollers with a lint-free cloth dampened
with warm water.
1. Remove the stack of paper from the tray and flex it, rotate it 180 degrees, and flip it over. Do not fan
the paper. Return the stack of paper to the tray.
2. Use only paper that meets HP specifications for this printer.
3. Use paper that is not wrinkled, folded, or damaged. If necessary, use paper from a different
package.
4. Make sure the tray is not overfilled. If it is, remove the entire stack of paper from the tray, straighten
the stack, and then return some of the paper to the tray.
5. Make sure the paper guides in the tray are adjusted correctly for the size of paper. Adjust the
guides to the appropriate indentation in the tray.
7. The tray pick and/or feed rollers might be contaminated. Clean the rollers with a lint-free cloth
dampened with warm water.
The document feeder jams, skews, or picks up multiple sheets of paper (MFP)
Learn about MFP document feeder paper handling problems.
Review the following information when the document feeder jams, skews, or picks up multiple sheets of
paper.
● Check to see if there are areas on the page that might have had staples removed. This can cause
jams and/or mispicks.
● The original might have something on it, such as staples or self-adhesive notes that must be
removed.
● The pages might not be placed correctly. Straighten the pages and adjust the paper guides to
center the stack.
● The paper guides must be touching the sides of the paper stack to work correctly. Make sure that
the paper stack is straight, and the guides are against the paper stack.
● The document feeder input tray or output bin might contain more than the maximum number of
pages. Make sure the paper stack fits below the guides in the input tray and remove pages from the
output bin.
● Verify that there are no pieces of paper, staples, paper clips, or other debris in the paper path.
● Use the control panel menus to check the status of the document-feeder kit and replace it if
necessary.
Cause Solution
Manual feed is selected in the software program. Load Tray 1 with paper, or, if the paper is loaded, press the OK
button.
The correct size paper is not loaded. Load the correct size paper.
The input tray is empty. Load paper into the input tray.
Paper from a previous jam has not been completely removed. Open the printer and remove any paper in the paper path.
The paper size is not configured correctly for the input tray. Print a configuration page or use the control panel to
determine the paper size for which the tray is configured.
The guides in the tray are not against the paper. Verify that the rear and width paper guides are touching the
paper.
Use the information in this topic to troubleshoot and resolve image-quality (what you see on the final
printed page) problems including copy-quality, print-quality, and color problems (color printers only).
Various printer hardware problems can cause image-quality defects. This topic is a guide to the steps
used to isolate the specific areas of the printer that are causing image-quality defects on the printed
page, and to provide solutions to resolve those image-quality defects.
● Print-quality (PQ) problems: PQ problems are associated with the print engine (printer base) of an
MFP printer (single function non MFP image-quality problems are always PQ defects). PQ defects
appear on pages that are printed by the print engine and not fed through an integrated scanner
assembly (ISA).
● Copy-quality (CQ) problems: CQ problems are associated with the integrated-scanner assembly
(ISA) portion of an MFP printer. CQ defects appear on pages that are copied using the document
feeder or flatbed glass.
If the print defect is already known to be a PQ or CQ problem, skip to the appropriate troubleshooting
topic listed below. Otherwise, follow the steps in the next section below to get started troubleshooting
image-quality problems.
NOTE: If the image defect appears on the printed demonstration page, the issue is a print-quality (PQ)
problem (associated with the print engine and not the document feeder or flatbed glass) and not a CQ
problem.
Enterprise printers
Pro printers
● Yes: If defects appear on the printed demonstration page the issue is PQ related. See Print-quality
troubleshooting on page 475.
● No: If defects does not appear on the printed demonstration page the issue is CQ related. See
Copy-quality troubleshooting on page 490.
NOTE: Print-quality (PQ) problems are associated with the print engine (printer base) of an MFP
printer (single function non MFP image-quality problems are always PQ defects). PQ defects appear on
pages that are printed by the print engine and not feed through an integrated scanner assembly (ISA).
When troubleshooting the source of some print image defects, one solution is to identify if it is a
repetitive defect (does the print quality defect appear multiple times on the printed page?). If this is
the case, use a ruler to measure occurrences of repetitive image defects to help solve image-quality
problems. For more information, see Using a ruler to measure between repetitive defects.
Use a ruler to measure occurrences of repetitive image defects to help solve image-quality problems.
Place the ruler next to the first occurrence of the defect on the page. Find the distance between identical
defects and use the table below to identify the component that is causing the defect.
CAUTION: Do not use solvents or oils to clean rollers. Instead, rub the roller with a lint-free cloth. If dirt
is difficult to remove, rub the roller with a lint-free cloth that has been dampened with water.
NOTE: The primary charging roller, photosensitive drum, and developer roller cannot be cleaned
because they are internal assemblies in the toner cartridge or imaging drum. If one of these
assemblies is causing the defect, replace the toner cartridge. The primary fuser sleeve unit or
pressure roller cannot be cleaned because they are internal assemblies in the fuser. If one of these
assemblies is causing the defect, replace the fuse.
TIP: To make a printer specific repetitive defect ruler, use a metric ruler to transfer the measurements
in the table below to a transparency or the edge of a piece of paper—clearly label each ruler mark with
the associated defective assembly.
Secondary transfer roller 50 mm (1.97 in) Appears as dropouts or dirt on the back of the page.
Fuser Pressure roller 79 mm (3.1 in) Appears as dirt, loose toner, or dirt on the back of the
page.
Registration roller 44 mm (1.7 in) Appears as dirt or dirt on the back of the page.
NOTE: Some printers allow loading Letter and A4 media in short-edge-first or long-edge-first
orientation in the paper trays. When measuring repetitive defects, make sure to place the ruler at
the leading edge of the page. This is the edge of the page that feeds into the printer first.
The example pages below show the following types of repetitive defects.
● Lines (callout 1)
● Smudges (callout 2)
1 2
NOTE: These are examples only, other types of repetitive defects might appear on a page.
TIP: Always measure from and to the same point on the defects. For example, if the ruler is
“zeroed” at the top edge of a defect, measure to the top edge of the next occurrence of that defect.
If the page prints correctly, the problem is with the software program from which you were printing.
2. Follow the control panel prompts to confirm or modify the paper type and size settings for the tray.
4. Adjust the humidity and resistance setting on the control panel to match the environment.
i. Settings
b. Select the paper type that matches the type loaded in the tray.
c. Use the arrows to increase or decrease the humidity and resistance setting.
5. Make sure the driver settings match the control panel settings.
NOTE: The print driver settings will override any control panel settings.
NOTE: The print driver settings will override any control panel settings.
2. Select the printer, and then click the Properties or Preferences button.
4. From the Paper Type drop-down list, click the More... option.
6. Expand the category of paper types that best describes your paper.
7. Select the option for the type of paper you are using, and click the OK button.
8. Click the OK button to close the Document Properties dialog box. In the Print dialog box, click the OK
button to print the job.
1. Click the File menu, and then click the Print option.
4. Open the menus drop-down list, and then click the Paper/Quality menu.
3. Select Supplies Status Page, and then select Print to print the page.
1. Look at the supplies status report to check the percent of life remaining for the toner cartridges
and, if applicable, the status of other replaceable maintenance parts.
Print quality problems can occur when using a toner cartridge that is at its estimated end of life.
The supplies status page indicates when a supply level is very low. After an HP supply has reached
the very low threshold, HP’s premium protection warranty on that supply has ended.
The toner cartridge does not need to be replaced now unless the print quality is no longer
acceptable. Consider having a replacement available to install when print quality is no longer
acceptable.
If you determine that you need to replace a toner cartridge or other replaceable maintenance
parts, the supplies status page lists the genuine HP part numbers.
A genuine HP toner cartridge has the word “HP” on it, or has the HP logo on it. For more information
on identifying HP cartridges go to www.hp.com/go/learnaboutsupplies.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, scroll to and touch the Support Tools button.
● Maintenance
● Calibration/Cleaning
3. Touch Cleaning Page, and then touch the Print button to print the cleaning page.
NOTE: A Cleaning... message displays on the control-panel display. Do not turn the printer off until
the cleaning process has finished. When it is finished, discard the printed page.
TIP: Use this screen to set up automatic cleaning page intervals if desired.
● Always use a paper type and weight that this printer supports.
● Use paper that is of good quality and free of cuts, nicks, tears, spots, loose particles, dust, wrinkles,
voids, staples, and curled or bent edges.
● Use paper that does not contain metallic material, such as glitter.
● Use paper that is designed for use in laser printers. Do not use paper that is designed only for use in
Inkjet printers.
● Use paper that is not too rough. Using smoother paper generally results in better print quality.
● Move the printer away from drafty locations, such as open windows or doors, or air-conditioning
vents.
● Make sure the printer is not exposed to temperatures or humidity outside of printer specifications.
● Remove anything that is blocking the vents on the printer. The printer requires good air flow on all
sides, including the top.
● Protect the printer from airborne debris, dust, steam, grease, or other elements that can leave
residue inside the printer.
1. From the Home screen on the printer control panel, select the Settings menu.
a. Copy/Print or Print
b. Print Quality
c. Image Registration
4. Select Print Test Page, and then follow the instructions on the printed pages.
5. Select Print Test Page again to verify the results, and then make further adjustments if necessary.
Download a different print driver from the HP support Web site: http://www.hp.com/support/colorlj6700
or http://www.hp.com/support/colorlj6800MFP or http://www.hp.com/support/colorlj6801MFP or
http://www.hp.com/support/colorljX654 or http://www.hp.com/support/colorljX677MFP.
Table 4-44 Light print on page 488 Table 4-42 Gray background or dark print Table 4-39 Blank page - No print on page
on page 487 486
Table 4-38 Black page on page 485 Table 4-37 Banding defects on page 485 Table 4-46 Streak defects on page 490
Table 4-41 Fixing/fuser defects on page Table 4-43 Image placement defects on Table 4-40 Color plane registrations
486 page 488 defects (color models only) on page 486
Image defects, no matter the cause, can often be resolved using the same steps. Use the following steps
as a starting point for solving image defect issues.
1. Reprint the document. Print quality defects can be intermittent in nature or can go away completely
with continued printing.
2. Check the condition of the cartridge or cartridges. If a cartridge is in a Very Low state (it has
passed the rated life), replace the cartridge.
3. Make sure that the driver and tray print mode settings match the media that is loaded in the tray.
Try using a different ream of media or a different tray. Try using a different print mode.
4. Make sure the printer is within the supported operating temperature/humidity range.
5. Make sure that the paper type, size, and weight are supported by the printer. See the printer
support page at support.hp.com for a list of the supported paper sizes and types for the printer.
NOTE: The term "fusing" refers to the part of the printing process where toner is affixed to paper.
The following examples depict letter-size paper that has passed through the printer with the short edge
first.
The page is completely blank and 1. Make sure that the cartridges are
contains no printed content. genuine HP cartridges.
Toner rubs off along either edge of the 1. Reprint the document.
page. This defect is more common at the
edges of high-coverage jobs, and on light 2. Check the paper type in the paper
media types, but can occur anywhere on tray and adjust the printer settings
the page. to match. If necessary, select a
heavier paper type.
The image or text is darker than 1. Make sure that the paper in the
expected and/or the background is gray. trays has not already been run
through the printer.
The paper does not stack well in the 1. Reprint the document.
output tray. The stack might be uneven,
skewed, or the pages might be pushed 2. Extend the output bin extension.
out of the tray and onto the floor. Any of
the following conditions can cause this 3. If the defect is caused by
defect: extreme paper curl, refer to the
troubleshooting steps for "Output
● Extreme paper curl curl."
Dark vertical lines which occur down the 1. Reprint the document.
length of the page. The defect might
occur anywhere on the page, in areas of 2. Remove the cartridge, and then
fill or in sections with no printed content. shake it to redistribute the toner.
On color models, these lines or streaks Reinsert the toner cartridges into
will also be visible on the ITB cleaning the printer and close the cover. For
page. a graphical representation of this
procedure, see Replace the toner
cartridges.
Copy-quality troubleshooting
Learn about copy-quality troubleshooting.
NOTE: Copy-quality (CQ) problems are associated with the integrated-scanner assembly (ISA) portion
of an MFP printer. CQ defects appear on pages that are copied using the document feeder or flatbed
glass.
NOTE: If a CQ defect appears on printed output from both the document feeder and the flatbed
glass, carefully inspect the original source for a print-quality (PQ) problem.
2. Place the source page in the document feeder, and then make a copy.
3. Mark the copied output page to clearly identify it as output from the document feeder.
4. Compare the original and copied pages. Defects appearing on the copied page are caused by a
problem in the document feeder.
1. Mark a printed page in a way that clearly identifies it as the source document used in this isolation
procedure.
2. Place the source page on the flatbed glass, and then make a copy.
3. Mark the copied output page to clearly identify it as output from the flatbed.
4. Compare the original and copied pages. Defects appearing on the copied page are caused by a
problem in the flatbed.
Over time, specks of debris might collect on the scanner glass and document feeder white plastic
backing, which might cause print defects. Use the following procedure to clean the scanner if the printed
pages have streaks, unwanted lines, black dots, poor print quality, or unclear text.
View a video of cleaning the document feeder glass and flatbed glass.
1. Press the power button to turn the printer off, and then disconnect the power cable from the
electrical outlet.
CAUTION: Do not use abrasives, acetone, benzene, ammonia, ethyl alcohol, or carbon
tetrachloride on any part of the printer; these can damage the printer. Do not place liquids directly
on the glass or platen. They might seep and damage the printer.
NOTE: If you are having trouble with streaks on copies when you are using the document feeder,
be sure to clean the small strips of glass on the left side of the scanner (callout 2, callout 3).
4. Dry the glass and white plastic parts with a chamois or a cellulose sponge to prevent spotting.
6. Connect the power cable to an outlet, and then press the power button to turn the printer on.
Vertical lines or streaks appear on copies and/or scans in the same direction that the paper feeds when
copying and/or scanning from the document feeder. Lines or streaks might be visible on the front and/or
The line or streak might be black or in color, and can also be present on fax or digital send output (for
example, when using Scan to folder or Scan to email features.
NOTE: HP has determined that 99% of all lines and streaks on copies made by feeding the original
documents through the document feeder are caused by debris on the document feeder glass strip.
Even small specks can cause the light reflected off the original to be distorted, resulting in a line, streak,
or smudge on copies or scans made from the document feeder.
Even if the document feeder glass strip and/or flatbed glass has been wiped clean, the defect might
persist. Persistent vertical lines, bands, or streaks when copying from the document feeder might mean
that the debris causing the print quality are not readily visible and cannot be removed with a quick
cleaning.
Use the procedures below to resolve persistent lines, bands, or streak copy-quality (CQ) problems.
3. Place the copied paper face-up on the flatbed glass with the X located as shown.
NOTE: Make sure the upper left corner of the copy is aligned with the upper left corner of the
flatbed glass.
4. Follow the line or streak on the paper to the area on the document feeder glass that is causing the
CQ problem.
WARNING! Use only a fingernail. Other objects can scratch the document feeder glass.
Clean this specific area again (with a lint-free cloth dampened with water), and then dry the glass
with a soft, lint-free cloth.
NOTE: Not all MFP printers use a background selector for duplex printing.
If a Side 2 Background Selector cannot be located for the printer (it might not include one) skip this
procedure.
1. Release the latch and open the document feeder jam-access door.
2. Unlock the Side 2 Background Selector by pressing and holding both green tabs inward towards
each other.
3. While holding the green tabs, pull out and remove the Side 2 Background Selector.
4. Rotate the top to reveal the white and black backside reflector (circled in blue).
NOTE: If the white and black areas do not come clean, wipe the surface thoroughly with a damp
cloth again. Dry the area with a soft, dry cloth to prevent spotting.
5. With the background selector removed from the document feeder, clean the inside of the scan
module.
6. In the back area from where the background selector was removed, locate the Side 2 Scan Module
glass found under the top area.
NOTE: The glass surface of the Side 2 Scan module sits horizontally flat and might not be easily
viewable.
NOTE: If needed, lens cleaner or non-abrasive glass cleaner can be applied to the cloth before
cleaning the glass. Spray only onto the cloth and not directly onto the glass or device. Do not spray
water or glass cleaner on the glass as it can seep under it and possibly damage the printer. Do not
use abrasives, acetone, benzene, ethyl alcohol, or carbon tetrachloride on the glass; these can
damage it and/or leave residue on the glass resulting in degraded copy/scan quality.
IMPORTANT: The printer settings described in this section are firmware dependent and might not be
available for a specific printer (for example, color adjustment settings do not apply to mono printers).
NOTE: Settings > Print (SFP) or Copy/Print (MFP) > Image Adjustment > Background Cleanup.
Use the sliders to perform a Background Cleanup, adjust the image Darkness as well as changing the
Sharpness and Contrast.
Use this feature to improve the overall quality of the copy (for example, adjusting the Darkness and
Sharpness. Use the Background Cleanup setting to remove faint images from the background or to
remove a light background color.
● Darkness: Adjust this setting to increase or decrease the amount of white and black in the colors.
● Contrast: Adjust this setting to increase or decrease the difference between the lightest and
darkest color on the page.
● Sharpness: Adjust this setting to clarify or soften the image. Increasing the sharpness might make
text appear crisper, but decreasing it would make photographs appear smoother.
Use to optimize the output for a particular type of content. You can optimize the output for text, printed
pictures, or a mixture.
Use this setting to optimize the output for a particular type of content.
● Mixed: Use to optimize the setting for text and for pictures.
● Text: Use to optimize the text portion of the copy when text and/or pictures are on the original.
Color/Black settings
Use to enable or disable color scanning.(some highlighters will not auto detect as color).
● Automatically detect color or black: When pages without color are detected, the printer creates an
image of the page in 1-bit black if other settings allow. If the other settings don't allow (File Type, for
example), the image is in grayscale.
● Automatically detect color or gray: When pages without color are detected, the printer creates an
image of the page in grayscale. Select this option for the best image quality for non-color pages.
● Black: Scans documents in black and white with a compressed file size.
NOTE: When digitally sending or copying highlighted images or text objects, the image might appear
lighter than expected or does not show up at all with certain brands/types of highlighter pens.
Highlighters come in bright, often fluorescent colors. Fluorescent highlighter inks tend to reflect more
light than that which is absorbed by the paper source. This reflection might cause the image to not show
up as well as non-fluorescent colors depending upon the scanner/MFP being used.
The most common color for highlighters is yellow, but many other colors are also found such as pink,
blue, green, orange, and purples. Yellow is often the preferred color to use when making a photocopy as it
tends to not produce as much of a shadow on copies or scans.
There are different color and ink properties depending upon the brand of highlighters used. Due to these
differences, scanning of the images might vary greatly from not being seen at all to changing colors (for
example, orange highlighter might appear brown in the copy or scan or yellow highlighter might appear
green).
A Firmware enhancement has been introduced for certain LaserJets to help with the reproduction of
highlighted images.
NOTE: Some Multifunction Printers (MFPs) using FutureSmart firmware v3.5.3 or later have improved
color reproduction of fluorescent highlighters when scanning or copying.
Use the following steps to identify the installed firmware version, and then upgrade the firmware if
needed.
2. On the printed configuration page look in the section marked Device Information, and then identify
the Firmware Datecode and Firmware Revision.
a. Select Get drivers, Software, and Firmware, and then select the appropriate product by name.
NOTE: More than one printer model might be listed. Make sure to select the correct model so
that the upgraded firmware supports all of the printer functions.
c. Locate the firmware download. If the firmware version is more recent than the one shown on the
printed configuration page, select Download.
c. Enter the product name in the Find my product dialogue box, and then select Go.
TIP: Click on the How do I find my product name/number? link to see a short video on
identifying the printer name and number.
NOTE: More than one printer model might be listed. Make sure to select the correct model so
that the upgraded firmware supports all of the printer functions.
f. Locate the firmware download. If the firmware version is more recent than the one shown on the
printed configuration page, select Download.
6. When the upgrade process is complete, print a configuration page and verify that the upgrade
firmware version was installed.
Yes
These procedures help provide settings which affect the way highlighters are scanned or copied. A
firmware enhancement is available for certain printers that helps with the reproduction of highlighted
images.
1. From the Home screen, select the desired scanning application (for example, Copy, E-Mail, Save
to Network Folder).
2. Select More Options > Optimize Text/Picture > Text button (not slider). This enables the improved
color reproduction of fluorescent highlighters.
TIP: Administrators can set Text as the default setting on the device.
● Alternative Settings
See Modify printer settings to improve scan or copy quality on page 497 for more information.
Fax or email troubleshooting information is not provided in this service manual. The most current
information is available in WISE. Search using model number then use "fax troubleshooting" as the
search term.
For HP Channel partners, open the HP Partner First Portal located at https://partner.hp.com, and then do
the following:
1. Select the Services & Support tab, and then select Technical Support.
For HP service personnel, go to one of the following Web-based Interactive Search Engines (WISE) sites:
Americas (AMS)
● WISE - English
● WISE - Spanish
● WISE - Portuguese
● WISE - French
● WISE - English
● WISE - Japanese
● WISE - Korean
● WISE - Thai
● WISE - English
NOTE: Tray 1 and Tray 2 are optimal for paper pickup when using special paper or media other than
75-80gsm (20lb) plain paper. For Tray 1 and Tray 2 the printer increases the number of attempts to pick
up a page, which increases the reliability of successfully picking the page from the tray and decreases
the possibility of a mis-pick jam.
HP recommends using Tray 1 or Tray 2 if the printer is experiencing excessive or reoccurring jams from
trays other than Tray 1 and Tray 2, or for print jobs that require media other than 75-80gsm (20lb) plain
paper.
Pages print but are totally blank. The document might contain blank Check the original document to see if
pages. content is present on all of the pages.
Pages print but are totally blank. The printer might be malfunctioning. To check the printer, print a
Configuration page.
Pages print but are totally blank. Make sure that the printer is not feeding Make sure that the paper meets HP
multiple pages (especially if very thin specifications for this printer.
paper is used).
For a complete list of specific HP-brand
paper that this printer supports, go to
http://www.hp.com/support/colorlj6700
or http://www.hp.com/support/
colorlj6800MFP or http://www.hp.com/
support/colorlj6801MFP or
http://www.hp.com/support/colorljX654
or http://www.hp.com/support/
colorljX677MFP.
Pages print very slowly. Heavier paper types can slow the print Print on a different type of paper.
job.
NOTE: Some software programs
process print jobs slowly.
Pages print very slowly. Complex pages can print slowly. Proper fusing might require a slower
print speed to ensure the best print
NOTE: Some software programs quality.
process print jobs slowly.
Pages print very slowly. Large batches, narrow paper, and Print in smaller batches, on a different
special paper such as gloss, type of paper, or on a different size of
NOTE: Some software programs transparency, cardstock, and HP Tough paper.
process print jobs slowly. Paper can slow the print job.
Pages did not print. The printer might not be pulling paper Make sure paper is loaded in the tray
correctly. correctly.
Pages did not print. The paper is jamming in the printer. Clear the jam.
Pages did not print. The USB cable might be defective or ● Disconnect the USB cable at both
incorrectly connected. ends and reconnect it.
Pages did not print. Other devices are running on the host The printer might not share a USB port.
computer. If an external hard drive or network
switchbox is connected to the same port
as the printer, the other device might be
interfering with the printer. To connect
and use the printer, disconnect the other
device or use two USB ports on the host
computer.
Pages did not print. The print job might not have arrived at Check the printer status queue. Also, the
the printer. Printing message should appear on the
control panel display.
Print speeds
Print speed is the number of pages that print in one minute. Print speed depends on different engine-
process speeds or operational pauses between printed pages during normal printer operation. Factors
that determine the print speed of the printer include the following:
The printer must pause for each page to be formatted before it prints. Complex pages take more
time to format, resulting in reduced print speed. However, most jobs print at full engine speed.
● Media size
Legal-size media reduces print speed because it is longer than the standard Letter- or A4–size
media. A reduce print speed is used when printing on narrow media to prevent the edges of the
fuser from overheating.
● Media mode
Some media types require a reduced print speed to achieve maximum print quality on that media.
For example, glossy, heavy, and specialty media (for example, envelopes or photos) require a
reduced print speed. To maximize the print speed for special media types, make sure that the
correct media type in the print driver is selected.
● Printer temperature
To prevent printer damage, print speed is reduced if the printer reaches a specific internal
temperature (thermal slow down). The starting temperature of the printer, ambient environment
temperature, and the print job size effect the number of pages that can be printed before the printer
reduces the print speed. Thermal slow down reduces print speed by printing four pages and then
pausing for an amount of time before printing continues.
Other factors (especially during large print jobs) that can cause reduced print speeds include:
1. Make sure the printer is turned on and that the control panel indicates it is ready.
● If the control panel does not indicate the printer is ready, turn the printer off and then on again.
● If the control panel indicates the printer is ready, try sending the job again.
2. If the control panel indicates the printer has an error, resolve the error and then try sending the job
again.
3. Make sure the cables are all connected correctly. If the printer is connected to a network, check the
following items:
● Check the bottom LED next to the network connection on the printer. If the network is active,
the light is green.
● Make sure that a network cable and not a phone cord is used to connect to the network.
● Make sure the network router, hub, or switch is turned on and that it is working correctly.
4. Install the HP software for the printer. Using generic printer drivers can cause delays clearing jobs
from the print queue.
5. From the list of printers on your computer, right-click the name of this product, click Properties, and
open the Ports tab.
● If a network cable is used to connect to the network, make sure the printer name listed on the
Ports tab matches the one on the printer configuration page.
● If a USB cable is used, and the printer is connected to a wireless network, make sure the box is
checked next to Virtual printer port for USB.
6. If a personal firewall system on the computer is used, it might be blocking communication with the
printer. Try temporarily disabling the firewall to see if it is the source of the problem.
7. If the host computer or the printer is connected to a wireless network, low signal quality or
interference might be delaying print jobs.
1. Make sure the computer meets the minimum specifications for this printer. For
a list of specifications, go to this Web site: http://www.hp.com/support/colorlj6700 or
http://www.hp.com/support/colorlj6800MFP or http://www.hp.com/support/colorlj6801MFP or
http://www.hp.com/support/colorljX654 or http://www.hp.com/support/colorljX677MFP.
2. When the printer is configured to print on some paper types, such as heavy paper, the printer prints
more slowly so it can correctly fuse the toner to the paper. If the paper type setting is not correct
for the type of paper you are using, change the setting to the correct paper type.
3. If the host computer or the printer is connected to a wireless network, low signal quality or
interference might be delaying print jobs.
● Verify that the cable is connected to the computer and to the product.
● Verify that the cable is not longer than 2 m (6.65 ft). Try using a shorter cable.
● Verify that the cable is working correctly by connecting it to another product. Replace the cable if
necessary.
Introduction
Learn about solving wired network problems.
Certain types of problems can indicate there is a network communication problem. These problems
include the following issues:
Check the items in this topic to verify that the printer is communicating with the network. Before
beginning, print a configuration page from the printer control panel and locate the printer IP address
that is listed on this page.
1. Verify that the printer is attached to the correct network port using a cable of the correct length.
3. Look at the network port connection on the back of the printer, and verify that the amber activity
light and the green link-status light are lit.
1. Open the printer properties and click the Ports tab. Verify that the current IP address for the printer
is selected. The printer IP address is listed on the printer configuration page.
2. If you installed the printer using the HP standard TCP/IP port, select the box labeled Always print to
this printer, even if its IP address changes.
3. If you installed the printer using a Microsoft standard TCP/IP port, use the hostname instead of the
IP address.
● For Windows, click Start, click Run, type cmd, and then press Enter.
2. If the ping command failed, verify that the network hubs are on, and then verify that the network
settings, the printer, and the computer are all configured for the same network.
The printer is using incorrect link and duplex settings for the network
HP recommends leaving these settings in automatic mode (the default setting). If you change these
settings, you must also change them for your network.
1. Check the network drivers, print drivers, and the network redirection settings.
1. Review the configuration page to check the status of the network protocol. Enable it if necessary.
When servicing the printer, several items must be considered to ensure a successful repair and to avoid
damage to the printer or personal injury. Learn about these considerations and find detailed instructions
for removing and replacing printer parts.
Customer-replaceable units
Learn about customer-replaceable parts removal and replacement.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to a toner cartridge, do not expose it to light for more than a few
minutes. Cover the imaging drum if the toner cartridge must be removed from the printer for an
extended period of time.
If toner gets on the skin or clothing, wipe it off with dry tissue paper and wash in cold water. Hot water
sets toner and it might be difficult, or impossible, to remove.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to a toner cartridge, do not expose it to light for more than a few
minutes. Cover the imaging drum if the toner cartridge must be removed from the printer for an
extended period of time.
If toner gets on the skin or clothing, wipe it off with dry tissue paper and wash in cold water. Hot water
sets toner and it might be difficult, or impossible, to remove.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
NOTE: Two methods are available to eject a toner cartridge using the control panel.
See Eject a toner cartridge using the control panel (Ready state) on page 513.
● Eject a toner cartridge with the printer in a cartridge low or very low error state.
See Eject a toner cartridge using the control panel (error condition) on page 514.
1. From the control panel Home screen, scroll to and select the Supplies button.
2. Select the Eject button (located below the Cartridge Levels indicators.
3. A prompt appears on the control-panel display to open the toner cartridge door.
1. On the control panel Home screen, Touch the error icon at the top of the display.
3. A prompt appears on the control-panel display to open the toner cartridge door.
NOTE: The toner cartridges must be released before removing them. See Eject the toner cartridges
(X654/X677 models) on page 513.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to an imaging drum, do not expose it to light for more than a few
minutes. Cover the green imaging drum if it must be removed from the printer for an extended period of
time.
If toner gets on the skin or clothing, wipe it off with dry tissue paper and wash in cold water. Hot water
sets toner and it might be difficult, or impossible, to remove.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2. Lift the TCU slightly and then pull it out of the printer.
NOTE: Maintain the position of the TCU as you pull it out from the printer. This will ensure that you
do not spill any waste toner in the printer. Place the unit into the clear plastic bag the new TCU was
packaged in.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
1. Remove the new TCU from its package. Save all packaging for recycling the used TCU.
2. Install the new TCU by inserting it into the printer, and then lifting slightly to make sure it pushes all
the way in.
4. Pack the used TCU into the box that the new TCU came in. See the enclosed recycling guide for
information about recycling.
In the U.S. and Canada, a pre-paid shipping label is included in the box. In other countries/regions,
go to www.hp.com/recycle to print a pre-paid shipping label.
Adhere the pre-paid shipping label to the box, and return the used TCU to HP for recycling.
J8J96A HP Staple Cartridge Refill for the floor-standing finisher or 3-bin stapler-
stacker
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2. Pull down the colored handle on the staple carriage, and then pull the staple carriage straight out.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: Do not dispose of the staple carriage. The carriage is not an orderable or replaceable part. If
the carriage is disposed of, the entire staple cartridge assembly will need to be replaced.
1. Remove the staple cartridge from the carrier/sled and replace it with the new staple cartridge.
NOTE: Do not dispose of the staple carrier/sled. The sled is not an orderable or replaceable part.
1 2 3
2. Reinstall the staple carriage into the stapler by pressing the colored handle inward until it snaps
into place.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2. Pull down the colored handle on the staple carriage, and then pull the staple carriage straight out.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: Do not dispose of the staple carriage. The carriage is not an orderable or replaceable part. If
the carriage is disposed of, the entire staple cartridge assembly will need to be replaced.
1. Remove the staple cartridge from the carrier/sled and replace it with the new staple cartridge.
NOTE: Do not dispose of the staple carrier/sled. The sled is not an orderable or replaceable part.
1 2 3
2. Reinstall the staple carriage into the stapler by pressing the colored handle inward until it snaps
into place.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
WARNING! The fuser is hot. Wait at least 30 minutes after turning the printer power off before
removing the fuser.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
CAUTION: The fuser is hot. Wait at least 10 minutes after turning the printer power off before
removing the fuser.
2. Squeeze the release levers on the handles (circle callouts), and then remove the fuser.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
2. Slide the fuser into the printer, push in to install it, and then make sure that it is fully seated.
TIP: When the fuser is fully seated, the release levers on the handles make an audible click.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the image transfer belt.
Required tools
No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2. Hold the two side levers and pull out the ITB assembly.
CAUTION: Do not touch the gray plastic belt. Skin oils and fingerprints on the belt can cause print-
quality problems.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
1. Hold the ITB by the edges (do not touch the gray plastic belt).
2. Align the ITB with the slots in the printer, and then carefully push it into the printer.
3. Continue to carefully push the ITB into the printer until it is fully installed.
TIP: The right door should close easily if the ITB assembly is correctly installed.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
Figure 5-13 Release the left end of the secondary transfer roller
2
1
3. With the left end of the roller lifted up, pull the roller to the left and out of the printer. Take care in
removing the right end of the roller from its holder.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that right end of the roller assembly is fully seated in the holder.
2. Push down on the blue left end until the roller snaps into place.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2. Release the blue locking arm to drop the assembly down. Slide the pickup and feed roller assembly
to the left, and then pull it away from the document feeder to remove it.
■ Lift the roller cover up and then slide the roller toward the front of the printer to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
■ Position the pickup and feed roller assembly in the document feeder, slide the assembly to the right
to seat it in the ADF, and then push the lever up to lock the roller assembly in place.
Figure 5-21 Install the ADF pickup and feed roller assembly
Introduction
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to install this assembly.
CAUTION: Do not touch the adhesive squares and be careful so that the adhesive squares do not
come off with the backing.
2. Position the keyboard overlay on the keyboard by aligning the upper edge of the overlay with the
top edge of the keyboard.
3. With the top edge positioned, align the side edges of the overlay with the keyboard edges.
5. Carefully remove the protective top sheet from the keyboard overlay.
CAUTION: Make sure that the adhesive squares do not come off of the keyboard with the
protective sheet.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2. Locate and release the blue pickup roller assembly release tab (callout 1).
NOTE: Even if you want to replace only the separation roller, you must first remove the pickup roller
assembly.
1. Grasp the left- and right-side of the separation roller assembly, and then lift the assembly up.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
CAUTION: Do not touch the spongy portion of the roller. Skin oils on the roller can cause paper-
handling and print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves or thoroughly washing
your hands before handling the assembly.
2. Push down on the Tray 1 separation roller until it snaps into place.
CAUTION: Do not touch the spongy portion of the roller. Skin oils on the roller can cause paper-
handling and print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves or thoroughly washing
your hands before handling the assembly.
Removal and replacement: Tray 2 paper pickup roller and separation roller assemblies
Learn about removing and replacing the Tray 2 rollers.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
Removal and replacement: Tray 2 paper pickup roller and separation roller assemblies 551
2. Slide the blue lever (callout 1) to the right, and then remove the separation roller assembly (callout 2)
by pulling it out from the printer.
NOTE: Even if you want to replace only the pickup roller assembly, you must first remove the
separation roller assembly.
■ Locate the pickup roller assembly, and then pull it away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: As the roller assembly can be hard to grip, you might need to reach under and behind the
rollers to securely grip it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
CAUTION: Do not touch the spongy portion of the roller. Skin oils on the roller can cause paper-
handling and print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves or thoroughly washing
your hands before handling the assembly.
■ Position the pickup roller assembly in the printer in the correct orientation, and then press the
assembly into place.
CAUTION: Do not touch the spongy portion of the roller. Skin oils on the roller can cause paper-
handling and print-quality problems. HP recommends using disposable gloves or thoroughly washing
your hands before handling the assembly.
Customer-replaceable units
Learn about customer-replaceable parts removal and replacement.
Introduction
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● Use the reversible screwdriver, the bracket, and the two screws included in the kit.
■ Pull the control panel out and tilt it up, and then remove the two thumbscrews on the control panel
arm. Remove the control panel by pulling it away from the printer.
1. On the back off the control panel, remove two screws, and then remove the bracket from the
assembly.
3. Use the pull tab to disconnect the FFC from the connector in the control panel.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
1. Align the back of the keyboard with the back of the control panel and then join them by connecting
the hinges.
2. Connect the keyboard flat flexible cable (FFC) with the connector in the control panel.
4. Use the reversible screwdriver to install the two bracket screws to attach the bracket to the control
panel.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
IMPORTANT: Do not replace the formatter, DC controller, and eMMC PCA or hard-disk drive
simultaneously during a single printer servicing. Doing so might cause the printer to become unstable
or inoperable.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. On the left side of the HDD, release the connector from the formatter, and then pull the HDD away
from the formatter.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
1. Align the connectors on the left side of the HDD with the connector on the formatter.
■ Slide the cover (callout 1) onto the printer, and then install one screw (callout 2) to secure it.
Removal and replacement: Dual in-line memory module (DIMM) (SFP models)
Learn about removing and replacing the dual in-line memory module (DIMM).
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
1. Align the connector edge on the DIMM with the slot on the formatter.
2. Gently insert the top edge of the DIMM up into the formatter slot.
■ Slide the cover (callout 1) onto the printer, and then install one screw (callout 2) to secure it.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
2. When installed, the port on the card should sit securely in the faceplate cut-out.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
1. Pull the card away from the formatter to disconnect the connector and remove the card.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the USB expansion kit.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
1. Pull the card away from the formatter to disconnect the connector.
2
1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
1
2
2. Align the connector on the card with the formatter connector, and then press the connectors
together to seat the card on the formatter.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
1
2
2. Verify that the PCA is properly installed by listening for a click when it is pressed into place. Also
verify that the PCA is underneath the two indicated tabs at the end.
7. Seat the SSD in the PCA connector, and then snap the other end of the SSD on the cross member.
5. Release one tab (callout 1), raise the end of the PCA up and off the cradle (callout 2), and then
remove the PCA from the cradle (callout 3).
6. Place one end of the new PCA on the cradle (callout 1), and then rotate the other end down onto the
cradle (callout 2). Make sure to orientate the PCA on the cradle as shown. Push down on the PCA to
install it on the cradle (an audible click is heard when it snaps into place).
NOTE: Make sure that the PCA is firmly seated under the clips on the cradle.
2 1
11. Seat the SSD in the PCA connector, and then snap the other end of the SSD on the cross member.
13. Press the bracket assembly to firmly seat it in the formatter connector.
6. Secure the board to the bracket (an audible click is heard when it snaps into place).
8. Install two pins to secure the bracket assembly to the formatter faceplate.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Use a small flat-blade screwdriver to release the tabs on the HIP cover.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to a toner cartridge, do not expose it to light for more than a few
minutes. Cover the green imaging drum if the toner cartridge must be removed from the printer for an
extended period of time.
If toner gets on the skin or clothing, wipe it off with dry tissue paper and wash in cold water. Hot water
sets toner and it might be difficult, or impossible, to remove.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Removal and replacement: embedded MultiMedia Card (eMMC) (SFP models) 601
Table 5-23 Part information
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
1. Align the connector on the replacement eMMC (callout 1) with the connector on the formatter
(callout 2), and then push the eMMC onto the formatter to install it.
NOTE: The eMMC can only be installed in one direction on the formatter
■ Slide the cover (callout 1) onto the printer, and then install one screw (callout 2) to secure it.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
3. Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models 6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+, X677dn, X677z+, X67755dn,
X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+)
Follow these steps to remove the rear upper cover.
Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models 6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+, X677dn, X677z+, X67755dn,
X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+) 607
■ Remove the 2 indicated screws the slide the cover slightly to the right and pull the cover away from
the engine to remove.
NOTE: The task below shows the rear upper cover on a 6800zfsw model. The cover on your model
might look different, but the process is the same.
■ Remove two screws, pry the right side away from printer, and then pull the cover in the direction
indicated.
2. Using a flat head screwdriver, disengage three snap-fit leavers then pull the cover away from the
printer.
Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z,
X67755zs, and X67765zs) 609
1. Remove two screws (callout 1).
TIP: These are self-tapping screws for plastic. When reinstalling, rotate the screw
counterclockwise to align it with the existing thread pattern, and then carefully turn it clockwise to
tighten. Do not overtighten. This will prevent stripping the threads inside the screw hole.
2. Disconnect one flat cable (callout 1), remove one ground screw (callout 2) to release the grounding
cable, and then disconnect the indicated connectors (callout 3) on the scanner control board.
Figure 5-134 Disconnect the flat cable, ground cable, and connectors
1 2 3
3. Tilt the document feeder back until it stops, and then lift it off of the scanner until it stops.
NOTE: While removing the document feeder, carefully pass the cables through the cable channel
in the scanner bed.
NOTE: Carefully ensure that the cables do not catch on the cable guides as you lift the assembly.
■ On the SCB, disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove one screw (callout 2). Slide the
SCB to the right, and then remove it from the integrated scanner assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
3. Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models 6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+, X677dn, X677z+, X67755dn,
X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+)
Follow these steps to remove the rear upper cover.
Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models 6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+, X677dn, X677z+, X67755dn,
X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+) 617
■ Remove the 2 indicated screws the slide the cover slightly to the right and pull the cover away from
the engine to remove.
NOTE: The task below shows the rear upper cover on a 6800zfsw model. The cover on your model
might look different, but the process is the same.
■ Remove two screws, pry the right side away from printer, and then pull the cover in the direction
indicated.
2. Using a flat head screwdriver, disengage three snap-fit leavers then pull the cover away from the
printer.
Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z,
X67755zs, and X67765zs) 619
1. Remove two screws (callout 1).
TIP: These are self-tapping screws for plastic. When reinstalling, rotate the screw
counterclockwise to align it with the existing thread pattern, and then carefully turn it clockwise to
tighten. Do not overtighten. This will prevent stripping the threads inside the screw hole.
2. Disconnect one flat cable (callout 1), remove one ground screw (callout 2) to release the grounding
cable, and then disconnect the indicated connectors (callout 3) on the scanner control board.
Figure 5-146 Disconnect the flat cable, ground cable, and connectors
1 2 3
3. Tilt the document feeder back until it stops, and then lift it off of the scanner until it stops.
NOTE: While removing the document feeder, carefully pass the cables through the cable channel
in the scanner bed.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts.
NOTE: The integrated scanner assembly (ISA) includes the sub-scanner assembly (SSA) and the
automatic document feeder (ADF).
Required tools
● Small flat-blade screwdriver
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Print any pages necessary to make sure the printer is functioning correctly.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
3. Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models 6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+, X677dn, X677z+, X67755dn,
X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+)
Follow these steps to remove the rear upper cover.
NOTE: The task below shows the rear upper cover on a 6800zfsw model. The cover on your model
might look different, but the process is the same.
■ Remove two screws, pry the right side away from printer, and then pull the cover in the direction
indicated.
2. Using a flat head screwdriver, disengage three snap-fit leavers then pull the cover away from the
printer.
TIP: These are self-tapping screws for plastic. When reinstalling, rotate the screw
counterclockwise to align it with the existing thread pattern, and then carefully turn it clockwise to
tighten. Do not overtighten. This will prevent stripping the threads inside the screw hole.
2. Disconnect one flat cable (callout 1), remove one ground screw (callout 2) to release the grounding
cable, and then disconnect the indicated connectors (callout 3) on the scanner control board.
Figure 5-155 Disconnect the flat cable, ground cable, and connectors
1 2 3
3. Tilt the document feeder back until it stops, and then lift it off of the scanner until it stops.
NOTE: While removing the document feeder, carefully pass the cables through the cable channel
in the scanner bed.
NOTE: Carefully ensure that the cables do not catch on the cable guides as you lift the assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
5800dn, 5800f, 5800zf, X57945dn, X58045dn, X57945z, X58045z, 6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+,
X677dn, X677z+, X67755dn, X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Removal and replacement: Internal parts and assemblies (base printer) 631
1. Remove the formatter cover
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Remove Tray 2
Follow these steps to remove Tray 2.
2. At the left side of the door, release the link arm (callout 1) from the clip (callout 2) on the front-door
assembly.
3. At the right side of the door, release the link arm (callout 1) from the clip (callout 2) on the front-door
assembly.
2 1
4. Remove two screws (callout 1), release the link lever (callout 2) from the front door assembly (callout
3), and then remove the front door.
2
1 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
CAUTION: To prevent damage to a toner cartridge, do not expose it to light for more than a few
minutes. Cover the green imaging drum if the toner cartridge must be removed from the printer for an
extended period of time.
If toner gets on the skin or clothing, wipe it off with dry tissue paper and wash in cold water. Hot water
sets toner and it might be difficult, or impossible, to remove.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
1. Remove Tray 2
Follow these steps to remove Tray 2.
2. At the right- and left-side of the door, remove two screws, and then remove the door.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker 645
3. Remove the rear cover
Follow these steps to remove the rear cover.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
3. Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models 6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+, X677dn, X677z+, X67755dn,
X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+)
Follow these steps to remove the rear upper cover.
Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models 6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+, X677dn, X677z+, X67755dn,
X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+) 649
■ Remove the 2 indicated screws the slide the cover slightly to the right and pull the cover away from
the engine to remove.
4. Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z,
X67755zs, and X67765zs)
Follow these steps to remove the rear upper cover.
5. Remove the rear upper left cover (MFP models 5800dn, 5800f, 5800zf, X57945dn, X58045dn, X57945z, and
X58045z)
Follow these steps to remove the rear upper cover.
■ Remove one screw (callout) and slide the panel to the right to remove it
Remove the rear upper left cover (MFP models 5800dn, 5800f, 5800zf, X57945dn, X58045dn, X57945z, and X58045z)
651
1. Dispose of the defective part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
■ At the left side of the printer, remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then slide
the cover (callout 3) toward the rear of the printer to release it.
1 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
1 2
■ At the left side of the printer, release one tab, and then slide the handle as indicated to release it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2. Pull the top part of the front left cover (callout 1) in the direction indicated, release one tab (callout
2), and then slide the cover upward to release it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
3. Release one tab, and then slide the front right cover upward to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● Small flat-blade screwdriver
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2
1
5. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable clamp
(callout 3).
2
3
6. Release one tab (callout 1), slide the link arm (callout 2) in the direction indicated, and then remove it.
8. Release two bosses (callout 1), and then remove the link arm (callout 2).
9. Close the front door a little, and then remove the spring (callout 1) from the link arm (callout 2) and
from the shaft (callout 3).
11. Remove the right door (callout 1) from the shaft (callout 2), and then unhook one spring (callout 3)
from the frame (callout 4).
2 4
12. Slide the right door (callout 1) in the direction indicated to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Release one tab, and then slide the front right cover upward to remove it.
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then slide the rear inner cover (callout
3) downward to remove it.
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Release one tab, and then slide the front right cover upward to remove it.
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then slide the rear inner cover (callout
3) downward to remove it.
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), slide the rear lower cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated below,
and then remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● Small flat-blade screwdriver
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Release one tab, and then slide the front right cover upward to remove it.
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
■ Slide the left lower cover in the direction indicated, and then remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● Small flat-blade screwdriver
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Lift the TCU slightly and then pull it out of the printer.
NOTE: Maintain the position of the TCU as you pull it out from the printer. This will ensure that you
do not spill any waste toner in the printer. Place the unit into the clear plastic bag the new TCU was
packaged in.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
■ Remove two screws (callout 1), and then slide the output tray (callout 2) towards the front (SFP
models) or left (MFP models) to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
4. Release two tabs (callout 1), and then remove the PCA cover (callout 2).
2
1
2
3
6. Release one tab (callout 1), slide the link arm (callout 2) in the direction indicated, and then remove it.
7. Close the front door a little, and then disconnect the joint that connects the two link arms.
9. Close the front door a little, and then remove the spring (callout 1) from the link arm (callout 2) and
from the shaft (callout 3).
10. Release one tab (callout 1), slide the cable holder (callout 2) in the direction indicate, and then
remove it.
2 4
12. Slide the right door (callout 1) in the direction indicated to remove it.
3 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● Small flat-blade screwdriver
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Lift the TCU slightly and then pull it out of the printer.
NOTE: Maintain the position of the TCU as you pull it out from the printer. This will ensure that you
do not spill any waste toner in the printer. Place the unit into the clear plastic bag the new TCU was
packaged in.
■ At the left side of the printer, remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then slide
the cover (callout 3) toward the rear of the printer to release it.
1 2
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
3. Release one tab (callout 1), release two USB cables (callout 2) and another cable (callout 3) from the
cable clamp (callout 4).
1
3
1 3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● Small flat-blade screwdriver
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
■ Remove two screws (callout 1), and then slide the output tray (callout 2) towards the front (SFP
models) or left (MFP models) to remove it.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then remove the top cover (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● Small flat-blade screwdriver
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
■ Remove two screws (callout 1), and then slide the output tray (callout 2) towards the front (SFP
models) or left (MFP models) to remove it.
■ At the left side of the printer, remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then slide
the cover (callout 3) toward the rear of the printer to release it.
1 2
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
3. Remove one screw (callout 1), hold up the top front cover (callout 2), and then remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● Small flat-blade screwdriver
1. Use a small flat-blade screwdriver to release the tabs on the HIP cover.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Pull up the control panel cover. A small flat blade screwdriver might be helpful with this.
4. Use a small flat blade screwdriver to pry and hold one tab (callout 1), push the assembly (callout 2)
to the rear of the printer to release another tab (callout 3), and then lift the control panel up (callout
4), slightly and gently.
CAUTION: The control panel is still attached to the printer. Do not attempt to completely remove
the control panel.
4
2
1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
● Torx 10 screwdriver
● Print any pages necessary to make sure the printer is functioning correctly.
■ Pull the control panel out and tilt it up, and then remove the two thumbscrews on the control panel
arm. Remove the control panel by pulling it away from the printer.
5800dn, 5800f, 5800zf, X57945dn, X58045dn, X57945z, X58045z, 6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+,
X677dn, X677z+, X67755dn, X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
Remove the rear upper left cover (MFP models 5800dn, 5800f, 5800zf, X57945dn, X58045dn, X57945z, and
X58045z)
Follow these steps to remove the rear upper cover.
■ Remove one screw (callout) and slide the panel to the right to remove it
Remove the rear upper left cover (MFP models 5800dn, 5800f, 5800zf, X57945dn, X58045dn, X57945z, and X58045z)
719
Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z,
X67755zs, and X67765zs)
Follow these steps to remove the rear upper cover.
2. Using a flat head screwdriver, disengage three snap-fit leavers then pull the cover away from the
printer.
■ Remove the 2 indicated screws the slide the cover slightly to the right and pull the cover away from
the engine to remove.
Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models 6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+, X677dn, X677z+, X67755dn,
X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+) 721
2. Remove four screws.
NOTE: Carefully ensure that the cables do not catch on the cable guides as you lift the assembly.
1. Remove the plastic cover near the end of the slide by using the torx 10 screwdriver.
The piece is held with two small snaps so light force is required to overcome it, the piece
coming loose will produce an audible click.
a. Remove 10 screws.
3. Remove 4 screws (1), and then carefully disconnect the FFC tape (2).
IMPORTANT: Make sure to follow the installation procedure following the "Unpack the replacement
assembly" directions.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
1. Place the new slide assembly making sure the slide assembly and the FFC align with their
respective openings in the engine casing. Extend the slide a small distance to verify placement
in the next step.
2. Ensure that the alignment hole in the slide assembly is over the embossed alignment pin.
Figure 5-281 Embossed alignment pin and slide assembly alignment hole, respectively
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer. To order the part, go to
www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Table 5-52
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
● Torx 10 screwdriver
● Print any pages necessary to make sure the printer is functioning correctly.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
NOTE: The task below shows the rear upper cover on a 6800zfsw model. The cover on your model
might look different, but the process is the same.
■ Remove two screws, pry the right side away from printer, and then pull the cover in the direction
indicated.
TIP: These are self-tapping screws for plastic. When reinstalling, rotate the screw
counterclockwise to align it with the existing thread pattern, and then carefully turn it clockwise to
tighten. Do not overtighten. This will prevent stripping the threads inside the screw hole.
2. Disconnect one flat cable (callout 1), remove one ground screw (callout 2) to release the grounding
cable, and then disconnect the indicated connectors (callout 3) on the scanner control board.
Figure 5-287 Disconnect the flat cable, ground cable, and connectors
1 2 3
3. Tilt the document feeder back until it stops, and then lift it off of the scanner until it stops.
NOTE: While removing the document feeder, carefully pass the cables through the cable channel
in the scanner bed.
NOTE: Carefully ensure that the cables do not catch on the cable guides as you lift the assembly.
a. Open the stapler cover from the end closest to the front on the engine.
3. Disconnect the rainbow cable from the upper right corner of the Stapler
b. Push the stapler assembly to the right to unseat it then twist the stapler out of the printer.
If the stapler’s cable is damaged, remove the cable from the engine.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
1. If installing a convenient stapler on a printer that has not previously had one installed, remove the
cover plate.
2. To install a new stapler assembly, go to the ‘Remove the convenience stapler assembly’ section and
reverse the removal steps.
NOTE: This procedure describes manually unlocking the cartridges when the printer is not
functioning.
To remove the cartridges by using the control-panel ejection method when the printer is operational,
see the CSR instructions.
View a video of removing and replacing the toner cartridges (manual unlock).
CAUTION: To prevent damage to a toner cartridge, do not expose it to light for more than a few
minutes. Cover the imaging drum if the toner cartridge must be removed from the printer for an
extended period of time.
If toner gets on the skin or clothing, wipe it off with dry tissue paper and wash in cold water. Hot water
sets toner and it might be difficult, or impossible, to remove.
Required tools
● Tool with a ≤ 3mm point and < 120mm length
1. Remove Tray 2
Follow these steps to remove Tray 2.
Removal and replacement: Toner cartridges (manual unlock) (X654/X677 models) 737
1. Pull the tray out until it stops.
2. Lift the front of the tray, and then pull it out of the printer to remove it.
1 2 3 4
3. Open the cartridge door. Use a tool with a less-than 3mm tip (and less than 120mm in length) to
release the lock mechanism.
a. Place the tip of the tool in the opening and under the lock mechanism (callout 1)
NOTE: When the lock mechanism is released, the corresponding toner cartridge extends out
of the printer.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2
1
3. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalled, make sure the cable is correctly routed through the cable
guide.
J311 J311
J312 J312
J313 J313
J301 J301
J314 J314
J315 J305
J316 J316
J302 J302
J317 J317
5. Release one tab (callout 1), and then lift up the registration assembly (callout 2) off the secondary
transfer assembly (callout 3)
1
2
6. Close the secondary transfer assembly until it is only slightly open. Slide the assembly (callout 1) in
the direction indicated below, and then dislodge the hinge pin (callout 2) from the holder to remove
the assembly.
Reinstallation tip: Before removing the assembly, take note of where the assembly hinge pins fit
into the holes provided in the printer.
Reinstallation tip: On the assembly right side, make sure that the wire is nested in the plastic
sleeve. Slide the wire sleeve into its place, depressing the spring, and then twist the left side of the
assembly into place and allow the spring pressure to nest the hinge pin in its hole.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Hold the two side levers and pull out the ITB assembly.
CAUTION: Do not touch the gray plastic belt. Skin oils and fingerprints on the belt can cause print-
quality problems.
2. Release two tabs (callout 1), and then remove the PCA cover (callout 2).
2
1
3. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalled, make sure the cable is correctly routed through the cable
guide.
J311 J311
J312 J312
J313 J313
J301 J301
J314 J314
J315 J305
J316 J316
J302 J302
J317 J317
5. Release one tab (callout 1), and then lift up the registration assembly (callout 2) off the secondary
transfer assembly (callout 3)
1
2
Reinstallation tip: Before removing the assembly, take note of where the assembly hinge pins fit
into the holes provided in the printer.
Reinstallation tip: On the assembly right side, make sure that the wire is nested in the plastic
sleeve. Slide the wire sleeve into its place, depressing the spring, and then twist the left side of the
assembly into place and allow the spring pressure to nest the hinge pin in its hole.
1. Disconnect one connector (J314; callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable
guides (callout 3).
NOTE: The shaft on the left side of the assembly is long and can break. Make sure to pivot the
right side of the assembly out first to ensure that the shaft does not break. When installing a
registration density sensor assembly, insert the shaft on the left side first, and then pivot the right
side into the printer.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Release two tabs (callout 1), and then remove the PCA cover (callout 2).
2
1
3. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalled, make sure the cable is correctly routed through the cable
guide.
J311 J311
J312 J312
J313 J313
J301 J301
J314 J314
J315 J305
J316 J316
J302 J302
J317 J317
5. Release one tab (callout 1), and then lift up the registration assembly (callout 2) off the secondary
transfer assembly (callout 3)
1
2
Reinstallation tip: Before removing the assembly, take note of where the assembly hinge pins fit
into the holes provided in the printer.
Reinstallation tip: On the assembly right side, make sure that the wire is nested in the plastic
sleeve. Slide the wire sleeve into its place, depressing the spring, and then twist the left side of the
assembly into place and allow the spring pressure to nest the hinge pin in its hole.
1. Disconnect three connectors (callout 1). and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
1
2
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the registration assembly (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the paper pickup assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Release two tabs (callout 1), and then remove the PCA cover (callout 2).
2
1
3. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalled, make sure the cable is correctly routed through the cable
guide.
J311 J311
J312 J312
J313 J313
J301 J301
J314 J314
J315 J305
J316 J316
J302 J302
J317 J317
5. Release one tab (callout 1), and then lift up the registration assembly (callout 2) off the secondary
transfer assembly (callout 3)
1
2
Reinstallation tip: Before removing the assembly, take note of where the assembly hinge pins fit
into the holes provided in the printer.
Reinstallation tip: On the assembly right side, make sure that the wire is nested in the plastic
sleeve. Slide the wire sleeve into its place, depressing the spring, and then twist the left side of the
assembly into place and allow the spring pressure to nest the hinge pin in its hole.
1. Disconnect one connector (J314; callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable
guides (callout 3).
NOTE: The shaft on the left side of the assembly is long and can break. Make sure to pivot the
right side of the assembly out first to ensure that the shaft does not break. When installing a
registration density sensor assembly, insert the shaft on the left side first, and then pivot the right
side into the printer.
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide (callout 3),
remove one screw (callout 4), and then remove the pickup assembly (callout 5).
4
3 1
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling, there are two holes. The screw goes in the upper hole where it
comes into contact with the grounding wire.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
1 2
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling, there are two holes. The screw goes in the upper hole where it
comes into contact with the grounding wire.
2. Remove the gear (callout 1) from the pickup assembly (callout 2).
2 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
CAUTION: The fuser is hot. Wait at least 10 minutes after turning the printer power off before
removing the fuser.
2. Squeeze the release levers on the handles (circle callouts), and then remove the fuser.
1. Pull the lever (callout 1) at the back of the cable cover (callout 2) to release one tab (callout 3), and
then remove the cable cover.
2 3
1
2
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling, lift the flag (callout 1) to prevent the flag from entering the
duct (callout 2)
1 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
RM2-3822-000CN Laser scanner assembly (5700, 55745, 5800, 57945, X58045dn, X58045z,
X58045zs )
Make sure that all of the connectors on the LVPS are fully seated.
Make sure that all of the connectors on the formatter are fully seated.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
■ At the left side of the printer, remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then slide
the cover (callout 3) toward the rear of the printer to release it.
1 2
3
2
1 4
2. Disconnect the FFC (callout 1), and then pull the laser scanner assembly (callout 2) out of the
printer.
1 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
IMPORTANT: Do not replace the formatter, DC controller, and eMMC PCA or hard-disk drive
simultaneously during a single printer servicing. Doing so might cause the printer to become unstable
or inoperable.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Make sure that the formatter cover is fully seated, and that the thumbscrews are finger tight after
replacing it.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
■ Disconnect all of the connectors on the DC controller, remove four screws (callout 1), and then
remove the DC controller (callout 2).
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
CAUTION: Under NO circumstances should a formatter from a different printer be installed during
the repair or troubleshooting processes. The formatter stores important data specific to the model of
printer it is installed in and is not deigned to be swapped or re-purposed in any way. Return a used
formatter to HP.
● Serial number, product number, product name, page count, and supported cartridges information
change and might make a product unusable.
If a used formatter is installed and causes this issue, the partner must cover the costs of the repair in
the form of a product replacement. There is no method in the field to recover a printer where a used
formatter is installed.
IMPORTANT: Do not replace the formatter, DC controller, and hard-disk drive simultaneously during a
single printer servicing. Doing so might cause the printer to become unstable or inoperable.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the fax PCA (callout 1) and the hard disk drive (HDD) (callout 2), and then remove seven
screws (callout 3) to remove the formatter.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker 787
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the fax PCA (callout 1) and the hard disk drive (HDD) (callout 2), and then remove seven
screws (callout 3) to remove the formatter.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
NOTE: Be careful not to drop any of the screws into the low-voltage power supply assembly below
the DC controller.
3
1
3. Unhook one spring (callout 1), release the cable (callout 2) from the cable clamp (callout 3), remove
four screws (callout 4), and then remove the formatter cage (callout 5).
2
4
3 5
4. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
1
3
2
4
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker 793
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the fax PCA (callout 1) and the hard disk drive (HDD) (callout 2), and then remove seven
screws (callout 3) to remove the formatter.
2. Using a flat head screwdriver, disengage three snap-fit leavers then pull the cover away from the
printer.
Remove the rear upper cover (MFP models X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z,
X67755zs, and X67765zs) 795
5. Remove the rear cover
Follow these steps to remove the rear cover.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
2
2
2. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
3 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove three screws (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
1. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove three screws (callout 2).
2
2
Reinstallation tip: The indicated gears (callout 1), clutch (callout 2), shaft (callout 3), and bushing
(callout 4) are not fixed to the assembly plate. Ensure that these components do not fall apart when
installing or removing the paper pickup drive assembly.
1
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
3. Release one tab, and then slide the front right cover upward to remove it.
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then slide the rear inner cover (callout
3) downward to remove it.
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), slide the rear lower cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated below,
and then remove it.
3 2
3. Remove the cable clamp (callout 1), disconnect two connectors (callout 2), and then remove three
screws (callout 3).
1
3
3
2 1
Reinstallation tip: The indicated gears (callout 1), clutch (callout 2), shaft (callout 3), and bushing
(callout 4) are not fixed to the assembly plate. Ensure that these components do not fall apart when
installing or removing the paper pickup drive assembly.
1
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
3. Release one tab, and then slide the front right cover upward to remove it.
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then slide the rear inner cover (callout
3) downward to remove it.
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), slide the rear lower cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated below,
and then remove it.
■ Disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove three screws (callout 2), and then remove the toner
supply motor assembly (callout 3).
1
3
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the lifter drive assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
33 21
12
3. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the lifter drive assembly (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2 1
5 5
3 4 6
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
3. Remove two screws (callout 1), remove the auto close assembly (callout 2), and then remove the
drawer connector (callout 3) from the auto close assembly.
2 3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
Removal and replacement: Tray 2 media size detect assembly (6700/6800 models)
Learn about removing and replacing the Tray 2 media size detect assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker 849
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2 1
5 5
3 4 6
■ Pull out the Tray 2 media size detect assembly (callout 1) toward you.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
Removal and replacement: Tray 2 media size detect assembly (X654/X677 models)
Learn about removing and replacing the Tray 2 media size detect assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Removal and replacement: Tray 2 media size detect assembly (X654/X677 models) 855
○ Connect the power cable.
3. Release one tab, and then slide the front right cover upward to remove it.
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
3. Remove two screws (callout 1), remove the auto close assembly (callout 2), and then remove the
drawer connector (callout 3) from the auto close assembly.
2 3
Remove the Tray 2 media size detect assembly (X654/X677 models) 859
■ Release one tab (callout 1), and then pull out the Tray 2 media size detect assembly (callout 2) toward
you.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the fuser drive assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
CAUTION: The fuser is hot. Wait at least 10 minutes after turning the printer power off before
removing the fuser.
2. Squeeze the release levers on the handles (circle callouts), and then remove the fuser.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
3. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker 863
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2. Pull the lever (callout 1) of the cable cover (callout 2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the
cable cover.
6
2
4 1
5. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), remove four screws (callout 2), and then remove the fuser
drive assembly (callout 3).
2 3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the main drive assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
CAUTION: The fuser is hot. Wait at least 10 minutes after turning the printer power off before
removing the fuser.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
3. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the fax PCA (callout 1) and the hard disk drive (HDD) (callout 2), and then remove seven
screws (callout 3) to remove the formatter.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
CAUTION: If the left cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
■ Disconnect all of the connectors on the DC controller, remove four screws (callout 1), and then
remove the DC controller (callout 2).
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the cable clamp (callout 1), remove four screws (callout 2), and then slide the DC controller
stay (callout 3) out to remove it.
NOTE: Be careful not to drop any of the screws into the low-voltage power supply assembly below
the DC controller.
3
1
2
4
3 5
4. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
1
3
2
4
2
2
2. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
3 1
1. Disconnect all the connectors on the DC controller PCA, remove the cable clamp (callout 1), remove
three screws (callout 2), and then slide the DC controller stay (callout 3) upward to release and to
remove it.
2. Disconnect all the connectors on the drive PCA, remove one screw (callout 1), release two tabs
(callout 2), and then remove the drive PCA (callout 3).
IMPORTANT: Some of these wires are very tightly connected. Take care when disconnecting them.
33
22
11
NOTE: Make sure that the front door is closed when performing this procedure.
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling, align the pegs in the holes, and then set the cover against the
frame and rotate it up and into position.
5
1
3
2
4. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the link cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
5. Close the right door a little, and then release the link arm (callout 1) from the coupling (callout 2).
NOTE: This is a keyed connection. When disconnecting, make sure to line up the peg with the
socket so that you do not strip the peg.
Reinstallation tip: If the black link arm disconnects from the white link arm below it, it might be
helpful for reinstallation purposes to reattach the two link arms.
6. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), release the cable (callout 2) from the fan cover (callout 3),
release four tabs (callout 4), and then remove the fan cover.
1 2
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling this cover, seat the right side pegs into the chassis slots first.
7. Release the cables (callout 1) and the remove FFC (callout 2) from the cable guide (callout 3).
NOTE: All seven screws are on sheet metal tabs on the assembly.
NOTE: Ensure that the screws do not fall into the assembly.
9. Special installation instructions for a main drive assembly (replacement unit and serviced unit)
● Replacement unit: A replacement unit is a new assembly that installs in place of a discarded
in-service unit.
● In-service unit: An in-service unit is a existing assembly that has been removed for repair or to
gain access to other assemblies.
CAUTION: When the main drive assembly is installed (replacement units and service units), the
front door must be closed.
IMPORTANT: If you are installing a new main drive assembly (replacement unit), you do not need to
perform the alignment steps below. New assemblies are already aligned.
a. Replacement unit and in-service unit: On the printer engine, be careful to not depress the
levers located behind the main drive assembly (when it is installed).
2
1 1
NOTE: For a replacement unit install, skip the remaining alignment steps which are for in-
service units only.
b. In-service unit: There are four gears on the main drive assembly that need to be lined up
correctly in order to successfully reinstall the main drive. For each gear, the triangle (callout 1)
on the inside of the gear should line up with the triangle (callout 2) stamped on the sheet metal
chassis. Also, the hole (callout 3) in the gear should line up with a hole in the chassis.
c. In-service unit: In order to realign the four gears, you must remove the motor that locks the
gear auger above the four gears. To do this, disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove two
screws (callout 2), and then remove the motor (callout 3).
d. In-service unit: To realign the four gears, turn the gear (callout 1) in the direction indicated. By
turning that gear, the four gears (callout 2) that need to be in phase turn in tandem. Turn the
four gears to the correct phase position.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
CAUTION: The fuser is hot. Wait at least 10 minutes after turning the printer power off before
removing the fuser.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
3. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the fax PCA (callout 1) and the hard disk drive (HDD) (callout 2), and then remove seven
screws (callout 3) to remove the formatter.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
1 2
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
■ Disconnect all of the connectors on the DC controller, remove four screws (callout 1), and then
remove the DC controller (callout 2).
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the cable clamp (callout 1), remove four screws (callout 2), and then slide the DC controller
stay (callout 3) out to remove it.
NOTE: Be careful not to drop any of the screws into the low-voltage power supply assembly below
the DC controller.
3
1
2
4
3 5
4. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
1
3
2
4
2
2
2. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
3 1
1. Disconnect all the connectors on the DC controller PCA, remove the cable clamp (callout 1), remove
three screws (callout 2), and then slide the DC controller stay (callout 3) upward to release and to
remove it.
2. Disconnect all the connectors on the drive PCA, remove one screw (callout 1), release two tabs
(callout 2), and then remove the drive PCA (callout 3).
IMPORTANT: Some of these wires are very tightly connected. Take care when disconnecting them.
33
22
11
NOTE: Make sure that the front door is closed when performing this procedure.
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling, align the pegs in the holes, and then set the cover against the
frame and rotate it up and into position.
5
1
3
2
4. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the link cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
5. Close the right door a little, and then release the link arm (callout 1) from the coupling (callout 2).
NOTE: This is a keyed connection. When disconnecting, make sure to line up the peg with the
socket so that you do not strip the peg.
Reinstallation tip: If the black link arm disconnects from the white link arm below it, it might be
helpful for reinstallation purposes to reattach the two link arms.
6. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), release the cable (callout 2) from the fan cover (callout 3),
release four tabs (callout 4), and then remove the fan cover.
1 2
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling this cover, seat the right side pegs into the chassis slots first.
7. Release the cables (callout 1) and the remove FFC (callout 2) from the cable guide (callout 3).
NOTE: All seven screws are on sheet metal tabs on the assembly.
NOTE: Ensure that the screws do not fall into the assembly.
9. Special installation instructions for a main drive assembly (replacement unit and serviced unit)
● Replacement unit: A replacement unit is a new assembly that installs in place of a discarded
in-service unit.
● In-service unit: An in-service unit is a existing assembly that has been removed for repair or to
gain access to other assemblies.
CAUTION: When the main drive assembly is installed (replacement units and service units), the
front door must be closed.
IMPORTANT: If you are installing a new main drive assembly (replacement unit), you do not need to
perform the alignment steps below. New assemblies are already aligned.
a. Replacement unit and in-service unit: On the printer engine, be careful to not depress the
levers located behind the main drive assembly (when it is installed).
2
1 1
NOTE: For a replacement unit install, skip the remaining alignment steps which are for in-
service units only.
b. In-service unit: There are four gears on the main drive assembly that need to be lined up
correctly in order to successfully reinstall the main drive. For each gear, the triangle (callout 1)
on the inside of the gear should line up with the triangle (callout 2) stamped on the sheet metal
chassis. Also, the hole (callout 3) in the gear should line up with a hole in the chassis.
c. In-service unit: In order to realign the four gears, you must remove the motor that locks the
gear auger above the four gears. To do this, disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove two
screws (callout 2), and then remove the motor (callout 3).
d. In-service unit: To realign the four gears, turn the gear (callout 1) in the direction indicated. By
turning that gear, the four gears (callout 2) that need to be in phase turn in tandem. Turn the
four gears to the correct phase position.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
CAUTION: The fuser is hot. Wait at least 10 minutes after turning the printer power off before
removing the fuser.
2. Squeeze the release levers on the handles (circle callouts), and then remove the fuser.
Reinstallation tip: During Reinstallation of the target part, do not reseat the ITB to early in the
process. The ITB must remain disengaged to make sure that the gear is correctly aligned.
A 46.00.0x error occurs if the ITB if the procedure is completed with the ITB seated.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker 913
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the fax PCA (callout 1) and the hard disk drive (HDD) (callout 2), and then remove seven
screws (callout 3) to remove the formatter.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
■ At the left side of the printer, remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then slide
the cover (callout 3) toward the rear of the printer to release it.
1 2
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
■ Disconnect all of the connectors on the DC controller, remove four screws (callout 1), and then
remove the DC controller (callout 2).
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the cable clamp (callout 1), remove four screws (callout 2), and then slide the DC controller
stay (callout 3) out to remove it.
NOTE: Be careful not to drop any of the screws into the low-voltage power supply assembly below
the DC controller.
3
1
2
4
3 5
4. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
1
3
2
4
2
2
2. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
3 1
1. Disconnect all the connectors on the DC controller PCA, remove the cable clamp (callout 1), remove
three screws (callout 2), and then slide the DC controller stay (callout 3) upward to release and to
remove it.
2. Disconnect all the connectors on the drive PCA, remove one screw (callout 1), release two tabs
(callout 2), and then remove the drive PCA (callout 3).
IMPORTANT: Some of these wires are very tightly connected. Take care when disconnecting them.
33
22
11
NOTE: Make sure that the front door is closed when performing this procedure.
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling, align the pegs in the holes, and then set the cover against the
frame and rotate it up and into position.
5
1
3
2
4. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the link cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
5. Close the right door a little, and then release the link arm (callout 1) from the coupling (callout 2).
NOTE: This is a keyed connection. When disconnecting, make sure to line up the peg with the
socket so that you do not strip the peg.
Reinstallation tip: If the black link arm disconnects from the white link arm below it, it might be
helpful for reinstallation purposes to reattach the two link arms.
6. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), release the cable (callout 2) from the fan cover (callout 3),
release four tabs (callout 4), and then remove the fan cover.
1 2
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling this cover, seat the right side pegs into the chassis slots first.
7. Release the cables (callout 1) and the remove FFC (callout 2) from the cable guide (callout 3).
NOTE: All seven screws are on sheet metal tabs on the assembly.
NOTE: Ensure that the screws do not fall into the assembly.
9. Special installation instructions for a main drive assembly (replacement unit and serviced unit)
● Replacement unit: A replacement unit is a new assembly that installs in place of a discarded
in-service unit.
● In-service unit: An in-service unit is a existing assembly that has been removed for repair or to
gain access to other assemblies.
CAUTION: When the main drive assembly is installed (replacement units and service units), the
front door must be closed.
IMPORTANT: If you are installing a new main drive assembly (replacement unit), you do not need to
perform the alignment steps below. New assemblies are already aligned.
a. Replacement unit and in-service unit: On the printer engine, be careful to not depress the
levers located behind the main drive assembly (when it is installed).
2
1 1
NOTE: For a replacement unit install, skip the remaining alignment steps which are for in-
service units only.
b. In-service unit: There are four gears on the main drive assembly that need to be lined up
correctly in order to successfully reinstall the main drive. For each gear, the triangle (callout 1)
on the inside of the gear should line up with the triangle (callout 2) stamped on the sheet metal
chassis. Also, the hole (callout 3) in the gear should line up with a hole in the chassis.
c. In-service unit: In order to realign the four gears, you must remove the motor that locks the
gear auger above the four gears. To do this, disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove two
screws (callout 2), and then remove the motor (callout 3).
d. In-service unit: To realign the four gears, turn the gear (callout 1) in the direction indicated. By
turning that gear, the four gears (callout 2) that need to be in phase turn in tandem. Turn the
four gears to the correct phase position.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Removal and replacement: Waste toner duct assembly (X654/X677/6700/6800 models) 931
1. Open the front door.
2. Lift the TCU slightly and then pull it out of the printer.
NOTE: Maintain the position of the TCU as you pull it out from the printer. This will ensure that you
do not spill any waste toner in the printer. Place the unit into the clear plastic bag the new TCU was
packaged in.
2. Grasp the two levers on the ITB, and then slightly pull it out of the printer to unseat and disengage it.
Reinstallation tip: During Reinstallation of the target part, do not reseat the ITB to early in the
process. The ITB must remain disengaged to make sure that the gear is correctly aligned.
A 46.00.0x error occurs if the ITB if the procedure is completed with the ITB seated.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
4. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
■ Remove two screws (callout 1), and then slide the output tray (callout 2) towards the front (SFP
models) or left (MFP models) to remove it.
1 2
1. Release one tab (callout 1), pull the upper part of the contact holder (callout 2) forward, slide the
contact holder in the direction indicated, and then rotate the contact holder.
2
1
3. Remove three screws (callout 1), and then slide the support plate (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
4. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
2 1
2 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
NOTE: Maintain the position of the TCU as you pull it out from the printer. This will ensure that you
do not spill any waste toner in the printer. Place the unit into the clear plastic bag the new TCU was
packaged in.
CAUTION: The fuser is hot. Wait at least 10 minutes after turning the printer power off before
removing the fuser.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
4. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
3. Release one tab, and then slide the front right cover upward to remove it.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
1 2
2. At the left side of the door, release the link arm (callout 1) from the clip (callout 2) on the front-door
assembly.
3. At the right side of the door, release the link arm (callout 1) from the clip (callout 2) on the front-door
assembly.
2 1
4. Remove two screws (callout 1), release the link lever (callout 2) from the front door assembly (callout
3), and then remove the front door.
2
1 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), release two USB cables (callout 2) and another cable (callout 3) from the
cable clamp (callout 4).
1
3
4. Remove two screws (callout 1), release two tabs (callout 2), and then remove the top cover (callout
3).
1 3
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then remove the top cover (callout 2).
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
3. Remove one screw (callout 1), hold up the top front cover (callout 2), and then remove it.
3. Release five tabs (callout 1), and then remove the front inner cover (callout 2).
5. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the pre-exposure PCA holder assembly (callout 2) in the
direction indicated to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Removal and replacement: Pre-exposure PCA holder assembly (X654/X677 models) 955
2. Lift the TCU slightly and then pull it out of the printer.
NOTE: Maintain the position of the TCU as you pull it out from the printer. This will ensure that you
do not spill any waste toner in the printer. Place the unit into the clear plastic bag the new TCU was
packaged in.
CAUTION: The fuser is hot. Wait at least 10 minutes after turning the printer power off before
removing the fuser.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
4. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
3. Release one tab, and then slide the front right cover upward to remove it.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
1 2
2. At the left side of the door, release the link arm (callout 1) from the clip (callout 2) on the front-door
assembly.
3. At the right side of the door, release the link arm (callout 1) from the clip (callout 2) on the front-door
assembly.
2 1
4. Remove two screws (callout 1), release the link lever (callout 2) from the front door assembly (callout
3), and then remove the front door.
2
1 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), release two USB cables (callout 2) and another cable (callout 3) from the
cable clamp (callout 4).
1
3
4. Remove two screws (callout 1), release two tabs (callout 2), and then remove the top cover (callout
3).
1 3
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then remove the top cover (callout 2).
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
3. Remove one screw (callout 1), hold up the top front cover (callout 2), and then remove it.
4. Release five tabs (callout 1), and then remove the front inner cover (callout 2).
6. Release four tabs (callout 1), and then slide the pre-exposure PCA holder assembly (callout 2)
upward.
1 1
8. Remove the link arm (callout 1) and two link levers (callout 2) from the pre-exposure PCA holder
assembly (callout 3).
Figure 5-657 Remove the link arm and two link levers
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Since the disassembly procedures of the following four toner supply drive assemblies are similar, the
disassembly procedure of the 1st toner supply drive assembly (callout 1) is shown below as an example.
1 2 3 4
1. Open the toner supply door and remove the toner cartridges.
NOTE: You can remove toner cartridges using the Service menu or Supplies menu on the printer
control panel, or manually.
b. Pull the cover 3 millimeters forward to clear the tab on the back of the cover, and then slide the
cover upward while the toner supply door is open.
3. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
5. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the toner cartridge rail assembly (callout 2) towards the
front to remove it.
6. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), remove one screw (callout 2), slide the toner supply drive
assembly (callout 3) towards the front, and then slide the toner supply drive assembly downward to
remove it.
● Reinstallation tip: Since a toner supply drive assembly can be installed in another station, be
careful not to mix. The exception is assemblies 2 and 4, which are the same.
● Reinstallation tip: On the first toner supply drive assembly, there are no gears (callout 1) and
no coupling (callout 2).
● Reinstallation tip: On the second and fourth toner supply drive assemblies, there are 3 gears
(callout 1) and no coupling (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
NOTE: When replacing the toner supply assembly, always replace the toner supply buffer assembly/
intermediate pipe at the same time.
Since the disassembly procedures of the following four toner supply assemblies are similar, the
disassembly procedure of the first toner supply assembly (callout 1) is shown below as an example.
1 2 3 4
1 2
IMPORTANT: When installing a new HP Toner supply service kit, ensure that the coupling gear is
attached to the toner duct. This gear should be captive, in case it gets detached, a new Toner
supply service kit must be ordered.
1 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
Removal and replacement: Toner supply buffer assembly/intermediate pipe (X654/X677 models)
Learn about removing and replacing the toner supply buffer assembly/intermediate pipe.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
NOTE: When replacing the toner supply assembly, always replace the toner supply buffer assembly/
intermediate pipe at the same time.
Since the disassembly procedures of the following four toner supply assemblies are similar, the
disassembly procedure of the first toner supply assembly (callout 1) is shown below as an example.
1 2 3 4
1 2
IMPORTANT: When installing a new HP Toner supply service kit, ensure that the coupling gear is
attached to the toner duct. This gear should be captive, in case it gets detached, a new Toner
supply service kit must be ordered.
1 2
Since the disassembly procedures of the following four toner supply drive assemblies are similar, the
disassembly procedure of the 1st toner supply drive assembly (callout 1) is shown below as an example.
1 2 3 4
1. Open the toner supply door and remove the toner cartridges.
NOTE: You can remove toner cartridges using the Service menu or Supplies menu on the printer
control panel, or manually.
3. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
5. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the toner cartridge rail assembly (callout 2) towards the
front to remove it.
6. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), remove one screw (callout 2), slide the toner supply drive
assembly (callout 3) towards the front, and then slide the toner supply drive assembly downward to
remove it.
● Reinstallation tip: Since a toner supply drive assembly can be installed in another station, be
careful not to mix. The exception is assemblies 2 and 4, which are the same.
● Reinstallation tip: On the first toner supply drive assembly, there are no gears (callout 1) and
no coupling (callout 2).
● Reinstallation tip: On the second and fourth toner supply drive assemblies, there are 3 gears
(callout 1) and no coupling (callout 2).
NOTE: When replacing toner supply buffer assembly/intermediate pipe, always replace the toner
supply assembly at the same time.
Since the disassembly procedures of the following four toner supply buffer assemblies are similar,
the disassembly procedure of the first toner supply buffer assembly (callout 1) is shown below as an
example.
1 2 3 4
Remove the toner supply buffer assembly/intermediate pipe (X654/X677 models) 987
■ Slide the toner supply buffer assembly (callout 1) frontward, and then slide the toner supply buffer
assembly (callout 1) and the intermediate pipe (callout 2) downward to remove them together.
IMPORTANT: When installing a new HP Toner supply service kit, ensure that the coupling gear is
attached to the toner duct. This gear should be captive, in case it gets detached, a new Toner supply
service kit must be ordered.
1 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Release two tabs (callout 1), and then remove the PCA cover (callout 2).
2
1
3. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalled, make sure the cable is correctly routed through the cable
guide.
J311 J311
J312 J312
J313 J313
J301 J301
J314 J314
J315 J305
J316 J316
J302 J302
J317 J317
5. Release one tab (callout 1), and then lift up the registration assembly (callout 2) off the secondary
transfer assembly (callout 3)
1
2
Reinstallation tip: Before removing the assembly, take note of where the assembly hinge pins fit
into the holes provided in the printer.
Reinstallation tip: On the assembly right side, make sure that the wire is nested in the plastic
sleeve. Slide the wire sleeve into its place, depressing the spring, and then twist the left side of the
assembly into place and allow the spring pressure to nest the hinge pin in its hole.
1. Disconnect three connectors (callout 1). and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable guide
(callout 3).
1
2
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the registration assembly (callout 2).
2. Remove the gear (callout 1) from the feed assembly (callout 2).
1 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip
Make sure that all of the connectors on the formatter are fully seated.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker 997
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
2. Lift the TCU slightly and then pull it out of the printer.
NOTE: Maintain the position of the TCU as you pull it out from the printer. This will ensure that you
do not spill any waste toner in the printer. Place the unit into the clear plastic bag the new TCU was
packaged in.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
3. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
1 2
■ Remove two screws (callout 1), and then slide the output tray (callout 2) towards the front (SFP
models) or left (MFP models) to remove it.
4 5 3
5 4 1 2 5
Reinstallation tip: The FFC (callout 2) is attached to the high-voltage PCA cover (callout 1) by
double sided tape. When removing the FFC from the high-voltage PCA cover, take care not to
damage the FFC.
6 5
1
4
2 3
● Reinstallation tip: When installing the high-voltage power supply PCA (callout 1), confirm that
the contact springs (callout 2) are in the correct position (so that the PCA engages with the
spring).
Figure 5-715 Verify that the contact springs are in the correct position
2
2
11
22
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2. Disconnect all the connectors on the drive PCA, remove one screw (callout 1), release two tabs
(callout 2), and then remove the drive PCA (callout 3).
IMPORTANT: Some of these wires are very tightly connected. Take care when disconnecting them.
33
22
11
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Release one tab, and then slide the front right cover upward to remove it.
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
■ Disconnect all the connectors on the feed/toner supply controller PCA. Remove two screws (callout
1), remove two PCA spacers (callout 2), and then remove the feed/toner supply controller PCA (callout
3).
2 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
2
1
3. Disconnect all the connectors on the right PCA, release two tabs (callout 1), and then remove the
right PCA (callout 2).
CAUTION: The FFCs are tightly packed and can be difficult to remove. A solution is to remove the
FFCs from the rear of the unit, remove the PCA, and then remove the FFCs to reinstall them on the
back. This option should be used only if needed and to ensure that the FFCs are not damaged.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker 1027
3. Remove the rear cover
Follow these steps to remove the rear cover.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
■ Disconnect all the connectors on the rear PCA, remove one screw (callout 1), release two tabs
(callout 2), and then remove the rear PCA (callout 3).
NOTE: Grounding wires are mounted on the top of this PCA. Use care when removing it. Pull the
bottom part out first, and then slide the assembly down to cleanly release from the spring wires at
the top.
Reinstallation tip: When installing the rear PCA, confirm that each contact spring (callout 1) is in the
correct position (so that the PCA engages with the springs).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
3
4 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), release two tabs (callout 2), and then remove the drum home
position sensor PCA (callout 3).
1 3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker 1059
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove four screws (callout 2), and then remove the motor
(callout 3).
2 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the fax PCA (callout 1) and the hard disk drive (HDD) (callout 2), and then remove seven
screws (callout 3) to remove the formatter.
CAUTION: If the cover is being removed to gain access to the main drive assembly, make sure
that the front door remains closed. This keeps the main drive properly aligned.
2. At the left side of the printer, insert the small flat-blade screwdriver into the slot to release one tab
(callout 1).
1 2
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the cable clamp (callout 1), remove four screws (callout 2), and then slide the DC controller
stay (callout 3) out to remove it.
NOTE: Be careful not to drop any of the screws into the low-voltage power supply assembly below
the DC controller.
3
1
2
4
3 5
4. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
1
3
2
4
2
2
2. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
3 1
■ Disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove two screws (callout 2), and then remove the motor
(callout 3).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove three screws (callout 2), and then remove the motor
(callout 3).
2 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
2. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove three screws (callout 2), and then remove the motor
(callout 3).
11
22
33
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker 1091
3. Remove the rear cover
Follow these steps to remove the rear cover.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
1. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the fan holder (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
NOTE: Take care not to pull any cables as you remove this assembly.
2. Release five tabs (callout 1), and then remove the power supply fan (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
2. At the back of the printer, remove two screws, and then slide the rear cover as indicated to remove
it.
1. Unhook one spring (callout 1), and then disconnect two connectors (callout 2).
NOTE: Unhook the spring from the formatter cage, not the low-voltage power supply. The spring
should remain attached to the LVPS.
2. Remove the FFC (callout 1), and then disconnect five connectors (callout 2).
2 1
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the low-voltage power supply assembly (callout 2).
NOTE: The black ducting in the lower right corner can stick during the removal process.
Replacement LVPS only: Remove the spring (callout 3), and then install it on the replacement LVPS.
2 3
Reinstallation tip: When reinstalling the LVPS, make sure that the spring (callout 1) is attached to
both the formatter cage (callout 2) and the LVPS (callout 3).
1 2
2. Pull out the cartridge fan (callout 1) toward you, and then remove the sponge (callout 2) from the
cartridge fan.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the formatter cover (callout 2) away from the printer to
remove it.
2. Remove the formatter cover for printer with the 3 bin stapler/stacker
Follow these steps to remove the formatter cover.
X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6081zfsw, X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs
2. Slide the formatter cover away from the printer to remove it.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the fax PCA (callout 1) and the hard disk drive (HDD) (callout 2), and then remove seven
screws (callout 3) to remove the formatter.
NOTE: The figures below show some assemblies (for example the top cover and formatter) removed
that might still be installed on the printer. However, the steps to remove the cover are correct.
IMPORTANT: Some of the flat flexible cable (FFC) connectors use hinged retainers to secure them
to the DC controller. The hinged retainers must be opened to release the FFCs.
2. Remove the cable clamp (callout 1), remove four screws (callout 2), and then slide the DC controller
stay (callout 3) out to remove it.
NOTE: Be careful not to drop any of the screws into the low-voltage power supply assembly below
the DC controller.
3
1
2
4
3 5
4. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
1
3
2
4
2
2
2. For a replacement formatter cage only: Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable guide (callout
2), release one tab (callout 3), and then remove the memory PCA (callout 4) from the formatter cage
(callout 5).
3 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), slide the fan holder (callout 3) in
the direction indicated, and then pull the fan holder (callout 3) out of the printer.
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the fuser fan (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
CAUTION: The fuser is hot. Wait at least 10 minutes after turning the printer power off before
removing the fuser.
2. Squeeze the release levers on the handles (circle callouts), and then remove the fuser.
2. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove the exhaust fan (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
Figure 5-860 Remove the front left cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
Removal and replacement: Front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder) 1117
○ Connect the power cable.
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the front right cover (callout 2) upward to remove it.
Figure 5-861 Remove the front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the front right cover (callout 2) upward to remove it.
Figure 5-862 Remove the front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
1
2
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the front right cover (callout 2) upward to remove it.
Figure 5-866 Remove the front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
1
2
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
Figure 5-871 Remove the front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
1
2
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
■ Slide the left cover (callout 1) in the direction indicated to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the front right cover (callout 2) upward to remove it.
Figure 5-877 Remove the front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove one screw (callout 2), and then remove the pickup
assembly (callout 3).
2 1
1 2
5. Slide the paper pickup assembly to the left to release it from the drive gear on the lifter drive
assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the lifter drive assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Removal and replacement: Lifter drive assembly (550-sheet paper feeder) 1135
After performing service
Turn the printer power on
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the front right cover (callout 2) upward to remove it.
Figure 5-884 Remove the front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
1
2
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
Figure 5-890 Remove the lifter drive assembly (550-sheet paper feeder)
3 2
4 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the pickup drive assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Figure 5-891 Remove the front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
1
2
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
3 2
3. Remove the cable clamp (callout 1), disconnect two connectors (callout 2), and then remove three
screws (callout 3).
3
3
Figure 5-899 Remove the pickup drive assembly (550-sheet paper feeder)
2
1
Reinstallation tip: The indicated gears (callout 1), clutch (callout 2), shaft (callout 3), and bushing
(callout 4) are not fixed to the assembly plate. Ensure that these components do not fall apart when
installing or removing the paper pickup drive assembly.
1
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the auto close assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the front right cover (callout 2) upward to remove it.
Figure 5-901 Remove the front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
1
2
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then slide the rear inner cover (callout
3) downward to remove it.
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the rear cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
3. Remove two screws (callout 1), remove the auto close assembly (callout 2), and then remove the
drawer connector (callout 3) from the auto close assembly.
2 3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
Removal and replacement: Media size detection assembly (550-sheet paper feeder)
Learn about removing and replacing the paper feeder media size detection assembly.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the media size detection assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
Removal and replacement: Media size detection assembly (550-sheet paper feeder) 1151
After performing service
Turn the printer power on
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the front right cover (callout 2) upward to remove it.
Figure 5-909 Remove the front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
1
2
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
3. Remove two screws (callout 1), remove the auto close assembly (callout 2), and then remove the
drawer connector (callout 3) from the auto close assembly.
2 3
Remove the media size detection assembly (550-sheet paper feeder) 1155
■ Release one tab (callout 1), and then pull the media size detect assembly (callout 2) toward you to
remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Figure 5-918 Remove the front right cover (550-sheet paper feeder)
1. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the base frame (callout 2).
1
2
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right door assembly (callout 2) in the direction
indicated to remove it.
■ Disconnect all the connectors on the paper feeder controller PCA, remove two screws (callout 1),
remove two PCA spacers (callout 2), and then remove the paper feeder controller PCA (callout 3).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Removal and replacement: Separation roller assembly (550-sheet paper feeder) 1161
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
2. Slide the lever (callout 1) to the right, and then remove the roller assembly (callout 2) by pulling it out
from the printer.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
Removal and replacement: Pickup roller assembly (550-sheet paper feeder) 1163
○ Connect the power cable.
2. Slide the lever (callout 1) to the right, and then remove the roller assembly (callout 2) by pulling it out
from the printer.
NOTE: Even if you want to replace only the pickup roller assembly, you must first remove the
separation roller assembly.
■ Locate the pickup roller assembly (callout 1) and then pull it away from the printer to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
1. Open the HCI tray, and then open the right door.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
1. Open the HCI tray, and then open the right door.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the rear cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
2. Remove the left cover (callout 1) together with the front left cover (callout 2). Release one tab
(callout 3), and then slide the front left cover upward to remove it from the left cover.
Figure 5-931 Remove the front left cover from the left cover (HCI)
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
1. Open the HCI tray, and then open the right door.
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then slide the right door (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the rear cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
1. Open the HCI tray, and then open the right door.
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then slide the right door (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
■ Bend the left edge of the rear lower cover (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then pull the rear
lower cover toward you from the left end of it to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Pull the HCI cassette assembly (callout 1) out of the HCI chassis.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
1. Open the HCI tray, and then open the right door.
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then slide the right door (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
2. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove one screw (callout 2), and then remove the pickup
assembly (callout 3).
2 3
3. Remove the gear (callout 2) from the pickup assembly (callout 1).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
3. Pull the HCI cassette assembly (callout 1) out of the HCI chassis.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Open the HCI tray, and then open the right door.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the rear cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
2 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
1. Open the HCI tray, and then open the right door.
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then slide the right door (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), and then slide the rear cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
1. Disconnect four connectors (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable clamps
(callout 3).
3 1
2 1
Reinstallation tip: When reassembling the pickup alienation assembly, line up the hole (callout 1) in
the gear overlaps the position of the hole (callout 2) in the pickup alienation assembly.
11
22
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the pickup drive assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
1. Open the HCI tray, and then open the right door.
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then slide the right door (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
1. Disconnect four connectors (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable clamps
(callout 3).
3 1
2 1
Reinstallation tip: When reassembling the pickup alienation assembly, line up the hole (callout 1) in
the gear overlaps the position of the hole (callout 2) in the pickup alienation assembly.
11
22
3
3
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the pickup drive assembly (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Pull the HCI cassette assembly (callout 1) out of the HCI chassis.
2. Remove the left cover (callout 1) together with the front left cover (callout 2). Release one tab
(callout 3), and then slide the front left cover upward to remove it from the left cover.
Figure 5-968 Remove the front left cover from the left cover (HCI)
2 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
NOTE: The 550-sheet paper feeder is shown in the graphics below. The steps for the HCI rollers are
the same.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
If the part is damaged and cannot be cleaned, use the table below to identify the correct part number
for your printer. To order the part, go to www.hp.com/buy/parts.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
NOTE: The 550-sheet paper feeder is shown in the graphics below. The steps for the HCI rollers are
the same.
NOTE: Even if you want to replace only the pickup roller assembly, you must first remove the
separation roller assembly.
NOTE: The 550-sheet paper feeder is shown in the graphics below. The steps for the HCI rollers are
the same.
■ Locate the pickup roller assembly (callout 1) and then pull it away from the printer to remove it.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
Removal and replacement: Staple cover and staple door (3-bin stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing and replacing the staple cover and door.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
Removal and replacement: Staple cover and staple door (3-bin stapler-stacker) 1211
After performing service
Turn the printer power on
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), and then release three tabs (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the staple cover (callout 2) and the staple door (callout
3) together.
Figure 5-977 Remove the staple door from the staple cover
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
3 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
3 2
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), release two tabs (callout 2), and then remove the right corner cover
(callout 3).
2
3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
1. Remove the printer formatter cover by removing one screw (callout 1) and then sliding the cover
(callout 2) in the direction indicated. Slide the 3-bin stapler-stacker formatter cover assembly
(callout 3) in the direction indicated to remove it.
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the staple cover (callout 2) and the staple door (callout
3) together.
4. Remove two shafts (callout 1), and then remove the staple door (callout 2) from the staple cover
(callout 3).
Figure 5-987 Remove the staple door from the staple cover
Remove the staple cover and staple door (3-bin stapler-stacker) 1221
3. Remove the right upper cover (3-bin stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing the 3-bin stapler-stacker right upper cover.
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then remove the right upper cover
(callout 3).
3 2
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), release two tabs (callout 2), and then remove the right corner cover
(callout 3).
2
3
1 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
2 3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the staple cover (callout 2) and the staple door (callout
3) together.
4. Remove two shafts (callout 1), and then remove the staple door (callout 2) from the staple cover
(callout 3).
Figure 5-998 Remove the staple door from the staple cover
Remove the staple cover and staple door (3-bin stapler-stacker) 1229
3. Remove the right upper cover (3-bin stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing the 3-bin stapler-stacker right upper cover.
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then remove the right upper cover
(callout 3).
3 2
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), release two tabs (callout 2), and then remove the right corner cover
(callout 3).
2
3
1 2
1. Remove two shafts (callout 1), and then open the feed guide (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right bushing (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
1 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● No special tools are required to remove or install this assembly.
1. Remove the printer formatter cover by removing one screw (callout 1) and then sliding the cover
(callout 2) in the direction indicated. Slide the 3-bin stapler-stacker formatter cover assembly
(callout 3) in the direction indicated to remove it.
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the staple cover (callout 2) and the staple door (callout
3) together.
4. Remove two shafts (callout 1), and then remove the staple door (callout 2) from the staple cover
(callout 3).
Figure 5-1010 Remove the staple door from the staple cover
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then remove the right upper cover
(callout 3).
3 2
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), release two tabs (callout 2), and then remove the right corner cover
(callout 3).
2
3
1 2
1. Remove two shafts (callout 1), and then open the feed guide (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right bushing (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
1 1
2 2
1 1
1
3 4
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the plate (callout 2) from the stapler assembly
(callout 3).
3 2
4 1
2. Release two tabs (callout 1), remove the duct 1 (callout 2) and the duct 2 (callout 3), and then remove
the MBM fan (callout 4) from the holder.
3
2
2. Release the cable (callout 1) from cable clamps (callout 2), and then disconnect three connectors
(callout 3).
2 1 3
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the guide (callout 2).
CAUTION: Be sure that the paper guides extend into the tray area when reinstalling the upper
feed assembly. The guides can be damaged if they are trapped behind the in-cave frame when the
assembly is seated in the frame.
2 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the staple cover (callout 2) and the staple door (callout
3) together.
4. Remove two shafts (callout 1), and then remove the staple door (callout 2) from the staple cover
(callout 3).
Figure 5-1032 Remove the staple door from the staple cover
1. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), remove three screws (callout 2), and then remove the stapler
assembly (callout 3) and the plate (callout 4) together.
1
3 4
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), and then remove the plate (callout 2) from the stapler assembly
(callout 3).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Remove the printer formatter cover by removing one screw (callout 1) and then sliding the cover
(callout 2) in the direction indicated. Slide the 3-bin stapler-stacker formatter cover assembly
(callout 3) in the direction indicated to remove it.
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), and then release three tabs (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the staple cover (callout 2) and the staple door (callout
3) together.
Figure 5-1039 Remove the staple door from the staple cover
1. Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable clamp (callout 2), and then disconnect one connector
(callout 3).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2 2
1 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the upper feed assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Remove the printer formatter cover by removing one screw (callout 1) and then sliding the cover
(callout 2) in the direction indicated. Slide the 3-bin stapler-stacker formatter cover assembly
(callout 3) in the direction indicated to remove it.
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), and then release three tabs (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the staple cover (callout 2) and the staple door (callout
3) together.
Remove the staple cover and staple door (3-bin stapler-stacker) 1259
4. Remove two shafts (callout 1), and then remove the staple door (callout 2) from the staple cover
(callout 3).
Figure 5-1048 Remove the staple door from the staple cover
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then remove the right upper cover
(callout 3).
3 2
2
3
■ Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right lower cover (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
1 2
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the left bushing (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right bushing (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
1 1
1. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), remove three screws (callout 2), and then remove the stapler
assembly (callout 3) and the plate (callout 4) together.
1
3 4
1. Release the cable (callout 1) from cable guide (callout 2), release one tab (callout 3), and then
remove the inner cover (callout 4).
3
2
2 1 3
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the guide (callout 2).
4. Remove six screws (callout 1), and then remove the upper feed assembly (callout 2).
CAUTION: Be sure that the paper guides extend into the tray area when reinstalling the upper
feed assembly. The guides can be damaged if they are trapped behind the in-cave frame when the
assembly is seated in the frame.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the staple cover (callout 2) and the staple door (callout
3) together.
4. Remove two shafts (callout 1), and then remove the staple door (callout 2) from the staple cover
(callout 3).
Figure 5-1066 Remove the staple door from the staple cover
Remove the staple cover and staple door (3-bin stapler-stacker) 1269
3. Remove the right upper cover (3-bin stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing the 3-bin stapler-stacker right upper cover.
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then remove the right upper cover
(callout 3).
3 2
■ Remove one screw (callout 1), release two tabs (callout 2), and then remove the right corner cover
(callout 3).
2
3
1 2
1. Release one boss (callout 1), rotate the pin (callout 2) in the direction indicated, and then remove the
pin.
2 2
1 1
1. Remove two shafts (callout 1), and then open the feed guide (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then slide the right bushing (callout 2) in the direction indicated to
remove it.
1 1
1. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), remove three screws (callout 2), and then remove the stapler
assembly (callout 3) and the plate (callout 4) together.
1
3 4
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove one screw (callout 2), and then remove the fan holder
(callout 3) together with the fan (callout 4).
3 2
4 1
1. Release the cable (callout 1) from cable guide (callout 2), release one tab (callout 3), and then
remove the inner cover (callout 4).
3
2
2 1 3
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the guide (callout 2).
4. Remove six screws (callout 1), and then remove the upper feed assembly (callout 2).
CAUTION: Be sure that the paper guides extend into the tray area when reinstalling the upper
feed assembly. The guides can be damaged if they are trapped behind the in-cave frame when the
assembly is seated in the frame.
2 1
1. Disconnect two connectors (callout 1), and then remove one screw (callout 2).
3. Remove one screw (callout 1), remove the cover (callout 2), remove three screws (callout 3), and then
remove the lower feed assembly (callout 4).
1 2 4
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Remove the printer formatter cover by removing one screw (callout 1) and then sliding the cover
(callout 2) in the direction indicated. Slide the 3-bin stapler-stacker formatter cover assembly
(callout 3) in the direction indicated to remove it.
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), and then release three tabs (callout 2).
3. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the staple cover (callout 2) and the staple door (callout
3) together.
Remove the staple cover and staple door (3-bin stapler-stacker) 1283
4. Remove two shafts (callout 1), and then remove the staple door (callout 2) from the staple cover
(callout 3).
Figure 5-1093 Remove the staple door from the staple cover
1. Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable clamp (callout 2), and then disconnect one connector
(callout 3).
1. Release one boss (callout 1), rotate the pin (callout 2) in the direction indicated, and then remove the
pin.
2 2
1 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove one screw (callout 2), and then remove the fan holder
(callout 3) together with the fan (callout 4).
3 2
4 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable stoppers
(callout 3).
2 3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
3 2
4 1
2. Release two tabs (callout 1), remove the duct 1 (callout 2) and the duct 2 (callout 3), and then remove
the MBM fan (callout 4) from the holder.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Remove the printer formatter cover by removing one screw (callout 1) and then sliding the cover
(callout 2) in the direction indicated. Slide the 3-bin stapler-stacker formatter cover assembly
(callout 3) in the direction indicated to remove it.
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), remove one screw (callout 2), and then remove the fan holder
(callout 3) together with the fan (callout 4).
3 2
4 1
2. Release two tabs (callout 1), remove the duct 1 (callout 2) and the duct 2 (callout 3), and then remove
the MBM fan (callout 4) from the holder.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1
3
2. Remove two screws (callout 1), release three tabs (callout 2), and then remove the rear cover
(callout 3).
3 1
1 3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Remove the hinge (callout 1) from the front door assembly (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
Removal and replacement: Upper and lower output bins (floor-standing stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing and replacing the floor-standing stapler-stacker upper and lower output bins.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the upper and lower output bins.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Removal and replacement: Upper and lower output bins (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1301
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
■ Release one boss (callout 1), rotate the pin (callout 2) in the direction indicated, and then remove the
pin. Remove either the upper bin (callout 3) or the lower bin (callout 4) with this process.
2 2
1 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Removal and replacement: Left upper rear cover (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1303
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
View a video demonstration of removing and replacing the left lower rear cover.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Remove one screw (callout 1), and then release two tabs (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM front cover (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Release another tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM rear cover (callout 2).
2 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Release another tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM rear cover (callout 2).
2 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Release another tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM rear cover (callout 2).
2 1
2 2
1 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
■ Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner upper cover (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
■ Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner lower cover (callout 2).
1
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
■ Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner lower cover (callout 2).
1
2
■ Remove three screws (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then remove the front inner cover
(callout 3).
2 3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
Removal and replacement: Foot front cover (tall model only) (floor-standing stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing and replacing the floor-standing stapler-stacker foot front cover (tall finishers).
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
■ Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner lower cover (callout 2).
1
2
3 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Remove the hinge (callout 1) from the front door assembly (callout 2).
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the foot front cover (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Tall finishers only: Remove one screw (callout 1), and then remove the tall foot rear cover (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Remove the hinge (callout 1) from the front door assembly (callout 2).
1
2
3 2
1. Tall finishers only: Remove one screw (callout 1), and then remove the tall foot rear cover (callout 2).
■ Release three tabs (callout 1), and then remove the foot center cover (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
3 2
1. Tall finishers only: Remove one screw (callout 1), and then remove the tall foot rear cover (callout 2).
■ Release three tabs (callout 1), and then remove the foot center cover (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
■ Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner lower cover (callout 2).
1
2
3 2
■ Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable clamp (callout 2), disconnect two connectors (callout 3),
remove one screw (callout 4), and then remove the stapler (callout 5).
3
5
4 1
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1
2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
1. Remove one screw (callout 1), and then release two tabs (callout 2).
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from cable clamps
(callout 3).
3 2 1 4 5
3. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the power supply assembly (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
Figure 5-1259 The four tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Removal and replacement: Height wall lower assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1401
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
3. Remove the hinge (callout 1) from the front door assembly (callout 2).
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM front cover (callout 2).
■ Press the left and right stoppers (callout 1) to remove the shaft (callout 2), and then remove the MBM
output bin (callout 3).
2 2
1 1
Figure 5-1274 The two tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
Removal and replacement: Lifter base upper assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1409
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
3. Remove the hinge (callout 1) from the front door assembly (callout 2).
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM front cover (callout 2).
■ Press the left and right stoppers (callout 1) to remove the shaft (callout 2), and then remove the MBM
output bin (callout 3).
2 2
1 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove two screws (callout 2).
Figure 5-1286 The four tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
3. Release three tabs (callout 1), and then remove the height wall upper assembly (callout 2).
■ Disconnect one connector (callout 1), release the cable clamp (callout 2), remove eight screws
(callout 3), and then remove the upper lifter base assembly (callout 4).
1
4
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
2 2
1 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove two screws (callout 2).
Figure 5-1298 The two tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
3. Release three tabs (callout 1), and then remove the lower height wall assembly (callout 2).
■ Disconnect one connector (callout 1), release the cable clamp (callout 2), remove eight screws
(callout 3), and then remove the lower lifter base assembly (callout 4).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
■ Press the left and right stoppers (callout 1) to remove the shaft (callout 2), and then remove the MBM
output bin (callout 3).
2 2
1 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove two screws (callout 2).
Figure 5-1315 The four tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
3. Release three tabs (callout 1), and then remove the height wall upper assembly (callout 2).
Figure 5-1319 The two tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
Do not touch the center (callout 1) of the upper lifter base assembly (callout 2) because grease is applied
to the center.
1
4
Do not touch the center (callout 1) of the lower lifter base assembly (callout 2) because grease is applied
to the center.
■ Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable clamp (callout 2), disconnect two connectors (callout 3),
remove four screws (callout 4), and then remove the delivery assembly (callout 5).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
■ Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner upper cover (callout 2).
3. Release another tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM rear cover (callout 2).
2 1
2. Remove one FFC (callout 1), disconnect seven connectors (callout 2), and then release the cable
(callout 3) from the cable clamps (callout 4).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Remove the hinge (callout 1) from the front door assembly (callout 2).
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM front cover (callout 2).
■ Press the left and right stoppers (callout 1) to remove the shaft (callout 2), and then remove the MBM
output bin (callout 3).
2 2
1 1
3. Release another tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM rear cover (callout 2).
2 1
Figure 5-1369 The four tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
Do not touch the center (callout 1) of the upper lifter base assembly (callout 2) because grease is applied
to the center.
1
4
1. Release one tab (callout 1), remove the sensor PCA (callout 2), disconnect one connector (callout 1),
and then release the cable (callout 4) from the cable clamps (callout 5).
2 3 5
1 4
3
1
3. Disconnect four connectors (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable clamps
(callout 3).
1 3
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
Removal and replacement: Drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing and replacing the floor-standing stapler-stacker drum assembly and door handle
rail assembly.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
■ Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner lower cover (callout 2).
1
2
■ Remove three screws (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then remove the front inner cover
(callout 3).
2 3
2 2
1 1
Remove the drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1467
2. Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the door handle rail assembly (callout 2).
Reinstallation tip: When installing the drum assembly, align the projection (callout 1) on the drum
assembly (callout 2) with the mark (callout 3) on the sheet metal (callout 4).
1 2 3
Reinstallation tip: When installing the door handle rail assembly and drum assembly, the shaft (callout
1) of drum assembly is inserted into the hole (callout 2) of the door handle rail assembly, and the shaft
(callout 3) is inserted into the hole (callout 4) of the door handle rail assembly.
2 1
Remove the drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1469
8. Unpack the replacement assembly
Follow these steps to unpack the replacement assembly.
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
3. Remove the hinge (callout 1) from the front door assembly (callout 2).
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM front cover (callout 2).
1
2
■ Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner upper cover (callout 2).
1. Remove one screw (callout 1), and then release two tabs (callout 2).
Remove the drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1479
2. Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the door handle rail assembly (callout 2).
Reinstallation tip: When installing the drum assembly, align the projection (callout 1) on the drum
assembly (callout 2) with the mark (callout 3) on the sheet metal (callout 4).
1 2 3
Reinstallation tip: When installing the door handle rail assembly and drum assembly, the shaft (callout
1) of drum assembly is inserted into the hole (callout 2) of the door handle rail assembly, and the shaft
(callout 3) is inserted into the hole (callout 4) of the door handle rail assembly.
2 1
Remove the drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1481
10. Remove the drum drive assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing the floor-standing stapler-stacker drum drive assembly.
1. Disconnect all the connectors on the controller PCA, and then release the cables (callout 1) from
the cable clamps (callout 2).
2. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the controller PCA (callout 2) and the plate (callout
3) together.
Figure 5-1414 Remove the controller PCA and the plate together
1 2
4. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the drum drive assembly (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
2. Push the stopper (callout 1) in the direction indicated, and then pull up the front door assembly
(callout 2) to remove it.
■ Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner upper cover (callout 2).
2 1
■ Press the left and right stoppers (callout 1) to remove the shaft (callout 2), and then remove the MBM
output bin (callout 3).
2 2
1 1
2 2
1 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove two screws (callout 2).
Figure 5-1439 The four tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
3. Release three tabs (callout 1), and then remove the height wall upper assembly (callout 2).
■ Disconnect one connector (callout 1), release the cable clamp (callout 2), remove eight screws
(callout 3), and then remove the upper lifter base assembly (callout 4).
1
4
2 3 5
1 4
2. Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable clamps (callout 2), and then disconnect six connectors
(callout 3).
3
1
3. Disconnect four connectors (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable clamps
(callout 3).
1 3
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove two screws (callout 2).
Figure 5-1453 The two tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
Do not touch the center (callout 1) of the lower lifter base assembly (callout 2) because grease is applied
to the center.
■ Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable clamp (callout 2), disconnect two connectors (callout 3),
remove four screws (callout 4), and then remove the delivery assembly (callout 5).
2. Remove one FFC (callout 1), disconnect seven connectors (callout 2), and then release the cable
(callout 3) from the cable clamps (callout 4).
■ Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner lower cover (callout 2).
1
2
2 3
21. Remove the drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing the floor-standing stapler-stacker drum assembly and door handle rail assembly.
Remove the drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1505
2. Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the door handle rail assembly (callout 2).
Reinstallation tip: When installing the drum assembly, align the projection (callout 1) on the drum
assembly (callout 2) with the mark (callout 3) on the sheet metal (callout 4).
1 2 3
Reinstallation tip: When installing the door handle rail assembly and drum assembly, the shaft (callout
1) of drum assembly is inserted into the hole (callout 2) of the door handle rail assembly, and the shaft
(callout 3) is inserted into the hole (callout 4) of the door handle rail assembly.
2 1
Remove the drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1507
22. Remove the drum drive assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing the floor-standing stapler-stacker drum drive assembly.
1. Disconnect all the connectors on the controller PCA, and then release the cables (callout 1) from
the cable clamps (callout 2).
2. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the controller PCA (callout 2) and the plate (callout
3) together.
Figure 5-1470 Remove the controller PCA and the plate together
1 2
4. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the drum drive assembly (callout 2).
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
WARNING! To avoid damage to the printer, turn the printer off, wait 30 seconds, and then remove
the power cord before attempting to service the printer.
Use the table below to identify the correct part number for your printer, and then go to
https://parts.hp.com/hpparts to order the part.
Required tools
● #2 Phillips screwdriver with a magnetic tip and a 152 mm (6 in) shaft length
3. Remove the hinge (callout 1) from the front door assembly (callout 2).
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM front cover (callout 2).
3. Release another tab (callout 1), and then remove the MBM rear cover (callout 2).
2 1
■ Press the left and right stoppers (callout 1) to remove the shaft (callout 2), and then remove the MBM
output bin (callout 3).
2 2
1 1
2 2
1 1
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove two screws (callout 2).
Figure 5-1496 The four tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
3. Release three tabs (callout 1), and then remove the height wall upper assembly (callout 2).
■ Disconnect one connector (callout 1), release the cable clamp (callout 2), remove eight screws
(callout 3), and then remove the upper lifter base assembly (callout 4).
1
4
2 3 5
1 4
2. Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable clamps (callout 2), and then disconnect six connectors
(callout 3).
3
1
3. Disconnect four connectors (callout 1), and then release the cable (callout 2) from the cable clamps
(callout 3).
1 3
1. Disconnect one connector (callout 1), and then remove two screws (callout 2).
Figure 5-1510 The two tabs viewed from the other side of the assembly
Do not touch the center (callout 1) of the lower lifter base assembly (callout 2) because grease is applied
to the center.
■ Release the cable (callout 1) from the cable clamp (callout 2), disconnect two connectors (callout 3),
remove four screws (callout 4), and then remove the delivery assembly (callout 5).
2. Remove one FFC (callout 1), disconnect seven connectors (callout 2), and then release the cable
(callout 3) from the cable clamps (callout 4).
■ Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the front inner lower cover (callout 2).
1
2
2 3
■ Remove two screws (callout 1), release one tab (callout 2), and then remove the foot front cover
(callout 3).
3 2
2. Release one tab (callout 1), and then remove the foot front cover (callout 2).
2. Remove one screw (callout 1), and then remove the foot rear cover (callout 1).
24. Remove the drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker)
Learn about removing the floor-standing stapler-stacker drum assembly and door handle rail assembly.
2. Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the door handle rail assembly (callout 2).
Remove the drum assembly/door handle rail assembly (floor-standing stapler-stacker) 1535
3. Remove the drum assembly (callout 1).
Reinstallation tip: When installing the drum assembly, align the projection (callout 1) on the drum
assembly (callout 2) with the mark (callout 3) on the sheet metal (callout 4).
1 2 3
Reinstallation tip: When installing the door handle rail assembly and drum assembly, the shaft (callout
1) of drum assembly is inserted into the hole (callout 2) of the door handle rail assembly, and the shaft
(callout 3) is inserted into the hole (callout 4) of the door handle rail assembly.
2 1
1. Disconnect all the connectors on the controller PCA, and then release the cables (callout 1) from
the cable clamps (callout 2).
2. Remove four screws (callout 1), and then remove the controller PCA (callout 2) and the plate (callout
3) together.
Figure 5-1532 Remove the controller PCA and the plate together
1 2
5. Remove three screws (callout 1), and then remove the prop (callout 2).
1 2
http://www8.hp.com/us/en/hp-information/environment/product-recycling.html
perform service work at an ESD-protected workstation or mat. If an ESD workstation or mat is not
available, touch the sheet-metal chassis to provide a static ground before touching an ESD-
sensitive assembly. Protect the ESD-sensitive assemblies by placing them in ESD pouches when
they are out of the printer.
IMPORTANT: Make sure that all of the shipping materials (for example shipping tape) are removed
from the replacement part prior to installation.
NOTE: If the replacement part is a roller or pad, avoid touching the spongy part of it. Skin oils on
the roller or pad can cause paper pickup and/or print-quality problems. HP recommends using
disposable gloves when handling rollers or pads or washing your hands before touching rollers or
pads.
NOTE: When applicable, special installation instructions are provided for an assembly at the end
of the removal procedure. Always completely read the removal instructions and follow all special
installation instructions.
Printer parts information including exploded assembly diagrams and part number lists.
2
4
No
No
Not shown 6M1P3-67001 ADF Pick/Sep Roller Kit (Flow 6xxx Series) 1
Control panels
Parts diagrams and part lists for the control panels.
Control panels
Parts diagrams and parts lists for the printer control panels.
1
2
No
A07
A07 2
A07
A07 3
12
A01 A07
11
A02
8
9
A06
A03
A04 6 A07
LLC
7
10 A05 LLC
No
A07
1
A07 2
16 A07 A07
3
A01 4
15
A07
14
5
13 A07
10
A07
A02
A06
A03
A04 8
A05
11
9 7
12
6
LLC
LLC
No
No
A07
1
A07
A07
3
A07
5
4
14
A01 A07
13
A02
10
11
A06
A03
A04 8 A07
LLC
9
12 A05 LLC
No
No
A07
1
A07
A07
18 A07 3
5
4
A01 6
17
A07
16
7
15 A07
12
A07
A02
A06
A03
A04 10
A05
13
9
11
14
8 LLC
LLC
No
A30
3 A01 A28
A27
2
6
A30
5
1 4
A29
SFP 6700/MFP 6800 7
11 (J102) A28
A26
(J191)
B
SFP 6700/MFP 6800
A25 A02
(J338)
(J338D)
10
A23 A03
A24 A19
A30 A04
A A06
A21
8
A07
A16
A17 A30
A18 A30 LLC
A15 A
A10 (J326)
(J942)
(J203) A08
(J216)
A14
(J209A)
9
A09
A13
(J943A) (J944A)
B A30
A12
A11
No
(J351)
MFP 6800
A02
SFP 6700/MFP 6800 A20 (J124D)
A03
A20
A18 A19
SFP 6700/MFP 6800
A17
A04
A16
LLC
A15
A14 (J305/J315)
A20 A05
2
(J353) 3 A20
A11
A06
A09 5
A08
A20
A07
No
A18
1
2
2
A01
3 A01
1 3
SFP 6700/MFP 6800
MFP 6800 8 A18
A06 A07 A18
A04 A15
A18 4
5
A05 A03
1 (J931)
2 A08 7
9 A
3 A01 (J206)
A09
10
A17
A15
A18
A14
A10
A17 A11
(J130)
A14 A13 (J125)
A (J204)
(J121)
A18 (J905D)
A12 (J290)
(J292)
(J293)
A16
No
No
8 RK3-0762-000CN 1 Fan
9 RK3-0762-000CN 1 Fan
Not shown as 6HN31A 1 HP 500GB CCC FIPS TAA Hard Disk Drive
Ref No
No
(J104)
(J323/J322A)
A19 5 6
A19 (J321A/J321B)
(J208)
A20
9 4 (J103)
3
7
(J207)
A17
(J115)
(J114)
A16 8
A07 (J301)
(J302)
A20
A15
A
A14
A13
A18
A11
A12
A10
A
A09
No
1 RK3-0760-000CN 1 Fan
No
A12
A11
A05
A06
A07
A08
A10
A09
LLC
No
2 RK3-2277-000CN 1 Fan
(J336)
2
(J336D)
A10
A11
A11 5
A01
A11 A09
A07 A06
(J316A)
A11
LLC
A08 6
A11
LLC
A11 A11
A03
No
No
No
No
3 A01 A30
A29
2
6
A30
5
1 4
A31
SFP X654/MFP X677
7
11
A30
A28 B
A27
(J338)
(J338D)
A02
10
A25 A03
A26 A21
A32 A04
A A06
A23
8
A07
A18
A19 A32
A20 A32 LLC
A16
A15
A
A10 (J326)
A17
(J942)
(J203) A08
(J216)
(J209B)
A14
9
A09
A13 B A32
(J944B)
A12
A11
No
No
MFP X677
(J351) A02
A21 (J124D)
LLC
A01 A21 (J124)
A03
A19
A21
A20
A18
A15 (J135)
A21
A04
A10
2
A11
A21 A14 (J314)
A13 (J311)
(J313)
A21 4
A21 (J312)
A12
A21
(J355) 3 A21
(J353)
A21
A08
A09
A05
5
A21
A06
A07
No
A19 A19
A02
1
2
2
A01
3 A01 1 3
SFP X654/MFP X677
8 A19
A06 A07 A19
A04 A16
4
5
A05 A03
(J931)
A08 7
8 A
(J206)
A09
A19
10
A16 A18
A19
A15
A10
A18 A11
A13
(J130)
A14 (J125)
A15
A (J204)
(J121)
A19 (J905D)
A12 (J290)
(J292)
(J293)
A17
No
No
8 RK3-0762-000CN 2 Fan
Not shown 6HN31A 1 HP 500GB CCC FIPS TAA Hard Disk Drive
A03
1
(J132) (J131)
(J261)
A02 (J262)
9 4 (J103)
3
7
(J207)
A09
(J115)
(J114)
A08 8
A05 (J301)
(J302)
A11
A07
A06
No
1 RK3-0760-000CN 1 Fan
No
A12
A11
A05
A06
A07
A08
A10
A09
LLC
No
2 RK3-2277-000CN 1 Fan
(J151)
(J431) (J423)
(J421) (J336C)
(J692D) (J693D)
(J957D) (J956D) (J991D)
(J694D)
(J955D) (J401) A03
(J695D) (J992D)
(J954D)
(J993D)
(J994D)
(J411)
(J412)
A22
(J416)
(J998)
(J999)
(J976)
1
(J989) A05 (J411D)
A01 A22
(J435)
A04
2 A22
(J417)
(J499)
3
(J499D)
(J410)
4
5
A21 A22
A22
A 7
B C A06 A07
D (J976)
A22
A18
A15 8
A19
A22
(J411DH)
LLC
A20
9
A22
LLC
A16
A22 A14
A12 A22
A22
A17
A22 A08
A13
A09
A11
A
10 B
C A10
No
No
(J327B) A03
A16
A07
(J35)
A01 A02
A16
2
A16 A04
A05
A05
A16
A06
A07
A16
3
A10
A04
A14
A15
A16
A13
A12
A08
A16
A11
A15
A09
A10 A16
A04
No
A10
4
B
A09
A A10
B
3
A10
A10
A10 A08
1
A10
A09
A01
A07
A06 A02
A03
A04
A05
No
2
1
No
No
A01
3 2
No
(J532F)
(J63)
1 (J64)
(J21) A17
(J532FD)
(J511D)
A01 2
(J511F)
4 A17
(J551)
A17
3 (J512)
5
(J512D)
(J541)
6 7
A15 A16
A17
8
A17
A03
(SW16)
(J21) A17
A13 A12
9
A10 A04
A05 (J532)
A14 LLC
A11
A17 A05
A17
LLC
A09
A17 A08 10
A06
A17
A17
A17
A07
No
No
A01
A01
A01
No
Input device - 2,100-sheet high capacity input (HCI) paper feeder 1587
Parts and diagrams: HCI main body
Parts diagram and parts list for the HCI main body.
A19
(SW8/J74)
5
A19 (SW9/J76)
(SW10/J77)
(J511H)
A07
4
(J552)
6
A18
A19
7
A19
(SW13)
(J82)
A08
A19 A09
A13 LLC
A14
9 A11
A19 A12
8
No
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) covers 6800/X677 models
Parts diagram and parts list for the FSSS covers.
13
4
13
A01
12
5
10
6
11
A01
9 7
A01
A01
8
A01
No
No
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) main body 6800/X677 models (1 of 2)
Parts diagram and parts list for the FSSS printer covers.
Figure 6-28 Floor stand staple stacker main body 6800/X677 models
3
1
2
A
16
A15
A
A13 A13
15
5 4
A15 6
A15
A01
7
A15 A03
A02 A04
A06
14 A05
A15
A06
A14
13 A08
8
A07
A13
A09
A
A13
A15
A10
A15
A15 9
12
A15 A14
A11
10
A11
A12
A15
11 A12
Table 6-28 Floor stand staple stacker main body 6800/X677 models
No
No
Figure 6-29 Floor stand staple stacker main body 6800/X677 models
(J83)
(J79) (J88)
(J89)
A21 (J68) (J76)
(J77D)
(J138D) (J80D)
(J140D) (J87) A03
(J85D) (J750D) (J792D) (J790D)
A04
A01 A02
(J760)
(J173) A05
(J167)
(J750)
(J761) (J72)
A21
(J751) (J792) (J790)
(J752) (J741) (J768)
2 (J765) (J780)
3 (J766)
A07
1 A08
(J871) (J716)
A09
A06
A19
4
A10
A A12 A11
A18
A21
A13 A21
A21
A A21
A21 A21
8 5
10 A14
A21
9
A17 A
A13
A21
A20
A16
A21 6
A15
A21
Table 6-29 Floor stand staple stacker main body 6800/X677 models
No
Parts and diagrams: Floor stand staple stacker (FSSS) main body 6800/X677 models (2 of 2) 1593
Table 6-29 Floor stand staple stacker main body 6800/X677 models (continued)
No
A02
A01
A02
No
A02
A03
10
9
A01
A03 3
7 4
5
8
6
A03
No
Parts and diagrams: 3 bin staple stacker main body 6800/X677 models
Parts diagram and parts list for the MFP printer covers.
(J401B)
(J101B) A05
2
A25 5
2 (J9916)
A04 (J1240)
1 (J503B) A25
(J402B)
(J301B) A06
A25
A07 6
A01 (J15)
A02
(FAN21)
A24 (J505B)
A03
A09
A25 A10 A08
13
(M22)
(J15)
A25
A11 A23
7
A13
A22 (SW21)
A14
A10
12 A12
A25 A14
(J301B)
A21 A25 10 (J302B)
A17
A18
A19 9 (J204C)
(J205) (J203C)
(J201C)
A20 (J502B)
(SW4)
(J7301D) 8
(J27)
(J19)
(J26) A15
A25
11 A25
A16
A25
No
No
6 RK2-8153-000CN 1 Fan
12 WC4-5136-000CN 1 Microswitch
Parts and diagrams: 3 bin staple stacker main body 6800/X677 models 1597
Alphabetical parts list
Table 6-33 Alphabetical parts list
ADF Pick/Sep Roller Kit (6xxx Series) 6H122-67001 Integrated scanner assembly
on page 1541
ADF Pick/Sep Roller Kit (Flow 6xxx Series) 6M1P3-67001 Integrated scanner assembly
on page 1541
Assy-USB A F Panel Mount To WTB 335mm 5851-7005 3 bin staple stacker main body
6800/X677 models on page
1596
Cover, Hardware integration pocket (HIP) RC4-0213-000CN Covers 6700 models on page
1545
Cover, Hardware integration pocket (HIP) RC4-0213-000CN Covers X654 models on page
1546
Cover, Hardware integration pocket (HIP) RC4-0213-000CN Covers 6800 models on page
1548
Cover, Hardware integration pocket (HIP) RC4-0213-000CN Covers X677 models on page
1551
Cover, foot front (tall model) RC6-0226-000CN Floor stand staple stacker
covers 6800/X677 models on
page 1589
Cover, front inner right lower RC6-2402-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1593
Cover, front inner upper RC6-0186-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
Door handle rail assembly RM2-3849-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1593
Front inner cover assembly RM2-3861-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1593
HP 213Y Extra High Yield Black Toner Cartridge W2130Y6QN29-67016 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 213Y Extra High Yield Cyan Toner Cartridge W2131Y6QN29-67019 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 213Y Extra High Yield Magenta Toner Cartridge W2133Y6QN29-67027 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 213Y Extra High Yield Yellow Toner Cartridge W2132Y6QN29-67023 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 214Z Ultra High Yield Black Toner Cartridge (SFP) W2140Z49L02-67001 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 214Z Ultra High Yield Cyan Toner Cartridge (SFP) W2141Z49L02-67003 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 214Z Ultra High Yield Magenta Toner Cartridge (SFP) W2143Z49L02-67007 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 214Z Ultra High Yield Yellow Toner Cartridge (SFP) W2142Z49L02-67005 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 217Z Ultra High Yield Black Toner Cartridge (MFP) W2170Z6QN35-67015 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 217Z Ultra High Yield Cyan Toner Cartridge (MFP) W2171Z6QN35-67017 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 217Z Ultra High Yield Magenta Toner Cartridge (MFP) W2173Z6QN35-67021 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 217Z Ultra High Yield Yellow Toner Cartridge (MFP) W2172Z6QN35-67019 Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
HP 500GB CCC FIPS TAA Hard Disk Drive 6HN31A Internal assemblies (3 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1558
HP 500GB CCC FIPS TAA Hard Disk Drive 6HN31A Internal assemblies (3 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1572
HP MFP Analog Fax 703 Accessory (Korea Only) 1M0Q1A Internal assemblies (3 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1558
HP MFP Analog Fax 703 Accessory (Korea Only) 1M0Q1A Internal assemblies (3 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1572
HP W9240MC Black Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) W9240MC6QN29-67029 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9241MC Cyan Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) W9241MC6QN29-67030 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9242MC Yellow Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) W9242MC6QN29-67030 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9243MC Magenta Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) W9243MC6QN29-67032 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9250MC Black Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) W9250MC6QN29-67033 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9251MC Cyan Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) W9251MC6QN29-67034 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9252MC Yellow Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) W9252MC6QN29-67035 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9253MC Magenta Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) W9253MC6QN29-67036 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9260MC Black Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) W9260MC49L02-67009 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9261MC Cyan Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) W9261MC49L02-67010 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9263MC Magenta Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) W9263MC49L02-67012 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9270MC Black Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) W9270MC6QN35-67023 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9271MC Cyan Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) W9271MC6QN35-67024 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
HP W9273MC Magenta Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) W9273MC6QN35-67026 Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
Handle (Lunar Grey Dark/ Cement Dark) 5851-8688 Integrated scanner assembly
on page 1541
Height wall lower assembly RM2-3844-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
Height wall upper assembly RM2-3845-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
Holder, drawer connector upper RC5-9398-000CN HCI main body on page 1588
Lifter base lower assembly RM2-3842-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
Lifter base upper assembly RM2-3843-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
Lower front inner cover assembly RM2-3862-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
Lower paper feed assembly RM2-4168-000CN 3 bin staple stacker main body
6800/X677 models on page
1596
Paper pickup drive assembly RM2-3617-000CN HCI main body on page 1588
Side plate assembly right RM2-3866-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1593
Slide Assembly: (5800dn, 5800f, 5800zf, X57945dn, X58045dn, 6QN29-67006 Control panels on page 1543
X57945z, and X58045z)
Slide Assembly: (6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+, X677dn, 6QN35-67007 Control panels on page 1543
X677z+, X67755dn, X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+)
Slide Assembly: (X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6801zfsw, 6QN35-67008 Control panels on page 1543
X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs)
Sub power supply assembly RM2-3854-000CN Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1593
Upper paper feed assembly RM2-4169-000CN 3 bin staple stacker main body
6800/X677 models on page
1596
1M0Q1A HP MFP Analog Fax 703 Accessory (Korea Only) Internal assemblies (3 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1558
1M0Q1A HP MFP Analog Fax 703 Accessory (Korea Only) Internal assemblies (3 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1572
5851-7005 Assy-USB A F Panel Mount To WTB 335mm 3 bin staple stacker main body
6800/X677 models on page
1596
5851-8688 Handle (Lunar Grey Dark/ Cement Dark) Integrated scanner assembly
on page 1541
6H122-67001 ADF Pick/Sep Roller Kit (6xxx Series) Integrated scanner assembly
on page 1541
6HN31A HP 500GB CCC FIPS TAA Hard Disk Drive Internal assemblies (3 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1558
6HN31A HP 500GB CCC FIPS TAA Hard Disk Drive Internal assemblies (3 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1572
6M1P3-67001 ADF Pick/Sep Roller Kit (Flow 6xxx Series) Integrated scanner assembly
on page 1541
6QN29-67006 Slide Assembly: (5800dn, 5800f, 5800zf, X57945dn, X58045dn, Control panels on page 1543
X57945z, and X58045z)
6QN35-67007 Slide Assembly: (6800dn, 6800zf, 6800zfw+, 6801zfw+, X677dn, Control panels on page 1543
X677z+, X67755dn, X67765dn, X67755z+, and X67765z+)
6QN35-67008 Slide Assembly: (X57945zs, X58045zs, 6800zfsw, 6801zfsw, Control panels on page 1543
X677zs, X677s, X677z, X67755zs, and X67765zs)
RC4-0213-000CN Cover, Hardware integration pocket (HIP) Covers 6700 models on page
1545
RC4-0213-000CN Cover, Hardware integration pocket (HIP) Covers X654 models on page
1546
RC4-0213-000CN Cover, Hardware integration pocket (HIP) Covers 6800 models on page
1548
RC4-0213-000CN Cover, Hardware integration pocket (HIP) Covers X677 models on page
1551
RC5-9398-000CN Holder, drawer connector upper HCI main body on page 1588
RC6-0186-000CN Cover, front inner upper Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
RC6-0226-000CN Cover, foot front (tall model) Floor stand staple stacker
covers 6800/X677 models on
page 1589
RC6-2402-000CN Cover, front inner right lower Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1593
RM2-3617-000CN Paper pickup drive assembly HCI main body on page 1588
RM2-3842-000CN Lifter base lower assembly Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
RM2-3843-000CN Lifter base upper assembly Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
RM2-3844-000CN Height wall lower assembly Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
RM2-3845-000CN Height wall upper assembly Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
RM2-3849-000CN Door handle rail assembly Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1593
RM2-3854-000CN Sub power supply assembly Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1593
RM2-3861-000CN Front inner cover assembly Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1593
RM2-3862-000CN Lower front inner cover assembly Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1591
RM2-3866-000CN Side plate assembly right Floor stand staple stacker main
body 6800/X677 models on
page 1593
RM2-4168-000CN Lower paper feed assembly 3 bin staple stacker main body
6800/X677 models on page
1596
RM2-4169-000CN Upper paper feed assembly 3 bin staple stacker main body
6800/X677 models on page
1596
W2130Y6QN29-67016 HP 213Y Extra High Yield Black Toner Cartridge Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2131Y6QN29-67019 HP 213Y Extra High Yield Cyan Toner Cartridge Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2132Y6QN29-67023 HP 213Y Extra High Yield Yellow Toner Cartridge Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2133Y6QN29-67027 HP 213Y Extra High Yield Magenta Toner Cartridge Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2140Z49L02-67001 HP 214Z Ultra High Yield Black Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2141Z49L02-67003 HP 214Z Ultra High Yield Cyan Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2142Z49L02-67005 HP 214Z Ultra High Yield Yellow Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2143Z49L02-67007 HP 214Z Ultra High Yield Magenta Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2170Z6QN35-67015 HP 217Z Ultra High Yield Black Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2171Z6QN35-67017 HP 217Z Ultra High Yield Cyan Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2172Z6QN35-67019 HP 217Z Ultra High Yield Yellow Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W2173Z6QN35-67021 HP 217Z Ultra High Yield Magenta Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (7 of 7)
6700/6800 models on page
1566
W9240MC6QN29-67029 HP W9240MC Black Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9241MC6QN29-67030 HP W9241MC Cyan Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9242MC6QN29-67030 HP W9242MC Yellow Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9243MC6QN29-67032 HP W9243MC Magenta Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9250MC6QN29-67033 HP W9250MC Black Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9251MC6QN29-67034 HP W9251MC Cyan Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9252MC6QN29-67035 HP W9252MC Yellow Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9253MC6QN29-67036 HP W9253MC Magenta Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9260MC49L02-67009 HP W9260MC Black Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9261MC49L02-67010 HP W9261MC Cyan Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9263MC49L02-67012 HP W9263MC Magenta Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (SFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9270MC6QN35-67023 HP W9270MC Black Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9271MC6QN35-67024 HP W9271MC Cyan Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
W9273MC6QN35-67026 HP W9273MC Magenta Mngd LaserJet Toner Cartridge (MFP) Internal assemblies (9 of 9)
X654/X677 models on page
1582
Certificate of Volatility
Review the certificates of volatility for the printers.
Triage data (which contain device configuration, event logs, crash logs, etc.), Backup files (backup/restore), and device
configuration (to export and clone to other products of same model)
Triage data (which contain device configuration, event logs, crash logs, etc.), Backup files (backup/restore), and device
configuration (to export and clone to other products of same model)
HP Color LaserJet Enterprise 5700, 6700, X557, X55745, X654, X65455, X65465, MFP 5800, 6800, X57945, X58045,
X677, X67755, X67765 WIFI - Supplemental Certificate of Volatility 1651
Figure A-7 Supplemental Certificate of Volatility
802.11
802.11 is a set of standards for wireless local area network (WLAN) communication, developed by the
IEEE LAN/MAN Standards Committee (IEEE 802).
802.11b/g/n
802.11b/g/n can share the same hardware and use the 2.4 GHz band. 802.11b supports bandwidth up
to 11 Mbps, 802.11n supports bandwidth up to 150 Mbps. 802.11b/g/n devices might occasionally suffer
interferences from microwave ovens, cordless telephones, and Bluetooth devices.
AC
An electric current that reverses its direction many times a second at regular intervals. For example, the
110V line current found in a typical US electrical wall receptacle.
ADF
An Automatic Document Feeder (ADF) is a device that automatically feeds an original sheet (or multiple
sheets) of paper into the image scanner. The document feeder is a component of the integrated
scanner assembly (ADF and image scanner).
BOOTP
Bootstrap Protocol. A network protocol used by a network client to obtain its IP address automatically.
This is usually done in the bootstrap process of computers or operating systems running on them. The
BOOTP servers assigns an IP address from a pool of addresses to each client. BOOTP enables “diskless
workstation” computers to obtain an IP address prior to loading any advanced operating system.
CCD
A Charged Coupled Device (CCD) is the scanner module which enables a scan job. A CCD locking
mechanism is used to hold the CCD module to prevent any damage when the printer is moved.
Collation
Collation is a process of printing a multiple-copy job in sets. When collation is selected, the device prints
an entire set before printing additional copies.
Control Panel
The control panel is a flat, typically vertical panel or screen where the user can control and/or monitor
the printer. The control panel is found on the front of the printer.
Coverage
Coverage is the printing term used for a toner usage measurement on printing. For example, 5%
coverage means that an A4 sided paper has about 5% image or text on it. If the paper or original has
complicated images or a large amount of text, the coverage will be higher and at the same time, a toner
usage will be as much as the coverage.
DC
An electric current flowing in one direction only. Typically, a low voltage load current supplied to an
electrical assembly.
DCC
The DC controller (DCC) controls the operation of the printer sub-systems and electrical components.
the DCC sends out various signals to operate motors, solenoids, and other printer components based
on the print command and image data that the host computer sends the formatter.
Default
The value or setting that is in effect when a printer is unboxed, reset, or initialized.
DHCP
Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) is a client-server networking protocol. A DHCP server
provides configuration parameters specific to the DHCP client host requesting, generally, information
required by the client host to participate on an IP network. The DHCP also provides a mechanism for
allocation of IP addresses to client hosts.
DIMM
A Dual Inline Memory Module (DIMM) is a small circuit board that holds memory. The DIMM stores all
data within the printer, such as printing data and received fax data.
DPI
Dots Per Inch (DPI) is a measurement of resolution that is used for scanning and printing. Generally,
higher DPI results in a higher resolution (more visible detail in the image and a larger file size).
Duty Cycle
Duty cycle is the page quantity which does not affect printer performance for a month. Generally, the
printer has the lifespan limitation such as pages per year. The lifespan means the average capacity of
print-outs, usually within the warranty period. For example, if the duty cycle is 48,000 pages per month
the printer limit is 2,400 pages a day (assuming 20 working days/month).
Dynamic Security
Dynamic Security is a toner cartridge design and process for authenticating genuine HP supplies. HP
printers use toner cartridges that have security chips or electronic circuitry. Cartridges using a non-HP
chip, or modified chip, or non-HP circuitry might not work (now or in the future).
e-Duplex
Single-pass electronic duplex (e-Duplex) printer use two separate scan modules to scan the front-side
and back-side of an e-duplex copy job page in a single pass through the document feeder.
EMC
EMC is a measure of a device's ability to operate as intended in its shared operating environment while,
at the same time, not affecting the ability of other equipment within the same environment to operate as
intended.
EMI
EMI is the electromagnetic energy which affects the functioning of an electronic device. Electronic
devices (like printers) are a source of EMI. Because it is rare for electronics to operate in isolation,
products are generally engineered to function in the presence of some amount of EMI.
eMMC
An embedded Multi-Media Card is a compact memory device consisting of NAND flash memory and a
simple storage controller.
Emulation
Emulation is a technique of one machine obtaining the same results as another. An emulator duplicates
the functions of one system with a different system, so that the second system behaves like the first
system. Emulation focuses on exact reproduction of external behavior. This is different from simulation,
which concerns an abstract model of the system being simulated, often considering its internal state.
EPS
Encapsulated PostScript (EPS) is a PostScript (PS) code file which is used for storing font and vector
graphic image information.
ESD
An electrostatic discharge (ESD) is a sudden flow of electricity between two electrically charged objects
caused by contact, an electrical short, or dielectric breakdown. Discharge of built up static electricity.
Ethernet
Ethernet is a frame-based computer networking technology for local area networks (LANs). It defines
wiring and signaling for the physical layer, and frame formats and protocols for the media access
control (MAC)/data link layer of the OSI model. Ethernet is mostly standardized as IEEE 802.3. Ethernet
has become the most widespread LAN technology in use during the 1990s to present.
FFC
Flat Flexible Cables (FFCs) are designed for Printed Circuit Assembly (PCA) to PCA connections (for
example, connecting a fax PCA to the formatter).
FIH
A Foreign Interface Harness (FIH) is a port that enables HP multifunction printers (MFPs) to use third-
party devices to extend the capabilities of the MFP.
Firmware
The formatter stores the printer firmware. A remote firmware upgrade process is used to overwrite and
upgrade the firmware.
Flash memory
Flash memory is non-volatile, meaning it retains stored data even when the power is turned off.
Formatter (LaserJet)
The formatter controls printer functions like receiving and processes print data, developing and
coordinating data placement and timing with the DC controller PCA, storing font and customer
configuration information, communicating with the host computer, and monitoring control panel
functions and relaying printer status information through the control panel.
FTP
FTP stands for File Transfer Protocol. FTP is a protocol designed for transferring files over the Internet.
Files stored on an FTP server can be accessed using an FTP client, such as a web browser, FTP software
program, or a command line interface.
Fuser Unit
The fuser unit is part of a laser printer that adheres the toner onto the printed page. It consists of a
heat roller and a pressure roller. After toner is transferred onto the paper, the fuser unit applies heat and
pressure to make sure that the toner stays on the paper permanently (which is why paper is warm when
it comes out of a laser printer).
Gateway
A connection between computer networks, or between a computer network and a telephone line. A
gateway is used to connect two different computer networks, especially a connection to the Internet.
Grayscale
Shades of gray that represent light and dark portions of a color image printed in monochrome. Colors
are represented by a range of gray shades from white to black.
Halftone
Halftone is a way of reproducing a photograph or other image in which the various tones of gray or color
are produced by variously sized dots of ink or toner. Halftone simulates grayscale by varying the number
of dots. Highly colored areas consist of a large number of dots, while lighter areas consist of a smaller
number of dots.
IEEE
The Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers (IEEE) is an international non-profit, professional
organization for the advancement of technology related to electricity.
Image scanner
The image scanner (or Sub Scanner Assembly) contains the components to digitally scan an original
source document. The image scanner is a component of the integrated scanner assembly (ADF and
image scanner).
IP address
An Internet Protocol (IP) address is a unique number that a device uses in order to identify and
communicate with other devices on a network utilizing the Internet Protocol standard.
IPM
The Images Per Minute (IPM) is a method of measuring the speed of a printer. An IPM rate indicates the
number of single-sided sheets a printer can complete in one minute.
IPP
The Internet Printing Protocol (IPP) defines a standard protocol for printing and managing print jobs,
media size, resolution, etc. IPP can be used locally, or over the internet to reach hundreds of printers. IPP
also supports access control, authentication, and encryption, making it a capable and secure printing
solution.
ISA
The Integrated Scanner Assembly (ISA) includes the document feeder and image scanner.
ISO
The International Organization for Standardization (ISO) is an international standard-setting body
composed of representatives from national standards bodies. In produces world-wide industrial and
commercial standards.
JBIG
Joint Bi-level Image Experts Group (JBIG) is an image compression standard with no loss of accuracy or
quality. It was designed for compression of binary images, particularly for faxes, but can also be used for
other images.
JPEG
Joint Photographic Experts Group (JPEG) is a commonly used standard method of loss compression for
photographic images. It is the format used for storing and transmitting photographs on the World Wide
Web.
LDAP
The Lightweight Directory Access Protocol (LDAP) is a networking protocol for querying and modifying
directory services running over TCP/IP.
LED
A Light-Emitting Diode (LED) is a semiconductor device that can indicate the status of a printer
(formatter LEDs) or a component in a contact image sensor (CIS) scanner that helps capture an image.
LPDC
Late point differentiation configuration (LPDC) allows the channel partner to configure the speed to the
printer depending on the customer’s order. LPDC configuration is stored on the Trusted Platform Module
(TPM).
LVPS - SMPS
Low Voltage Power Supplies (LVPS) and Switching Mode Power Supplies (SMPS) supply direct current
(DC) voltages to various printer components and assemblies.
MAC address
Media Access Control (MAC) address is a unique identifier associated with a network adapter. MAC
address is a unique 48–bit identifier usually written as 12 hexadecimal characters grouped in pairs (for
example, 00–00–0c-34–11–4e). This address is usually hard-coded into a Network Interface Card (NIC) by
the manufacturer and used as an aid for routers trying to locate machines on a large network.
MEt
HP Memory Enhancement technology (MEt) effectively doubles the standard memory through a variety
of font- and data-compression methods. MEt is available only in Printer Command Language (PCL) mode;
it is not functional when printing in PostScript (PS) mode.
MFP
A Multi Function Printer (MFP) is a printer that incorporates multiple functionalities in a single physical
body. For example, an MFP printer can scan, digitally send, fax, copy, and print.
MHV
Miniature High Voltage (MHV) is designed for high voltage applications of BNC connectors (DC voltage
between 500 V and 5 kV).
Modem
A device that modulates a carrier signal to encode digital information, and also demodulates such a
carrier signal to decode transmitted information.
MPCA (PageWide)
The MPCA integrates both formatter (LaserJet) and engine control electronics (DC controller) into a
single assembly. The Main PCA (MPCA) controls printer functions like receiving and processes print
data, developing and coordinating data placement, storing font and customer configuration information,
communicating with the host computer, and monitoring control panel functions and relaying printer
status information through the control panel.
NAND
NAND is not an acronym (the term is short for NOT AND a Boolean operator and logic gate). NAND
(flash) memory is non-volatile, meaning it retains stored data even when the power is turned off.
NVRAM
Nonvolatile random access memory (NVRAM) is used to store I/O and information about the print
environment configuration (stored data even when the power is turned off).
Originals
The first example of something, such as a document, photograph, or text which is copied, reproduced, or
translated to produce additional copies. The original itself is not copied or derived from something else.
PCA
Printed Circuit Assembly (PCA). Once the printed circuit board (PCB) is complete, electronic components
must be assembled to form a functional printed circuit assembly or PCA.
PCL
Printer Command Language (PCL) is a Page Description Language (PDL) developed by HP as a printer
protocol. PCL has become an industry standard. Originally developed for early Inkjet printers, PCL has
been released in varying levels for thermal, dot matrix printers and laser printers.
PDF
Portable Document Format (PDF) is a proprietary file format developed by Adobe Systems. A PDF
represents two dimension documents in a device independent and resolution independent format.
PJL
Printer job language (PJL) is an integral part of printer configuration, in addition to the standard PCL
and PostScript (PS). With standard cabling, the printer can use PJL to perform a variety of functions like
dynamic I/O switching, context-sensitive switching, and isolation of print environment settings from one
print job to the next.
PML
Printer management language (PML) allows remote configuration of the printer and status read-back
from the printer through the I/O ports.
PostScript (PS)
PostScript (PS) is a Page Description Language (PDL) and programming language used primarily in
electronic and desktop publishing. PostScript is run in an interpreter to generate an image.
PPM
Pages Per Minute (PPM) is a method of measurement for determining how fast a printer works, meaning
the number of pages a printer can produce in one minute.
Print Media
Media like paper, envelopes, labels, and transparencies which can be used in a printer, scanner, fax, or
copier.
Printer Driver
A program used to send commands and transfer data from the computer to the printer.
Printhead (PageWide)
The printhead converts the digital firing instructions from the printer electronics into properly formed
and timed microscopic drops of the four ink colors.
Protocol
A convention or standard that controls or enables the connection, communication, and data transfer
between two computing endpoints.
RAM
Random Access Memory (RAM) is the printer memory device where the data in current use is kept so it
can be quickly retrieved by the device's processor. This memory is an important factor in avoiding errors
and printing documents properly. Printer memory is used to store, and process print jobs as they are
sent to the printer from a computer. After printing, the job is cleared from the memory to make room
for more print jobs. Printer memory is directly linked to two print characteristics: speed and print quality.
More memory allows you to print faster and print larger, high-quality graphics.
REDI sensor
An optical reflective edge detection interrupter (REDI) sensor. Usually used in conjunction with mirrors
to sense the presence or absence of paper in the paper path. These sensors are carefully aligned and
calibrated at the factory, so care must be taken when servicing these sensors.
Resolution
The sharpness of an image is measured in Dots Per Inch (DPI). The higher the DPI, the greater the
resolution.
SCB
The Scanner Control Board (SCB) controls the functions of the image scanner components in the Sub
Scanner Assembly (SSA).
SFP
A single-function printer only processes print jobs sent from a host computer or from an USB port on the
printer.
SMB
Server Message Block (SMB) is a network protocol mainly applied to share files, printers, serial ports,
and miscellaneous communications between nodes on a network. SMB also provides an authenticated
inter-process communication mechanism.
SODIMM
Small outline dual in-line memory module (SODIMM) is a thin profile memory storage device (a smaller
alternative to a standard DIMM device).
SSA
The Sub-Scanner Assembly is the image scanner component of the Integrated Scanner Assembly (ISA,
which includes the document feeder and the image scanner).
Subnet Mask
The subnet mask is used in conjunction with the network address to determine which part of the
address is the network address and which part is the host address.
TCP/IP
The Transmission Control Protocol (TCP) and the Internet Protocol (IP) are the set of communications
protocols that implement the protocol stack on which the internet and most commercial networks run.
TIFF
Tagged Image File Format (TIFF) is a variable-resolution bit mapped image format. TIFF describes image
data that typically come from scanners. TIFF images use tags, keywords defining the characteristics
of the image that is included in the file. This flexible and platform-independent format can be used for
pictures that have been made by various image processing applications.
Toner Cartridge
A bottle or container that holds toner, which is used in a machine like a printer. Toner is a powder used
in laser printers and photocopiers. The toner forms the text and images on printed paper. Toner can be
fused by a combination of heat/pressure from the fuser, causing it to bind the fibers in the paper.
TPM
The HP Trusted Platform Module (TPM) is a security accessory for printers. The TPM strengthens
protection of encrypted credentials and data stored on your printer. Certificate private keys are both
generated by and protected by the TPM. Once installed, the printer and the TPM are sealed, and the
printer owns the TPM. The TPM may not be moved to another device without losing its ownership from
the original printer. Installing a TPM accessory might necessitate a firmware upgrade. The TPM prevents
the printer from starting if the TPM is missing. If the TPM is removed from the printer, a control-panel
error message appears indicating that the TPM is missing.
NOTE: The TPM is not a service part for some printer models. Check the printer service manual to determine if
the TPM is a replaceable service part.
TWAIN
An industry standard for scanners and software. By using a TWAIN compliant scanner with TWAIN-
compliant software, a scan can be initiated from the program. TWAIN is an image capture API for
Microsoft Windows and Apple Macintosh operating systems.
USB
Universal Serial Bus (USB) is a standard that was developed by the USB Implementers Forum, Inc., to
connect computers and peripherals. Unlike the parallel port, USB is designed to concurrently connect a
single computer USB port to multiple peripherals.
Walk-up USB
Some printers support direct printing from a USB flash drive (the walk-up USB port is usually near the
control panel).
Watermark
A watermark is a recognizable image or pattern in paper that appears lighter when viewed by
transmitted light. Watermarks were first introduced in Bologna, Italy in 1282. Watermarks have been
used by paper makers to identify their product, and also on postage stamps, currency, and other
government documents to discourage counterfeiting.
XPS
XML Paper Specification (XPS) is a specification for a Page Description Language (PDL) and a new
document format developed by Microsoft. This has benefits for portable document and electronic
documents. It is an XML-based specification based on a new print path and vector-based, device-
independent document format.
ZIF Connector
Zero insertion force (ZIF) connectors use a mechanical locking method to secure Flat Flexible Cables
(FFCs) to a Printed Circuit Assembly (PCA).
Index 1663
checklists parts 1543 D
pre-troubleshooting 139 solve problems 147, 322
DC controller
circuit base printer, control panel diagnostic
components 66
diagrams 238 flowcharts 161
fans 66, 73
circuit diagrams control panel messages 343
motors 66, 71
high-voltage power supply 66, control panel, system diagnostics
theory of operation 67
76 solve problems 322
DC controller communication error
low-voltage power supply 66 control panels
55.WX.YZ error 364
cleaning page 292, 293 parts and diagrams 1543
DC controller firmware error
print 481 control-panel menu
70.WX.YZ error 364
clutches Maintenance 292
DC motors 66, 71
theory of operation 67 control-panel menu)
defeating
cold rest Service (Maintenance) 294
interlocks 312
reset 303 Troubleshooting
defeating interlocks
color self calibration (Maintenance) 295
solve problems 188, 313
theory 83 USB Firmware Upgrade
definitions and terms
component diagnostics (Maintenance) 294
glossary 1653
solve problems 196 controller
delivery functions, other
components 550-sheet paper feeder 109
3-bin stapler-stacker 116
DC controller 66, 67 floor-standing stapler-
floor-standing stapler-
engine-control unit 66 stacker 116, 120
stacker 120
fuser control 77 HCI 112
determine problem source 139
intermediate transfer belt conventions used vi
development
(ITB) 83, 94 cooling
image formation 89
low-voltage power supply 73 areas and fans 66, 73
development process 83, 85
pickup, feed, and delivery 97 copy-quality problems
devices, input
secondary transfer roller light or faint copies 498
information 33
assembly 96 modify printer settings to
devices, output
toner cartridge 83 improve scan or copy
information 35
configuration quality 497
diagnostics
base printer 12 vertical lines, bands, or
component, solve
printer 1 streaks 492
problems 196
configuration page copy-quality troubleshooting 490
engine 312
determine installed Copy/Print (Settings) menu (MFP)
diagram
firmware 143 control-panel menu 166
3-bin stapler-stacker 35
find information 249 CoV
floor-standing stapler-
solve problems 249 certificate of volatility 1646
stacker 36
configurations, 6700/X654/ covers
IPTU 39
X65455/X65465 12 remove and replace parts 631,
diagrams, block
configurations, 6800/X677/ 1115, 1166, 1209, 1299
solve problems 198
X67755/X67765 13 covers MFP
diagrams, external plug and port
connectivity and performance parts 1548, 1550
locations 198
troubleshooting 501 covers SFP
diagrams, general circuit base
connector error parts 1544, 1546
printer 238
65.WX.YZ error 364 covers, panels, and doors
diagrams, major component
connector locations parts and diagrams 1544,
locations 206
external plug and port 1584, 1589, 1595
diagrams, printed circuit assembly
diagrams 198 CPMD 343
connector locations 226
printed circuit assembly customer self-repair (CSR) A parts
diagrams, sensors and
diagrams 226 and accessories 508
switches 199
control panel 64 customer self-repair (CSR) B parts
diagrams, timing chart 236
locating MFP managed 8 and accessories 555
digital sending error (firmware)
locating MFP transactional 6 customer-replaceable units
44.WX.YZ error 363
locating SFP managed 4 remove and replace
dimensions, printer 24-26, 28
locating SFP transactional 4 parts 508, 555
1664 Index
disable cartridge check engine field-replaceable units
solve problems 194, 315 diagnostics 312 covers, panels, and doors 631,
document feeder test page 312 1115, 1166, 1209, 1299
jams 407, 409 engine error (LaserJet) remove and replace
locating MFP managed 8 46.WX.YZ error 363 parts 605, 631, 1115, 1166,
locating MFP transactional 6 63.WX.YZ error 364 1209, 1299
locating SFP managed 4 engine error (PageWide) firmware
paper-feeding problems 61.WX.YZ error 364 determine the installed
(MFP) 472 engine FRUs, internal version 143
remove and replace parts 605 parts and diagrams 1552, theory of operations 65
whole unit replacement 1541 1585, 1591, 1596 firmware communication error
document feeder / scanner engine laser scanner system 49.WX.YZ error 363
information, configurations, and laser scanner safety 84 firmware install error
specifications 2 engine test 99.WX.YZ error 364
parts and diagrams 1541 solve problems 147, 312 hard disk error 364
theory of operations 58 engine-control unit remote firmware upgrade
document feeder and scanner components 66 error 364
information 2 engine, printer firmware locations
document feeder error parts and diagrams 1543 active and repository 305
31.WX.YZ error 363 event log 353 firmware upgrade
doors event log error (firmware) firmware version
parts and diagrams 1544, 42.WX.YZ error 363 determine 143
1584, 1589, 1595 exhaust fans 66, 73 firmware upgrade)
remove and replace parts 631, external plug and port diagrams embedded web server 142
1115, 1166, 1209, 1299 locations 198 USB flash drive, control
drum panel 142
remove 518 F USB flash drive, pre-boot
replacing 520 menu 142
factory settings
drum cleaning 83, 85 firmware, upgrade
reset 303, 305
duplexer downloading 142
failure detection
jams 365, 407 firmware, version determine
laser/scanner 83
duplexer error find information 143
motors 66, 71
69.WX.YZ error 364 firmware, version
faint copies
duplexing unit determining 142
copy-quality problems 498
motors 66, 71 flash memory
fan control
theory of operations 65
3-bin stapler-stacker 116
E flatbed
floor-standing stapler-
scanning and image capture
easy-access USB port stacker 120
MFP only 58
locating MFP managed 8 fan error
Floor stand staple stacker covers
locating MFP transactional 6 58.WX.YZ error 364
MFP
locating SFP managed 4 fans
parts 1589
eject DC controller 66, 73
Floor stand staple stacker main
toner cartridges 513 exhaust 66, 73
body MFP
electrical components intake 66, 73
parts 1591, 1593
550-sheet paper feeder 109 theory of operation 67
floor stand staple stacker output
floor-standing stapler- Fax (Settings) menu (MFP)
devices
stacker 122 control-panel menu 272
parts and diagrams 1589
HCI 112 fax functions
floor-standing stapler-stacker
electrical specifications 31 theory of operations 65
controller 120
email problems fax ports
delivery functions, other 120
get help from WISE 501 locating MFP 11
electrical components 122
Embedded Jetdirect error fax problems
fan control 120
80.WX.YZ error 364 get help from WISE 501
jam detection 120
motor control 120, 126, 127
Index 1665
other functions 127 glossary image formation primary charging
output accessories 120 terms and definitions 1653 theory of operation 88
paper path 120 image formation primary transfer
floor-standing stapler-stacker H theory of operation 89
paper path image formation secondary
hard disk partition error
theory of operation 120 transfer
98.WX.YZ error 364
flowcharts theory of operation 90
hardware integration pocket (HIP)
troubleshooting 139, 140 image formation separation
locating SFP managed 4
format disk theory of operation 90
hardware integration pocket (HIP)
solve problems 305 image quality
is not functioning 161, 165
formatter check toner-cartridge
HCI
locating MFP 11 status 480
controller 112
formatter control system 62 image-formation process
electrical components 112, 113
front door development process 83, 85
input accessories 112
locating MFP managed 8 drum cleaning 83, 85
jam detection 112
locating MFP transactional 6 fusing process 83, 85
motor control 112, 114
locating SFP managed 4 laser-beam exposure 83, 85
other functions 114
locating SFP transactional 4 primary charging 83, 85
paper path 112
FRUs primary transfer process 83,
pickup and feed functions,
remove and replace 85
other 112
parts 605, 631, 1115, 1166, secondary transfer
HCI covers
1209, 1299 process 83, 85
parts 1587
FRUS, internal separation process 83, 85
HCI main body
parts and diagrams 1552, image-information system 83
parts 1588
1585, 1591, 1596 image-quality
HCI paper path
functions troubleshooting 474
theory of operation 112
fuser control 77 imaging drums
high-voltage power supply (HVPS)
low-voltage power supply 73, remove 518
operations 66, 76
75 replacing 520
home button is unresponsive 161,
toner cartridge 94 individual component test
164
fuser solve problems 196
HP internal users
jams 398, 400, 404, 407, 445, information
WISE vii
447, 451 document feeder and
HVPS (high-voltage power supply)
fuser control scanner 2
operations 66, 76
fuser control functions 83 input devices 33
theory of operation 77 I output devices 35
fuser control functions printer 1
fuser control 83 I/O functions printer base 4
fuser error theory of operations 65 information pages
41.WX.YZ error 363 image capture system configuration page 249
laser scanner error 363 scanning MFP only 58 Jetdirect page 249
paper path error 363 image defects, repetitive information, configurations, and
fuser error (LaserJet) ruler 475 specifications
50.WX.YZ error 363 image formation development ADF / scanner 2
fuser heater theory of operation 89 document feeder / scanner 2
protection 82 image formation fusing scanner / document feeder 2
fusing theory of operation 91 initial rotation period 60
image formation 91 image formation ITB cleaning input accessory error
fusing process 83, 85 theory of operation 91 67.WX.YZ error 364
image formation laser-beam input devices
G exposure information 33
theory of operation 88 parts and diagrams 1584
General (Settings) menu
image formation pre-exposure remove and replace, 2,100-sheet
control-panel menu 255
theory of operation 87 paper deck 1166
1666 Index
remove and replace, 550-sheet internal assemblies (5 of 7), J
paper feeder 1115 parts 1563
jam detection
input, 2,100-sheet paper feeder HCI Internal assemblies (5 of 9),
3-bin stapler-stacker 116, 120
parts and diagrams 1587 parts 1576
550-sheet feeder 111, 128
input, 550-sheet paper feeder internal assemblies (6 of 7),
550-sheet paper feeder 109
parts and diagrams 1584 parts 1564
floor-standing stapler-
input/output error internal assemblies (6 of 9),
stacker 120
40.WX.YZ error 363 parts 1577
HCI 112, 115
input/output functions internal assemblies (7 of 7),
jam error (LaserJet)
theory of operations 65 parts 1566
13.WX.YZ error 363
install internal assemblies (7 of 9) ,
jam error (PageWide)
tray 1 pickup roller 550 parts 1579
13.WX.YZ error 363
installation internal assemblies (8 of 9),
jams
printer 41 parts 1580
3-bin stapler-stacker 120
installation, base printer 45 internal assemblies (9 of 9),
550-sheet feeder 111, 128
installation, document feeder / parts 1582
550-sheet tray 407
scanner 42 internal assemblies 2,100-sheet
550-sheet trays 365
intake fans 66, 73 paper deck 1166
auto-navigation 365, 409
integrated scanner assembly (ISA) internal assemblies 3-bin staple
causes of 365, 409
ISA stacker multi-bin
document feeder 407, 409
whole-unit replacement, mailbox 1209, 1299
duplexer 365, 407
integrated scanner internal assemblies 550-sheet
fuser 398, 400, 404, 407, 445,
assembly 622 paper feeder 1115
447, 451
whole-unit replacement 622 internal assemblies base
HCI 115
interface ports printer 631
in right door 395, 442
locating MFP 11 internal diagnostics error
locations 365, 407
locating SFP 5 90.WX.YZ error 364
output bin 365, 406, 407, 453,
interlocks video display error 364
454, 456, 458, 462, 465
defeating 312 internal parts 2,100-sheet paper
Tray 1 365, 407
Intermediate paper transfer unit deck
Tray 2 365, 370, 407, 417
MFP remove and replace 1166
Tray 4 381, 388, 428, 435
parts 1594 internal parts 3-bin staple stacker
Jetdirect page
intermediate paper transport unit multi-bin mailbox
solve problems 249
output devices remove and replace 1209,
job accounting error (firmware)
parts and diagrams 1594 1299
48.WX.YZ error 363
intermediate transfer belt (ITB) internal parts 550-sheet paper
job management error
components 83, 94 feeder
(firmware) 363
operations 83, 94 remove and replace 1115
job pipeline error
internal assemblies (1 of 7), internal parts and assemblies
(firmware) 363
parts 1552 parts and diagrams 1552,
job parser error (firmware)
internal assemblies (1 of 9), 1585, 1591, 1596
47.WX.YZ error 363
parts 1568 internal parts and assemblies,
printer calibration error 363
internal assemblies (2 of 7), remove and replace 508, 555,
parts 1555 605, 716, 1130, 1176, 1247, 1377
K
internal assemblies (2 of 9), internal parts base printer, remove
parts 1570 and replace 631 keyboard 64
internal assemblies (3 of 7), internal test and information
parts 1558 pages L
Internal assemblies (3 of 9), solve problems 249 laser scanner
parts 1572 ITB (intermediate transfer belt) failure detection 84
internal assemblies (4 of 7), operation 83, 94 laser scanner error (LaserJet)
parts 1561 ITB cleaning 51.WX.YZ error 363
Internal assemblies (4 of 9), image formation 91 52.WX.YZ error 363
parts 1574
Index 1667
laser scanner functions EMMC error 364 movement of paper through
failure detection 84 hard disk error 364 printer
laser scanner safety memory functions See pickup, feed, and delivery
engine laser scanner theory of operations 65
system 84 menu, control panel N
laser-beam exposure 83, 85 Backup/Restore (Maintenance)
Near Field Communication error
image formation 88 menu 292
81.WX.YZ error 364
laser/scanner Backup/Restore menu 292
Bluetooth error 364
failure detection 83 Calibrate/Cleaning menu 292,
external I/O card error 364
operations 83 293
internal EIO error 364
last rotation period 60 Copy/Print (Settings) menu
wireless error 364
latent image formation 83, 85 (MFP) 166
network port
light copies Fax (Settings) menu (MFP) 272
locating SFP 5
copy-quality problems 498 General (Settings) menu 255
Networking (Settings) menu
lines, bands, streaks Manage Supplies (Settings)
control-panel menu 286
copy-quality problems 492 menu) 283
networks
link speed, change 189, 315 Networking (Settings)
supported 16, 17, 19, 21
low-voltage power supply menu 286
no control panel sound 161, 163
functions 75 Print (Settings) menu
note vi
over-current/over-voltage (SFP) 166
NVRAM
protection 75 Reports menu 253
theory of operations 65
safety 75 Scan/Digital Send (Settings)
theory of operation 73 menu (MFP) 261 O
voltage descriptions 74 Service (Maintenance)
low-voltage power supply (HVPS) menu 294 on/off button
operations 66 Service menu 292 locating MFP managed 8
LVPS (low-voltage power supply) Settings menu 254 locating MFP transactional 6
operations 66 Support Tools menu 292 locating SFP managed 4
Troubleshooting (Maintenance) locating SFP transactional 4
M menu 295 operating-environment range
USB Firmware Upgrade printer 32
maintenance
(Maintenance) menu 294 operation
printer 41
USB Firmware Upgrade Sleep delay 62
maintenance, base printer 45
menu 292 Sleep mode 62
maintenance, document feeder /
menus control panel, control panel operation sequence 60
scanner 42
Calibrate/Cleaning) 292 operations
major component diagrams
menus, control panel laser/scanner 83
locations 206
Calibrate/Cleaning 293 toner cartridge memory 83
major component locations
motor control other functions
diagrams 206
3-bin stapler-stacker 116, 119 floor-standing stapler-
Manage Supplies (Settings) menu
550-sheet paper feeder 109, stacker 127
control-panel menu 283
111 other functions, 3-bin stapler-
manual sensor test, tray/bin
floor-standing stapler- stacker
solve problems 197
stacker 120, 126, 127 theory of operation 119
manual sensor tests
HCI 112, 114 other functions, 550-sheet paper
solve problem 197
motor error (LaserJet) feeder
memory
59.WX.YZ error 364 theory of operation 111
included 16, 17, 19, 21
motors other functions, HCI
toner cartridge 83
DC controller 66, 71 theory of operation 114
Memory Enhancement technology
failure detection 66, 71 output accessory error
theory of operations 65
pickup, feed, and delivery 66.WX.YZ error 364
Memory Enhancement technology
system 97, 101 output bin
(MEt) 62
stepping 66, 71 clear jams 365, 406, 407, 453,
memory error
theory of operation 67 454, 458, 462, 465
82.WX.YZ error 364
locating MFP managed 8
1668 Index
locating SFP managed 4 paper jams parts and diagrams
locating SFP transactional 4 550-sheet tray 407 2,100-sheet paper feeder
output bin, base printer 550-sheet trays 365 HCI 1587
locating MFP transactional 6 document feeder 407, 409 550-sheet paper feeder 1584
output bin, finisher duplexer 365, 407 ADF / scanner 1541
locating MFP transactional 6 fuser 398, 400, 404, 407, 445, base printer 1543
output device, 3-bin staple stacker 447, 451 control panels 1543
parts and diagrams 1594 locations 365, 407 covers, panels, and
output device, floor stand staple output bin 365, 406, 407, 453, doors 1544, 1584, 1589,
stacker 454, 456, 458, 462, 465 1595
parts and diagrams 1589 right door 395, 442 document feeder /
output device, intermediate paper Stapler stacker 456 scanner 1541
transport unit Tray 1 365, 407 doors 1544, 1584, 1589, 1595
parts and diagrams 1594 Tray 2 365, 370, 407, 417 engine, printer 1543
output devices Tray 4 381, 388, 428, 435 f3-bin staple stacker output
information 35 paper movement device 1594
parts and diagrams 1589 operation 97 floor stand staple stacker
remove and replace, 3-bin paper path output device 1589
staple stacker multi-bin 3-bin stapler-stacker 116 input devices 1584
mailbox 1209, 1299 550-sheet paper feeder 109 intermediate paper transport
over-current/over-voltage floor-standing stapler- unit output device 1594
protection stacker 120 internal parts and
low-voltage power supply 75 HCI 112 assemblies 1552, 1585,
OXPd/Web kit error printer 97 1591, 1596
45.WX.YZ error 363 paper path sensors test (not output devices 1589
available for this printer) panels 1544, 1584, 1589, 1595
P solve problems 196 scanner / document
paper path test feeder 1541
page error
solve problems 196 parts internal 2,100-sheet paper
21.WX.YZ error 363
partial clean (disk) deck
pages
solve problems 305 remove and replace 1166
blank 502
parts parts internal 3-bin staple stacker
not printing 502
3 bin staple stacker covers multi-bin mailbox
printing slowly 502
MFP 1595 remove and replace 1209,
pages per minute 16, 17, 19, 21
3 bin staple stacker main body 1299
panels
MFP 1596 parts internal 550-sheet paper
parts and diagrams 1544,
550-sheet paper feeder covers, feeder
1584, 1589, 1595
panels, and doors 1584 remove and replace 1115
remove and replace parts 631,
550-sheet paper feeder main parts internal base printer, remove
1115, 1166, 1209, 1299
body 1585 and replace 631
paper
control panel 1543 parts, internal assemblies (1 of
jams 365, 407, 409
covers MFP 1548, 1550 7) 1552
selecting 481
covers SFP 1544, 1546 parts, internal assemblies (1 of
paper feeder, 2,100-sheet HCI
document feeder and scanner 9) 1568
parts and diagrams 1587
whole units 1541 parts, internal assemblies (2 of
paper feeder, 550-sheet
Floor stand staple stacker 7) 1555
parts and diagrams 1584
covers MFP 1589 parts, internal assemblies (2 of
parts, main body 1585
Floor stand staple stacker main 9) 1570
whole unit replacement
body MFP 1591, 1593 parts, internal assemblies (3 of
part 1584
HCI covers 1587 7) 1558
paper handling
HCI main body 1588 parts, Internal assemblies (3 of
solve problems 365
Intermediate paper transfer 9) 1572
paper handling error (LaserJet)
unit MFP 1594 parts, internal assemblies (4 of
56.WX.YZ error 364
7) 1561
Index 1669
parts, Internal assemblies (4 of Print (Settings) menu (SFP) R
9) 1574 control-panel menu 166
RAM
parts, internal assemblies (5 of print a cleaning page 481
theory of operations 65
7) 1563 print bar error (PageWide)
real-time clock error
parts, Internal assemblies (5 of 62.WX.YZ error 364
11.WX.YZ error 363
9) 1576 print-quality troubleshooting 475
removal and replacement 507
parts, internal assemblies (6 of print/stop test
remove
7) 1564 solve problems 195
imaging drums 518
parts, internal assemblies (6 of printed circuit assembly diagrams
toner cartridges 510, 515
9) 1577 connector locations 226
toner cartridges (manually
parts, internal assemblies (7 of printer
unlocked) 740
7) 1566 information, configuration, and
tray 1 pickup roller 546
parts, internal assemblies (7 of specifications 1
remove and replace
9) 1579 installation and
2,100-sheet paper deck, internal
parts, internal assemblies (8 of maintenance 41
parts and assemblies 1166
9) 1580 operating-environment
3-bin staple stacker multi-bin
parts, internal assemblies (9 of range 32
mailbox, internal parts and
9) 1582 resets 303
assemblies 1209, 1299
performance and connectivity space requirements 31
550-sheet paper feeder,
troubleshooting 501 printer engine
internal parts and
periods of the operation parts and diagrams 1543
assemblies 1115
sequence 60 printer information, configuration,
remove and replace parts
personal identification number and specifications
automatic document feeder,
(PIN) document feeder and scanner
whole-unit
service menu 299 specifications 2
replacement 614
pickup and feed functions, other document feeder and scanner
covers, panels, and doors 631,
550-sheet paper feeder 109 views 2
1115, 1166, 1209, 1299
HCI 112 printer installation and
customer-replaceable
pickup, feed, and delivery maintenance
units 508, 555
components 97 base printer 45
document feeder /
overview 97 document feeder /
scanner 605
PJL (printer job language) 62, 64 scanner 42
field-replaceable units 605,
PML (printer management printer job language (PJL) 62, 64
631, 1115, 1166, 1209, 1299
language) 62 printer management language
integrated scanner assembly
power (PML) 62
(ISA), whole-unit
consumption 31 printer memory error
replacement 622
power connection 20.WX.YZ error 363
whole-unit replacement 614
locating SFP 5 printer resets
remove and replace, internal parts
power management solve problems 303
and assemblies 508, 555, 605,
theory of operation 62 printer settings
716, 1130, 1176, 1247, 1377
power on troubleshooting 310 copy-quality problems 497
remove and replace, internal parts
power on troubleshooting printer, base
and assemblies base
overview 310 configuration 12
printer 631
power switch information 4
repetitive image defect ruler 475
locating SFP transactional 4 specifications 16
replacing
power-on checks printing
imaging drums 520
troubleshooting process 310 period in operation
toner cartridges 510, 516
pre-boot menu options 343 sequence 60
reports
pre-exposure troubleshooting 502
event log 353
image formation 87 Process Cleaning Page 292, 293
supplies status page 343
pre-troubleshooting protection
Reports menu
checklist 139 fuser heater 82
control-panel menu 253
primary charging
resets
image formation 88
printer 303
primary charging process 83, 85
1670 Index
revision history iii security error solve connectivity problems 505
right door 33.WX.YZ error 363 solve performance
locating MFP managed 8 sensor error problems 502
locating MFP transactional 6 54.WX.YZ error 364 factors affecting print
locating SFP managed 4 58.WX.YZ error 364 performance 502
locating SFP transactional 4 sensors print speeds 503
Right door pickup, feed, and delivery printer does not print 504
jams 395, 442 system 97, 99 printer prints slowly 504
roller, tray 1 pickup theory of operation 67 solve problems
install 550 sensors and switches diagrams circuit diagrams 238
remove 546 3-bin stapler-stacker 199 configuration page 249
550-sheet paper feeder 199 control panel 147, 322
S base printer 199 control panel messages 343
floor-standing stapler- copy-quality
safety
stacker 199 troubleshooting 490
low-voltage power supply 75
HCI 199 CPMD 343
scan or copy quality improvement
separation defeating interlocks 188, 313
copy-quality problems 497
image formation 90 diagrams, block 198
Scan/Digital Send (Settings) menu
separation process 83, 85 disable cartridge check 194,
(MFP)
Service (Maintenance) menu 315
control-panel menu 261
control-panel menu 294 engine test 147, 312
scanner
service and support external plug and port location
remove and replace parts 605
WISE vii diagrams 198
scanner and document feeder
service ID firmware upgrade 142
information 2
restore 303 firmware, determine
scanner error
service menu version 143
30.WX.YZ error 363
personal identification number format disk and partial clean
scanner tests (MFP)
(PIN) 299 functions 305
solve problems 193
solve problems 299 image-quality
troubleshooting 193
Settings (Copy/Print, MFP) menu troubleshooting 474
scanner, image
control-panel menu 166 individual component
whole unit replacement
Settings (Fax) menu (MFP) diagnostics 196
part 1541
control-panel menu 272 individual component test 196
scanner/document feeder
Settings (General) menu internal test and information
information, configurations, and
control-panel menu 255 pages 249
specifications 2
Settings (Manage Supplies) menu) LED diagnostics 189, 315
parts and diagrams 1541
control-panel menu 283 link speed 189, 315
theory of operations 58
Settings (Networking) menu major component locations
scanning
control-panel menu 286 diagrams 206
image capture MFP only 58
Settings (Print, SFP) menu manual sensor test 197
secondary transfer
control-panel menu 166 output is curled or
image formation 90
Settings (Scan/Digital Send) menu wrinkled 365, 471
secondary transfer assembly
(MFP) paper does not feed
operation 96
control-panel menu 261 automatically 365, 473
secondary transfer
Settings menu paper does not feed from Tray
processes 83, 85
control-panel menu 254 2-X 365, 470
secondary transfer roller
sleep delay paper handling 365
assembly
operation 62 paper path sensors test (not
components 96
sleep mode available for this
operations 96
operation 62 printer) 196
secondary transfer roller
sleep settings 62 paper path test 196
assembly)
solenoids performance and connectivity
operation 96
pickup, feed, and delivery troubleshooting 501
security
system 97, 101 power-on checks 310
dynamic security 83
theory of operation 67
Index 1671
print-quality remove toner cartridges image formation primary
troubleshooting 475 (manually unlocked) 740 transfer 89
print/stop test 195 replacing imaging drums 520 image formation secondary
printed circuit assembly replacing toner transfer 90
connector location cartridges 510, 516 image formation
diagrams 226 unlock manually the toner separation 90
printer does not pick up cartridges 738 low-voltage power supply 73
paper 365 supplies error (LaserJet) motors 67
printer does not pick up paper 10.WX.YZ error 363 scanning and image
or misfeeds 365 supplies error (PageWide) capture 58
printer feeds incorrect page 17.WX.YZ error 363 sensors 67
size 365, 469 supplies status page 343 solenoids 67
printer picks up multiple sheets Support Tools menu switches 67
of paper 365 control-panel menu 292 toner cartridges 92
printer pulls from incorrect switches theory of operations
tray 365, 469 pickup, feed, and delivery 10/100/1000 functions 65
printer resets 303 system 97, 99 ADF / scanner 58
printer will not duplex or theory of operation 67 base printer 60
duplexes incorrectly 365, system error (LaserJet) document feeder /
470 62.WX.YZ error 364 scanner 58
scanner tests (MFP) 193 fax functions 65
sensors and switches T firmware 65
diagrams 199 flash memory 65
terms and definitions
service menu 299 I/O functions 65
glossary 1653
system diagnostics, control input devices 109
tests
panel 322 input/output functions 65
disable cartridge check 312
timing chart diagrams 236 Memory Enhancement
engine 312
tray/bin manual sensor technology 65
theory of operation 57
test 197 memory functions 65
3-bin stapler-stacker other
troubleshooting tools 147 NVRAM 65
functions 119
solving output devices 116
550-sheet paper feeder other
direct-connect problems 505 printer, base 60
functions 111
space requirements RAM 65
550-sheet paper feeder paper
printer 31 scanner / document
path 109, 116
specifications feeder 58
clutches 67
base printer 16 USB functions 65
DC controller 67
electrical and acoustic 31 USB hosts functions 65
fans 67
printer 1 wireless functions 65
floor-standing stapler-stacker
specifications, document feeder timing chart, diagrams 236
paper path 120
and scanner tip vi
fuser control 77
printer information, toner
HCI other functions 114
configuration, and image formation, use
HCI paper path 112
specifications 2 during 83, 85
image formation
standby period 60 toner cartridge
development 89
stapler developing unit engagement
image formation fusing 91
locating MFP managed 8 and disengagement 83
image formation ITB
locating MFP transactional 6 diagnostic test 312
cleaning 91
Stapler stacker functions 94
image formation laser-beam
clear jams 456 life detection 83
exposure 88
stepping motors 66, 71 memory chip 83
image formation pre-
supplies presence detection 83
exposure 87
eject toner cartridges 513 toner level detection 83
image formation primary
remove imaging drums 518 toner cartridges 83
charging 88
remove toner cartridges 510, components 83
515 eject 513
1672 Index
error conditions 83 troubleshooting firmware upgrade 142
manually unlock 738 blank pages 502 image-quality
operations 83 check toner-cartridge troubleshooting 474
remove 510, 515 status 480 individual component
remove (manually checklist 139 diagnostics 196
unlocked) 740 control panel 147, 322 performance and connectivity
replacing 510, 516 defeating interlocks 188, 313 troubleshooting 501
theory of operation 92 direct-connect problems 505 print-quality
touchscreen blank, white, or dim disable cartridge check 194, troubleshooting 475
(no image) 161 315 solve problems 147
touchscreen control panel 64 engine test 147, 312
touchscreen has an unresponsive event log 353 U
zone 161, 162 flowchart 139, 140
unlock, manually
transfer processes 83, 85 format disk and partial clean
toner cartridges 738
transfer unit functions 305
upgrade, product firmware 142
operation 83, 94 individual component test 196
USB Firmware Upgrade
tray jams 365, 407, 409
(Maintenance) menu
location assemblies, 550-sheet LED diagnostics 189, 315
control-panel menu 294
paper feeder 33 link speed 189, 315
USB functions
location assemblies, HCI paper manual sensor test 197
theory of operations 65
feeder 34 network problems 505
USB hosts functions
Tray 1 pages not printing 502
theory of operations 65
jams 365, 407 pages printing slowly 502
USB port
locating MFP managed 8 paper path sensors test (not
locating SFP transactional 4
locating MFP transactional 6 available for this
troubleshooting 502
locating SFP managed 4 printer) 196
locating SFP transactional 4 paper path test 196 V
tray 1 pickup roller print/stop test 195
install 550 printer resets 303 vertical lines, bands, or streaks
remove 546 scanner tests (MFP) 193 copy-quality problems 492
Tray 2 service menu 299 views, document feeder and
jams 365, 370, 407, 417 supplies status page 343 scanner
locating MFP managed 8 system diagnostics, control printer information,
locating MFP transactional 6 panel 322 configuration, and
locating SFP managed 4 tray/bin manual sensor specifications 2
locating SFP transactional 4 test 197 voltage descriptions
Tray 3 USB cables 502 low-voltage power supply 74
locating MFP managed 8 wired network 505
locating MFP transactional 6 Troubleshooting (Maintenance) W
locating SFP managed 4 menu waiting period 60
Tray 4 control-panel menu 295 warning vi
jams 381, 388, 428, 435 troubleshooting process Web-based Interactive Search
locating MFP managed 8 power on 310 Engine (WISE)
locating MFP transactional 6 power subsystem 310 HP internal users and Channel
tray motor error (LaserJet) power-on checks 310 partners vii
60.WX.YZ error 364 troubleshooting process overview weight, printer 24-26, 28
tray/bin, manual sensor test power on 310 whole-unit replacement
solve problems 197 troubleshooting tools automatic document
trays control panel messages 343 feeder 614
capacity 16, 17, 19, 21 copy-quality integrated scanner assembly
included 16, 17, 19, 21 troubleshooting 490 (ISA) 622
locating MFP managed 8 CPMD 343 remove and replace parts 614
locating MFP transactional 6 determine the problem wireless functions
locating SFP managed 4 source 139 theory of operations 65
locating SFP transactional 4 diagrams, block 198
Index 1673
WISE
email problems 501
fax problems 501
HP internal users and Channel
partners vii
WUR
automatic document
feeder 614
integrated scanner assembly
(ISA) 622
remove and replace parts 614
1674 Index